dbxout.c (dbxout_source_line_counter): New global variable.
[gcc.git] / gcc / config / alpha / alpha.c
1 /* Subroutines used for code generation on the DEC Alpha.
2 Copyright (C) 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995, 1996, 1997, 1998, 1999,
3 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
4 Contributed by Richard Kenner (kenner@vlsi1.ultra.nyu.edu)
5
6 This file is part of GNU CC.
7
8 GNU CC is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
9 it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
10 the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option)
11 any later version.
12
13 GNU CC is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
14 but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
15 MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
16 GNU General Public License for more details.
17
18 You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
19 along with GNU CC; see the file COPYING. If not, write to
20 the Free Software Foundation, 59 Temple Place - Suite 330,
21 Boston, MA 02111-1307, USA. */
22
23
24 #include "config.h"
25 #include "system.h"
26 #include "coretypes.h"
27 #include "tm.h"
28 #include "rtl.h"
29 #include "tree.h"
30 #include "regs.h"
31 #include "hard-reg-set.h"
32 #include "real.h"
33 #include "insn-config.h"
34 #include "conditions.h"
35 #include "output.h"
36 #include "insn-attr.h"
37 #include "flags.h"
38 #include "recog.h"
39 #include "expr.h"
40 #include "optabs.h"
41 #include "reload.h"
42 #include "obstack.h"
43 #include "except.h"
44 #include "function.h"
45 #include "toplev.h"
46 #include "ggc.h"
47 #include "integrate.h"
48 #include "tm_p.h"
49 #include "target.h"
50 #include "target-def.h"
51 #include "debug.h"
52 #include "langhooks.h"
53 #include <splay-tree.h>
54 #include "cfglayout.h"
55
56 /* Specify which cpu to schedule for. */
57
58 enum processor_type alpha_cpu;
59 static const char * const alpha_cpu_name[] =
60 {
61 "ev4", "ev5", "ev6"
62 };
63
64 /* Specify how accurate floating-point traps need to be. */
65
66 enum alpha_trap_precision alpha_tp;
67
68 /* Specify the floating-point rounding mode. */
69
70 enum alpha_fp_rounding_mode alpha_fprm;
71
72 /* Specify which things cause traps. */
73
74 enum alpha_fp_trap_mode alpha_fptm;
75
76 /* Specify bit size of immediate TLS offsets. */
77
78 int alpha_tls_size = 32;
79
80 /* Strings decoded into the above options. */
81
82 const char *alpha_cpu_string; /* -mcpu= */
83 const char *alpha_tune_string; /* -mtune= */
84 const char *alpha_tp_string; /* -mtrap-precision=[p|s|i] */
85 const char *alpha_fprm_string; /* -mfp-rounding-mode=[n|m|c|d] */
86 const char *alpha_fptm_string; /* -mfp-trap-mode=[n|u|su|sui] */
87 const char *alpha_mlat_string; /* -mmemory-latency= */
88 const char *alpha_tls_size_string; /* -mtls-size=[16|32|64] */
89
90 /* Save information from a "cmpxx" operation until the branch or scc is
91 emitted. */
92
93 struct alpha_compare alpha_compare;
94
95 /* Nonzero if inside of a function, because the Alpha asm can't
96 handle .files inside of functions. */
97
98 static int inside_function = FALSE;
99
100 /* The number of cycles of latency we should assume on memory reads. */
101
102 int alpha_memory_latency = 3;
103
104 /* Whether the function needs the GP. */
105
106 static int alpha_function_needs_gp;
107
108 /* The alias set for prologue/epilogue register save/restore. */
109
110 static GTY(()) int alpha_sr_alias_set;
111
112 /* The assembler name of the current function. */
113
114 static const char *alpha_fnname;
115
116 /* The next explicit relocation sequence number. */
117 extern GTY(()) int alpha_next_sequence_number;
118 int alpha_next_sequence_number = 1;
119
120 /* The literal and gpdisp sequence numbers for this insn, as printed
121 by %# and %* respectively. */
122 extern GTY(()) int alpha_this_literal_sequence_number;
123 extern GTY(()) int alpha_this_gpdisp_sequence_number;
124 int alpha_this_literal_sequence_number;
125 int alpha_this_gpdisp_sequence_number;
126
127 /* Costs of various operations on the different architectures. */
128
129 struct alpha_rtx_cost_data
130 {
131 unsigned char fp_add;
132 unsigned char fp_mult;
133 unsigned char fp_div_sf;
134 unsigned char fp_div_df;
135 unsigned char int_mult_si;
136 unsigned char int_mult_di;
137 unsigned char int_shift;
138 unsigned char int_cmov;
139 };
140
141 static struct alpha_rtx_cost_data const alpha_rtx_cost_data[PROCESSOR_MAX] =
142 {
143 { /* EV4 */
144 COSTS_N_INSNS (6), /* fp_add */
145 COSTS_N_INSNS (6), /* fp_mult */
146 COSTS_N_INSNS (34), /* fp_div_sf */
147 COSTS_N_INSNS (63), /* fp_div_df */
148 COSTS_N_INSNS (23), /* int_mult_si */
149 COSTS_N_INSNS (23), /* int_mult_di */
150 COSTS_N_INSNS (2), /* int_shift */
151 COSTS_N_INSNS (2), /* int_cmov */
152 },
153 { /* EV5 */
154 COSTS_N_INSNS (4), /* fp_add */
155 COSTS_N_INSNS (4), /* fp_mult */
156 COSTS_N_INSNS (15), /* fp_div_sf */
157 COSTS_N_INSNS (22), /* fp_div_df */
158 COSTS_N_INSNS (8), /* int_mult_si */
159 COSTS_N_INSNS (12), /* int_mult_di */
160 COSTS_N_INSNS (1) + 1, /* int_shift */
161 COSTS_N_INSNS (1), /* int_cmov */
162 },
163 { /* EV6 */
164 COSTS_N_INSNS (4), /* fp_add */
165 COSTS_N_INSNS (4), /* fp_mult */
166 COSTS_N_INSNS (12), /* fp_div_sf */
167 COSTS_N_INSNS (15), /* fp_div_df */
168 COSTS_N_INSNS (7), /* int_mult_si */
169 COSTS_N_INSNS (7), /* int_mult_di */
170 COSTS_N_INSNS (1), /* int_shift */
171 COSTS_N_INSNS (2), /* int_cmov */
172 },
173 };
174
175 /* Get the number of args of a function in one of two ways. */
176 #if TARGET_ABI_OPEN_VMS || TARGET_ABI_UNICOSMK
177 #define NUM_ARGS current_function_args_info.num_args
178 #else
179 #define NUM_ARGS current_function_args_info
180 #endif
181
182 #define REG_PV 27
183 #define REG_RA 26
184
185 /* Declarations of static functions. */
186 static struct machine_function *alpha_init_machine_status (void);
187 static rtx alpha_emit_xfloating_compare (enum rtx_code, rtx, rtx);
188
189 #if TARGET_ABI_OPEN_VMS
190 static void alpha_write_linkage (FILE *, const char *, tree);
191 #endif
192
193 static void unicosmk_output_deferred_case_vectors (FILE *);
194 static void unicosmk_gen_dsib (unsigned long *);
195 static void unicosmk_output_ssib (FILE *, const char *);
196 static int unicosmk_need_dex (rtx);
197 \f
198 /* Parse target option strings. */
199
200 void
201 override_options (void)
202 {
203 int i;
204 static const struct cpu_table {
205 const char *const name;
206 const enum processor_type processor;
207 const int flags;
208 } cpu_table[] = {
209 #define EV5_MASK (MASK_CPU_EV5)
210 #define EV6_MASK (MASK_CPU_EV6|MASK_BWX|MASK_MAX|MASK_FIX)
211 { "ev4", PROCESSOR_EV4, 0 },
212 { "ev45", PROCESSOR_EV4, 0 },
213 { "21064", PROCESSOR_EV4, 0 },
214 { "ev5", PROCESSOR_EV5, EV5_MASK },
215 { "21164", PROCESSOR_EV5, EV5_MASK },
216 { "ev56", PROCESSOR_EV5, EV5_MASK|MASK_BWX },
217 { "21164a", PROCESSOR_EV5, EV5_MASK|MASK_BWX },
218 { "pca56", PROCESSOR_EV5, EV5_MASK|MASK_BWX|MASK_MAX },
219 { "21164PC",PROCESSOR_EV5, EV5_MASK|MASK_BWX|MASK_MAX },
220 { "21164pc",PROCESSOR_EV5, EV5_MASK|MASK_BWX|MASK_MAX },
221 { "ev6", PROCESSOR_EV6, EV6_MASK },
222 { "21264", PROCESSOR_EV6, EV6_MASK },
223 { "ev67", PROCESSOR_EV6, EV6_MASK|MASK_CIX },
224 { "21264a", PROCESSOR_EV6, EV6_MASK|MASK_CIX },
225 { 0, 0, 0 }
226 };
227
228 /* Unicos/Mk doesn't have shared libraries. */
229 if (TARGET_ABI_UNICOSMK && flag_pic)
230 {
231 warning ("-f%s ignored for Unicos/Mk (not supported)",
232 (flag_pic > 1) ? "PIC" : "pic");
233 flag_pic = 0;
234 }
235
236 /* On Unicos/Mk, the native compiler consistenly generates /d suffices for
237 floating-point instructions. Make that the default for this target. */
238 if (TARGET_ABI_UNICOSMK)
239 alpha_fprm = ALPHA_FPRM_DYN;
240 else
241 alpha_fprm = ALPHA_FPRM_NORM;
242
243 alpha_tp = ALPHA_TP_PROG;
244 alpha_fptm = ALPHA_FPTM_N;
245
246 /* We cannot use su and sui qualifiers for conversion instructions on
247 Unicos/Mk. I'm not sure if this is due to assembler or hardware
248 limitations. Right now, we issue a warning if -mieee is specified
249 and then ignore it; eventually, we should either get it right or
250 disable the option altogether. */
251
252 if (TARGET_IEEE)
253 {
254 if (TARGET_ABI_UNICOSMK)
255 warning ("-mieee not supported on Unicos/Mk");
256 else
257 {
258 alpha_tp = ALPHA_TP_INSN;
259 alpha_fptm = ALPHA_FPTM_SU;
260 }
261 }
262
263 if (TARGET_IEEE_WITH_INEXACT)
264 {
265 if (TARGET_ABI_UNICOSMK)
266 warning ("-mieee-with-inexact not supported on Unicos/Mk");
267 else
268 {
269 alpha_tp = ALPHA_TP_INSN;
270 alpha_fptm = ALPHA_FPTM_SUI;
271 }
272 }
273
274 if (alpha_tp_string)
275 {
276 if (! strcmp (alpha_tp_string, "p"))
277 alpha_tp = ALPHA_TP_PROG;
278 else if (! strcmp (alpha_tp_string, "f"))
279 alpha_tp = ALPHA_TP_FUNC;
280 else if (! strcmp (alpha_tp_string, "i"))
281 alpha_tp = ALPHA_TP_INSN;
282 else
283 error ("bad value `%s' for -mtrap-precision switch", alpha_tp_string);
284 }
285
286 if (alpha_fprm_string)
287 {
288 if (! strcmp (alpha_fprm_string, "n"))
289 alpha_fprm = ALPHA_FPRM_NORM;
290 else if (! strcmp (alpha_fprm_string, "m"))
291 alpha_fprm = ALPHA_FPRM_MINF;
292 else if (! strcmp (alpha_fprm_string, "c"))
293 alpha_fprm = ALPHA_FPRM_CHOP;
294 else if (! strcmp (alpha_fprm_string,"d"))
295 alpha_fprm = ALPHA_FPRM_DYN;
296 else
297 error ("bad value `%s' for -mfp-rounding-mode switch",
298 alpha_fprm_string);
299 }
300
301 if (alpha_fptm_string)
302 {
303 if (strcmp (alpha_fptm_string, "n") == 0)
304 alpha_fptm = ALPHA_FPTM_N;
305 else if (strcmp (alpha_fptm_string, "u") == 0)
306 alpha_fptm = ALPHA_FPTM_U;
307 else if (strcmp (alpha_fptm_string, "su") == 0)
308 alpha_fptm = ALPHA_FPTM_SU;
309 else if (strcmp (alpha_fptm_string, "sui") == 0)
310 alpha_fptm = ALPHA_FPTM_SUI;
311 else
312 error ("bad value `%s' for -mfp-trap-mode switch", alpha_fptm_string);
313 }
314
315 if (alpha_tls_size_string)
316 {
317 if (strcmp (alpha_tls_size_string, "16") == 0)
318 alpha_tls_size = 16;
319 else if (strcmp (alpha_tls_size_string, "32") == 0)
320 alpha_tls_size = 32;
321 else if (strcmp (alpha_tls_size_string, "64") == 0)
322 alpha_tls_size = 64;
323 else
324 error ("bad value `%s' for -mtls-size switch", alpha_tls_size_string);
325 }
326
327 alpha_cpu
328 = TARGET_CPU_DEFAULT & MASK_CPU_EV6 ? PROCESSOR_EV6
329 : (TARGET_CPU_DEFAULT & MASK_CPU_EV5 ? PROCESSOR_EV5 : PROCESSOR_EV4);
330
331 if (alpha_cpu_string)
332 {
333 for (i = 0; cpu_table [i].name; i++)
334 if (! strcmp (alpha_cpu_string, cpu_table [i].name))
335 {
336 alpha_cpu = cpu_table [i].processor;
337 target_flags &= ~ (MASK_BWX | MASK_MAX | MASK_FIX | MASK_CIX
338 | MASK_CPU_EV5 | MASK_CPU_EV6);
339 target_flags |= cpu_table [i].flags;
340 break;
341 }
342 if (! cpu_table [i].name)
343 error ("bad value `%s' for -mcpu switch", alpha_cpu_string);
344 }
345
346 if (alpha_tune_string)
347 {
348 for (i = 0; cpu_table [i].name; i++)
349 if (! strcmp (alpha_tune_string, cpu_table [i].name))
350 {
351 alpha_cpu = cpu_table [i].processor;
352 break;
353 }
354 if (! cpu_table [i].name)
355 error ("bad value `%s' for -mcpu switch", alpha_tune_string);
356 }
357
358 /* Do some sanity checks on the above options. */
359
360 if (TARGET_ABI_UNICOSMK && alpha_fptm != ALPHA_FPTM_N)
361 {
362 warning ("trap mode not supported on Unicos/Mk");
363 alpha_fptm = ALPHA_FPTM_N;
364 }
365
366 if ((alpha_fptm == ALPHA_FPTM_SU || alpha_fptm == ALPHA_FPTM_SUI)
367 && alpha_tp != ALPHA_TP_INSN && ! TARGET_CPU_EV6)
368 {
369 warning ("fp software completion requires -mtrap-precision=i");
370 alpha_tp = ALPHA_TP_INSN;
371 }
372
373 if (TARGET_CPU_EV6)
374 {
375 /* Except for EV6 pass 1 (not released), we always have precise
376 arithmetic traps. Which means we can do software completion
377 without minding trap shadows. */
378 alpha_tp = ALPHA_TP_PROG;
379 }
380
381 if (TARGET_FLOAT_VAX)
382 {
383 if (alpha_fprm == ALPHA_FPRM_MINF || alpha_fprm == ALPHA_FPRM_DYN)
384 {
385 warning ("rounding mode not supported for VAX floats");
386 alpha_fprm = ALPHA_FPRM_NORM;
387 }
388 if (alpha_fptm == ALPHA_FPTM_SUI)
389 {
390 warning ("trap mode not supported for VAX floats");
391 alpha_fptm = ALPHA_FPTM_SU;
392 }
393 }
394
395 {
396 char *end;
397 int lat;
398
399 if (!alpha_mlat_string)
400 alpha_mlat_string = "L1";
401
402 if (ISDIGIT ((unsigned char)alpha_mlat_string[0])
403 && (lat = strtol (alpha_mlat_string, &end, 10), *end == '\0'))
404 ;
405 else if ((alpha_mlat_string[0] == 'L' || alpha_mlat_string[0] == 'l')
406 && ISDIGIT ((unsigned char)alpha_mlat_string[1])
407 && alpha_mlat_string[2] == '\0')
408 {
409 static int const cache_latency[][4] =
410 {
411 { 3, 30, -1 }, /* ev4 -- Bcache is a guess */
412 { 2, 12, 38 }, /* ev5 -- Bcache from PC164 LMbench numbers */
413 { 3, 12, 30 }, /* ev6 -- Bcache from DS20 LMbench. */
414 };
415
416 lat = alpha_mlat_string[1] - '0';
417 if (lat <= 0 || lat > 3 || cache_latency[alpha_cpu][lat-1] == -1)
418 {
419 warning ("L%d cache latency unknown for %s",
420 lat, alpha_cpu_name[alpha_cpu]);
421 lat = 3;
422 }
423 else
424 lat = cache_latency[alpha_cpu][lat-1];
425 }
426 else if (! strcmp (alpha_mlat_string, "main"))
427 {
428 /* Most current memories have about 370ns latency. This is
429 a reasonable guess for a fast cpu. */
430 lat = 150;
431 }
432 else
433 {
434 warning ("bad value `%s' for -mmemory-latency", alpha_mlat_string);
435 lat = 3;
436 }
437
438 alpha_memory_latency = lat;
439 }
440
441 /* Default the definition of "small data" to 8 bytes. */
442 if (!g_switch_set)
443 g_switch_value = 8;
444
445 /* Infer TARGET_SMALL_DATA from -fpic/-fPIC. */
446 if (flag_pic == 1)
447 target_flags |= MASK_SMALL_DATA;
448 else if (flag_pic == 2)
449 target_flags &= ~MASK_SMALL_DATA;
450
451 /* Align labels and loops for optimal branching. */
452 /* ??? Kludge these by not doing anything if we don't optimize and also if
453 we are writing ECOFF symbols to work around a bug in DEC's assembler. */
454 if (optimize > 0 && write_symbols != SDB_DEBUG)
455 {
456 if (align_loops <= 0)
457 align_loops = 16;
458 if (align_jumps <= 0)
459 align_jumps = 16;
460 }
461 if (align_functions <= 0)
462 align_functions = 16;
463
464 /* Acquire a unique set number for our register saves and restores. */
465 alpha_sr_alias_set = new_alias_set ();
466
467 /* Register variables and functions with the garbage collector. */
468
469 /* Set up function hooks. */
470 init_machine_status = alpha_init_machine_status;
471
472 /* Tell the compiler when we're using VAX floating point. */
473 if (TARGET_FLOAT_VAX)
474 {
475 real_format_for_mode[SFmode - QFmode] = &vax_f_format;
476 real_format_for_mode[DFmode - QFmode] = &vax_g_format;
477 real_format_for_mode[TFmode - QFmode] = NULL;
478 }
479 }
480 \f
481 /* Returns 1 if VALUE is a mask that contains full bytes of zero or ones. */
482
483 int
484 zap_mask (HOST_WIDE_INT value)
485 {
486 int i;
487
488 for (i = 0; i < HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT / HOST_BITS_PER_CHAR;
489 i++, value >>= 8)
490 if ((value & 0xff) != 0 && (value & 0xff) != 0xff)
491 return 0;
492
493 return 1;
494 }
495
496 /* Returns 1 if OP is either the constant zero or a register. If a
497 register, it must be in the proper mode unless MODE is VOIDmode. */
498
499 int
500 reg_or_0_operand (rtx op, enum machine_mode mode)
501 {
502 return op == CONST0_RTX (mode) || register_operand (op, mode);
503 }
504
505 /* Return 1 if OP is a constant in the range of 0-63 (for a shift) or
506 any register. */
507
508 int
509 reg_or_6bit_operand (rtx op, enum machine_mode mode)
510 {
511 return ((GET_CODE (op) == CONST_INT
512 && (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) INTVAL (op) < 64)
513 || register_operand (op, mode));
514 }
515
516
517 /* Return 1 if OP is an 8-bit constant or any register. */
518
519 int
520 reg_or_8bit_operand (rtx op, enum machine_mode mode)
521 {
522 return ((GET_CODE (op) == CONST_INT
523 && (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) INTVAL (op) < 0x100)
524 || register_operand (op, mode));
525 }
526
527 /* Return 1 if OP is a constant or any register. */
528
529 int
530 reg_or_const_int_operand (rtx op, enum machine_mode mode)
531 {
532 return GET_CODE (op) == CONST_INT || register_operand (op, mode);
533 }
534
535 /* Return 1 if OP is an 8-bit constant. */
536
537 int
538 cint8_operand (rtx op, enum machine_mode mode ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
539 {
540 return ((GET_CODE (op) == CONST_INT
541 && (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) INTVAL (op) < 0x100));
542 }
543
544 /* Return 1 if the operand is a valid second operand to an add insn. */
545
546 int
547 add_operand (rtx op, enum machine_mode mode)
548 {
549 if (GET_CODE (op) == CONST_INT)
550 /* Constraints I, J, O and P are covered by K. */
551 return (CONST_OK_FOR_LETTER_P (INTVAL (op), 'K')
552 || CONST_OK_FOR_LETTER_P (INTVAL (op), 'L'));
553
554 return register_operand (op, mode);
555 }
556
557 /* Return 1 if the operand is a valid second operand to a sign-extending
558 add insn. */
559
560 int
561 sext_add_operand (rtx op, enum machine_mode mode)
562 {
563 if (GET_CODE (op) == CONST_INT)
564 return (CONST_OK_FOR_LETTER_P (INTVAL (op), 'I')
565 || CONST_OK_FOR_LETTER_P (INTVAL (op), 'O'));
566
567 return reg_not_elim_operand (op, mode);
568 }
569
570 /* Return 1 if OP is the constant 4 or 8. */
571
572 int
573 const48_operand (rtx op, enum machine_mode mode ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
574 {
575 return (GET_CODE (op) == CONST_INT
576 && (INTVAL (op) == 4 || INTVAL (op) == 8));
577 }
578
579 /* Return 1 if OP is a valid first operand to an AND insn. */
580
581 int
582 and_operand (rtx op, enum machine_mode mode)
583 {
584 if (GET_CODE (op) == CONST_DOUBLE && GET_MODE (op) == VOIDmode)
585 return (zap_mask (CONST_DOUBLE_LOW (op))
586 && zap_mask (CONST_DOUBLE_HIGH (op)));
587
588 if (GET_CODE (op) == CONST_INT)
589 return ((unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) INTVAL (op) < 0x100
590 || (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) ~ INTVAL (op) < 0x100
591 || zap_mask (INTVAL (op)));
592
593 return register_operand (op, mode);
594 }
595
596 /* Return 1 if OP is a valid first operand to an IOR or XOR insn. */
597
598 int
599 or_operand (rtx op, enum machine_mode mode)
600 {
601 if (GET_CODE (op) == CONST_INT)
602 return ((unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) INTVAL (op) < 0x100
603 || (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) ~ INTVAL (op) < 0x100);
604
605 return register_operand (op, mode);
606 }
607
608 /* Return 1 if OP is a constant that is the width, in bits, of an integral
609 mode smaller than DImode. */
610
611 int
612 mode_width_operand (rtx op, enum machine_mode mode ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
613 {
614 return (GET_CODE (op) == CONST_INT
615 && (INTVAL (op) == 8 || INTVAL (op) == 16
616 || INTVAL (op) == 32 || INTVAL (op) == 64));
617 }
618
619 /* Return 1 if OP is a constant that is the width of an integral machine mode
620 smaller than an integer. */
621
622 int
623 mode_mask_operand (rtx op, enum machine_mode mode ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
624 {
625 if (GET_CODE (op) == CONST_INT)
626 {
627 HOST_WIDE_INT value = INTVAL (op);
628
629 if (value == 0xff)
630 return 1;
631 if (value == 0xffff)
632 return 1;
633 if (value == 0xffffffff)
634 return 1;
635 if (value == -1)
636 return 1;
637 }
638 else if (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT == 32 && GET_CODE (op) == CONST_DOUBLE)
639 {
640 if (CONST_DOUBLE_LOW (op) == 0xffffffff && CONST_DOUBLE_HIGH (op) == 0)
641 return 1;
642 }
643
644 return 0;
645 }
646
647 /* Return 1 if OP is a multiple of 8 less than 64. */
648
649 int
650 mul8_operand (rtx op, enum machine_mode mode ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
651 {
652 return (GET_CODE (op) == CONST_INT
653 && (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) INTVAL (op) < 64
654 && (INTVAL (op) & 7) == 0);
655 }
656
657 /* Return 1 if OP is the zero constant for MODE. */
658
659 int
660 const0_operand (rtx op, enum machine_mode mode)
661 {
662 return op == CONST0_RTX (mode);
663 }
664
665 /* Return 1 if OP is a hard floating-point register. */
666
667 int
668 hard_fp_register_operand (rtx op, enum machine_mode mode)
669 {
670 if (mode != VOIDmode && GET_MODE (op) != VOIDmode && mode != GET_MODE (op))
671 return 0;
672
673 if (GET_CODE (op) == SUBREG)
674 op = SUBREG_REG (op);
675 return GET_CODE (op) == REG && REGNO_REG_CLASS (REGNO (op)) == FLOAT_REGS;
676 }
677
678 /* Return 1 if OP is a hard general register. */
679
680 int
681 hard_int_register_operand (rtx op, enum machine_mode mode)
682 {
683 if (mode != VOIDmode && GET_MODE (op) != VOIDmode && mode != GET_MODE (op))
684 return 0;
685
686 if (GET_CODE (op) == SUBREG)
687 op = SUBREG_REG (op);
688 return GET_CODE (op) == REG && REGNO_REG_CLASS (REGNO (op)) == GENERAL_REGS;
689 }
690
691 /* Return 1 if OP is a register or a constant integer. */
692
693
694 int
695 reg_or_cint_operand (rtx op, enum machine_mode mode)
696 {
697 return (GET_CODE (op) == CONST_INT
698 || register_operand (op, mode));
699 }
700
701 /* Return 1 if OP is something that can be reloaded into a register;
702 if it is a MEM, it need not be valid. */
703
704 int
705 some_operand (rtx op, enum machine_mode mode)
706 {
707 if (mode != VOIDmode && GET_MODE (op) != VOIDmode && mode != GET_MODE (op))
708 return 0;
709
710 switch (GET_CODE (op))
711 {
712 case REG:
713 case MEM:
714 case CONST_INT:
715 case CONST_DOUBLE:
716 case CONST_VECTOR:
717 case LABEL_REF:
718 case SYMBOL_REF:
719 case CONST:
720 case HIGH:
721 return 1;
722
723 case SUBREG:
724 return some_operand (SUBREG_REG (op), VOIDmode);
725
726 default:
727 break;
728 }
729
730 return 0;
731 }
732
733 /* Likewise, but don't accept constants. */
734
735 int
736 some_ni_operand (rtx op, enum machine_mode mode)
737 {
738 if (GET_MODE (op) != mode && mode != VOIDmode)
739 return 0;
740
741 if (GET_CODE (op) == SUBREG)
742 op = SUBREG_REG (op);
743
744 return (GET_CODE (op) == REG || GET_CODE (op) == MEM);
745 }
746
747 /* Return 1 if OP is a valid operand for the source of a move insn. */
748
749 int
750 input_operand (rtx op, enum machine_mode mode)
751 {
752 if (mode != VOIDmode && GET_MODE (op) != VOIDmode && mode != GET_MODE (op))
753 return 0;
754
755 if (GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_FLOAT && GET_MODE (op) != mode)
756 return 0;
757
758 switch (GET_CODE (op))
759 {
760 case LABEL_REF:
761 case SYMBOL_REF:
762 case CONST:
763 if (TARGET_EXPLICIT_RELOCS)
764 {
765 /* We don't split symbolic operands into something unintelligable
766 until after reload, but we do not wish non-small, non-global
767 symbolic operands to be reconstructed from their high/lo_sum
768 form. */
769 return (small_symbolic_operand (op, mode)
770 || global_symbolic_operand (op, mode)
771 || gotdtp_symbolic_operand (op, mode)
772 || gottp_symbolic_operand (op, mode));
773 }
774
775 /* This handles both the Windows/NT and OSF cases. */
776 return mode == ptr_mode || mode == DImode;
777
778 case HIGH:
779 return (TARGET_EXPLICIT_RELOCS
780 && local_symbolic_operand (XEXP (op, 0), mode));
781
782 case REG:
783 case ADDRESSOF:
784 return 1;
785
786 case SUBREG:
787 if (register_operand (op, mode))
788 return 1;
789 /* ... fall through ... */
790 case MEM:
791 return ((TARGET_BWX || (mode != HImode && mode != QImode))
792 && general_operand (op, mode));
793
794 case CONST_DOUBLE:
795 case CONST_VECTOR:
796 return op == CONST0_RTX (mode);
797
798 case CONST_INT:
799 return mode == QImode || mode == HImode || add_operand (op, mode);
800
801 case CONSTANT_P_RTX:
802 return 1;
803
804 default:
805 break;
806 }
807
808 return 0;
809 }
810
811 /* Return 1 if OP is a SYMBOL_REF for a function known to be in this
812 file, and in the same section as the current function. */
813
814 int
815 samegp_function_operand (rtx op, enum machine_mode mode ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
816 {
817 if (GET_CODE (op) != SYMBOL_REF)
818 return false;
819
820 /* Easy test for recursion. */
821 if (op == XEXP (DECL_RTL (current_function_decl), 0))
822 return true;
823
824 /* Functions that are not local can be overridden, and thus may
825 not share the same gp. */
826 if (! SYMBOL_REF_LOCAL_P (op))
827 return false;
828
829 /* If -msmall-data is in effect, assume that there is only one GP
830 for the module, and so any local symbol has this property. We
831 need explicit relocations to be able to enforce this for symbols
832 not defined in this unit of translation, however. */
833 if (TARGET_EXPLICIT_RELOCS && TARGET_SMALL_DATA)
834 return true;
835
836 /* Functions that are not external are defined in this UoT,
837 and thus must share the same gp. */
838 return ! SYMBOL_REF_EXTERNAL_P (op);
839 }
840
841 /* Return 1 if OP is a SYMBOL_REF for which we can make a call via bsr. */
842
843 int
844 direct_call_operand (rtx op, enum machine_mode mode)
845 {
846 tree op_decl, cfun_sec, op_sec;
847
848 /* Must share the same GP. */
849 if (!samegp_function_operand (op, mode))
850 return false;
851
852 /* If profiling is implemented via linker tricks, we can't jump
853 to the nogp alternate entry point. Note that current_function_profile
854 would not be correct, since that doesn't indicate if the target
855 function uses profiling. */
856 /* ??? TARGET_PROFILING_NEEDS_GP isn't really the right test,
857 but is approximately correct for the OSF ABIs. Don't know
858 what to do for VMS, NT, or UMK. */
859 if (!TARGET_PROFILING_NEEDS_GP && profile_flag)
860 return false;
861
862 /* Must be a function. In some cases folks create thunks in static
863 data structures and then make calls to them. If we allow the
864 direct call, we'll get an error from the linker about !samegp reloc
865 against a symbol without a .prologue directive. */
866 if (!SYMBOL_REF_FUNCTION_P (op))
867 return false;
868
869 /* Must be "near" so that the branch is assumed to reach. With
870 -msmall-text, this is assumed true of all local symbols. Since
871 we've already checked samegp, locality is already assured. */
872 if (TARGET_SMALL_TEXT)
873 return true;
874
875 /* Otherwise, a decl is "near" if it is defined in the same section. */
876 if (flag_function_sections)
877 return false;
878
879 op_decl = SYMBOL_REF_DECL (op);
880 if (DECL_ONE_ONLY (current_function_decl)
881 || (op_decl && DECL_ONE_ONLY (op_decl)))
882 return false;
883
884 cfun_sec = DECL_SECTION_NAME (current_function_decl);
885 op_sec = op_decl ? DECL_SECTION_NAME (op_decl) : NULL;
886 return ((!cfun_sec && !op_sec)
887 || (cfun_sec && op_sec
888 && strcmp (TREE_STRING_POINTER (cfun_sec),
889 TREE_STRING_POINTER (op_sec)) == 0));
890 }
891
892 /* Return true if OP is a LABEL_REF, or SYMBOL_REF or CONST referencing
893 a (non-tls) variable known to be defined in this file. */
894
895 int
896 local_symbolic_operand (rtx op, enum machine_mode mode)
897 {
898 if (mode != VOIDmode && GET_MODE (op) != VOIDmode && mode != GET_MODE (op))
899 return 0;
900
901 if (GET_CODE (op) == LABEL_REF)
902 return 1;
903
904 if (GET_CODE (op) == CONST
905 && GET_CODE (XEXP (op, 0)) == PLUS
906 && GET_CODE (XEXP (XEXP (op, 0), 1)) == CONST_INT)
907 op = XEXP (XEXP (op, 0), 0);
908
909 if (GET_CODE (op) != SYMBOL_REF)
910 return 0;
911
912 return SYMBOL_REF_LOCAL_P (op) && !SYMBOL_REF_TLS_MODEL (op);
913 }
914
915 /* Return true if OP is a SYMBOL_REF or CONST referencing a variable
916 known to be defined in this file in the small data area. */
917
918 int
919 small_symbolic_operand (rtx op, enum machine_mode mode ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
920 {
921 if (! TARGET_SMALL_DATA)
922 return 0;
923
924 if (mode != VOIDmode && GET_MODE (op) != VOIDmode && mode != GET_MODE (op))
925 return 0;
926
927 if (GET_CODE (op) == CONST
928 && GET_CODE (XEXP (op, 0)) == PLUS
929 && GET_CODE (XEXP (XEXP (op, 0), 1)) == CONST_INT)
930 op = XEXP (XEXP (op, 0), 0);
931
932 if (GET_CODE (op) != SYMBOL_REF)
933 return 0;
934
935 /* ??? There's no encode_section_info equivalent for the rtl
936 constant pool, so SYMBOL_FLAG_SMALL never gets set. */
937 if (CONSTANT_POOL_ADDRESS_P (op))
938 return GET_MODE_SIZE (get_pool_mode (op)) <= g_switch_value;
939
940 return (SYMBOL_REF_LOCAL_P (op)
941 && SYMBOL_REF_SMALL_P (op)
942 && SYMBOL_REF_TLS_MODEL (op) == 0);
943 }
944
945 /* Return true if OP is a SYMBOL_REF or CONST referencing a variable
946 not known (or known not) to be defined in this file. */
947
948 int
949 global_symbolic_operand (rtx op, enum machine_mode mode)
950 {
951 if (mode != VOIDmode && GET_MODE (op) != VOIDmode && mode != GET_MODE (op))
952 return 0;
953
954 if (GET_CODE (op) == CONST
955 && GET_CODE (XEXP (op, 0)) == PLUS
956 && GET_CODE (XEXP (XEXP (op, 0), 1)) == CONST_INT)
957 op = XEXP (XEXP (op, 0), 0);
958
959 if (GET_CODE (op) != SYMBOL_REF)
960 return 0;
961
962 return !SYMBOL_REF_LOCAL_P (op) && !SYMBOL_REF_TLS_MODEL (op);
963 }
964
965 /* Return 1 if OP is a valid operand for the MEM of a CALL insn. */
966
967 int
968 call_operand (rtx op, enum machine_mode mode)
969 {
970 if (mode != Pmode)
971 return 0;
972
973 if (GET_CODE (op) == REG)
974 {
975 if (TARGET_ABI_OSF)
976 {
977 /* Disallow virtual registers to cope with pathalogical test cases
978 such as compile/930117-1.c in which the virtual reg decomposes
979 to the frame pointer. Which is a hard reg that is not $27. */
980 return (REGNO (op) == 27 || REGNO (op) > LAST_VIRTUAL_REGISTER);
981 }
982 else
983 return 1;
984 }
985 if (TARGET_ABI_UNICOSMK)
986 return 0;
987 if (GET_CODE (op) == SYMBOL_REF)
988 return 1;
989
990 return 0;
991 }
992
993 /* Returns 1 if OP is a symbolic operand, i.e. a symbol_ref or a label_ref,
994 possibly with an offset. */
995
996 int
997 symbolic_operand (rtx op, enum machine_mode mode)
998 {
999 if (mode != VOIDmode && GET_MODE (op) != VOIDmode && mode != GET_MODE (op))
1000 return 0;
1001 if (GET_CODE (op) == SYMBOL_REF || GET_CODE (op) == LABEL_REF)
1002 return 1;
1003 if (GET_CODE (op) == CONST
1004 && GET_CODE (XEXP (op,0)) == PLUS
1005 && GET_CODE (XEXP (XEXP (op,0), 0)) == SYMBOL_REF
1006 && GET_CODE (XEXP (XEXP (op,0), 1)) == CONST_INT)
1007 return 1;
1008 return 0;
1009 }
1010
1011 /* Return true if OP is valid for a particular TLS relocation. */
1012
1013 static int
1014 tls_symbolic_operand_1 (rtx op, enum machine_mode mode, int size, int unspec)
1015 {
1016 if (mode != VOIDmode && GET_MODE (op) != VOIDmode && mode != GET_MODE (op))
1017 return 0;
1018
1019 if (GET_CODE (op) != CONST)
1020 return 0;
1021 op = XEXP (op, 0);
1022
1023 if (GET_CODE (op) != UNSPEC || XINT (op, 1) != unspec)
1024 return 0;
1025 op = XVECEXP (op, 0, 0);
1026
1027 if (GET_CODE (op) != SYMBOL_REF)
1028 return 0;
1029
1030 if (SYMBOL_REF_LOCAL_P (op))
1031 {
1032 if (alpha_tls_size > size)
1033 return 0;
1034 }
1035 else
1036 {
1037 if (size != 64)
1038 return 0;
1039 }
1040
1041 switch (SYMBOL_REF_TLS_MODEL (op))
1042 {
1043 case TLS_MODEL_LOCAL_DYNAMIC:
1044 return unspec == UNSPEC_DTPREL;
1045 case TLS_MODEL_INITIAL_EXEC:
1046 return unspec == UNSPEC_TPREL && size == 64;
1047 case TLS_MODEL_LOCAL_EXEC:
1048 return unspec == UNSPEC_TPREL;
1049 default:
1050 abort ();
1051 }
1052 }
1053
1054 /* Return true if OP is valid for 16-bit DTP relative relocations. */
1055
1056 int
1057 dtp16_symbolic_operand (rtx op, enum machine_mode mode)
1058 {
1059 return tls_symbolic_operand_1 (op, mode, 16, UNSPEC_DTPREL);
1060 }
1061
1062 /* Return true if OP is valid for 32-bit DTP relative relocations. */
1063
1064 int
1065 dtp32_symbolic_operand (rtx op, enum machine_mode mode)
1066 {
1067 return tls_symbolic_operand_1 (op, mode, 32, UNSPEC_DTPREL);
1068 }
1069
1070 /* Return true if OP is valid for 64-bit DTP relative relocations. */
1071
1072 int
1073 gotdtp_symbolic_operand (rtx op, enum machine_mode mode)
1074 {
1075 return tls_symbolic_operand_1 (op, mode, 64, UNSPEC_DTPREL);
1076 }
1077
1078 /* Return true if OP is valid for 16-bit TP relative relocations. */
1079
1080 int
1081 tp16_symbolic_operand (rtx op, enum machine_mode mode)
1082 {
1083 return tls_symbolic_operand_1 (op, mode, 16, UNSPEC_TPREL);
1084 }
1085
1086 /* Return true if OP is valid for 32-bit TP relative relocations. */
1087
1088 int
1089 tp32_symbolic_operand (rtx op, enum machine_mode mode)
1090 {
1091 return tls_symbolic_operand_1 (op, mode, 32, UNSPEC_TPREL);
1092 }
1093
1094 /* Return true if OP is valid for 64-bit TP relative relocations. */
1095
1096 int
1097 gottp_symbolic_operand (rtx op, enum machine_mode mode)
1098 {
1099 return tls_symbolic_operand_1 (op, mode, 64, UNSPEC_TPREL);
1100 }
1101
1102 /* Return 1 if OP is a valid Alpha comparison operator. Here we know which
1103 comparisons are valid in which insn. */
1104
1105 int
1106 alpha_comparison_operator (rtx op, enum machine_mode mode)
1107 {
1108 enum rtx_code code = GET_CODE (op);
1109
1110 if (mode != GET_MODE (op) && mode != VOIDmode)
1111 return 0;
1112
1113 return (code == EQ || code == LE || code == LT
1114 || code == LEU || code == LTU);
1115 }
1116
1117 /* Return 1 if OP is a valid Alpha comparison operator against zero.
1118 Here we know which comparisons are valid in which insn. */
1119
1120 int
1121 alpha_zero_comparison_operator (rtx op, enum machine_mode mode)
1122 {
1123 enum rtx_code code = GET_CODE (op);
1124
1125 if (mode != GET_MODE (op) && mode != VOIDmode)
1126 return 0;
1127
1128 return (code == EQ || code == NE || code == LE || code == LT
1129 || code == LEU || code == LTU);
1130 }
1131
1132 /* Return 1 if OP is a valid Alpha swapped comparison operator. */
1133
1134 int
1135 alpha_swapped_comparison_operator (rtx op, enum machine_mode mode)
1136 {
1137 enum rtx_code code = GET_CODE (op);
1138
1139 if ((mode != GET_MODE (op) && mode != VOIDmode)
1140 || GET_RTX_CLASS (code) != '<')
1141 return 0;
1142
1143 code = swap_condition (code);
1144 return (code == EQ || code == LE || code == LT
1145 || code == LEU || code == LTU);
1146 }
1147
1148 /* Return 1 if OP is a signed comparison operation. */
1149
1150 int
1151 signed_comparison_operator (rtx op, enum machine_mode mode ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
1152 {
1153 enum rtx_code code = GET_CODE (op);
1154
1155 if (mode != GET_MODE (op) && mode != VOIDmode)
1156 return 0;
1157
1158 return (code == EQ || code == NE
1159 || code == LE || code == LT
1160 || code == GE || code == GT);
1161 }
1162
1163 /* Return 1 if OP is a valid Alpha floating point comparison operator.
1164 Here we know which comparisons are valid in which insn. */
1165
1166 int
1167 alpha_fp_comparison_operator (rtx op, enum machine_mode mode)
1168 {
1169 enum rtx_code code = GET_CODE (op);
1170
1171 if (mode != GET_MODE (op) && mode != VOIDmode)
1172 return 0;
1173
1174 return (code == EQ || code == LE || code == LT || code == UNORDERED);
1175 }
1176
1177 /* Return 1 if this is a divide or modulus operator. */
1178
1179 int
1180 divmod_operator (rtx op, enum machine_mode mode ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
1181 {
1182 switch (GET_CODE (op))
1183 {
1184 case DIV: case MOD: case UDIV: case UMOD:
1185 return 1;
1186
1187 default:
1188 break;
1189 }
1190
1191 return 0;
1192 }
1193
1194 /* Return 1 if this memory address is a known aligned register plus
1195 a constant. It must be a valid address. This means that we can do
1196 this as an aligned reference plus some offset.
1197
1198 Take into account what reload will do. */
1199
1200 int
1201 aligned_memory_operand (rtx op, enum machine_mode mode)
1202 {
1203 rtx base;
1204
1205 if (reload_in_progress)
1206 {
1207 rtx tmp = op;
1208 if (GET_CODE (tmp) == SUBREG)
1209 tmp = SUBREG_REG (tmp);
1210 if (GET_CODE (tmp) == REG
1211 && REGNO (tmp) >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
1212 {
1213 op = reg_equiv_memory_loc[REGNO (tmp)];
1214 if (op == 0)
1215 return 0;
1216 }
1217 }
1218
1219 if (GET_CODE (op) != MEM
1220 || GET_MODE (op) != mode)
1221 return 0;
1222 op = XEXP (op, 0);
1223
1224 /* LEGITIMIZE_RELOAD_ADDRESS creates (plus (plus reg const_hi) const_lo)
1225 sorts of constructs. Dig for the real base register. */
1226 if (reload_in_progress
1227 && GET_CODE (op) == PLUS
1228 && GET_CODE (XEXP (op, 0)) == PLUS)
1229 base = XEXP (XEXP (op, 0), 0);
1230 else
1231 {
1232 if (! memory_address_p (mode, op))
1233 return 0;
1234 base = (GET_CODE (op) == PLUS ? XEXP (op, 0) : op);
1235 }
1236
1237 return (GET_CODE (base) == REG && REGNO_POINTER_ALIGN (REGNO (base)) >= 32);
1238 }
1239
1240 /* Similar, but return 1 if OP is a MEM which is not alignable. */
1241
1242 int
1243 unaligned_memory_operand (rtx op, enum machine_mode mode)
1244 {
1245 rtx base;
1246
1247 if (reload_in_progress)
1248 {
1249 rtx tmp = op;
1250 if (GET_CODE (tmp) == SUBREG)
1251 tmp = SUBREG_REG (tmp);
1252 if (GET_CODE (tmp) == REG
1253 && REGNO (tmp) >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
1254 {
1255 op = reg_equiv_memory_loc[REGNO (tmp)];
1256 if (op == 0)
1257 return 0;
1258 }
1259 }
1260
1261 if (GET_CODE (op) != MEM
1262 || GET_MODE (op) != mode)
1263 return 0;
1264 op = XEXP (op, 0);
1265
1266 /* LEGITIMIZE_RELOAD_ADDRESS creates (plus (plus reg const_hi) const_lo)
1267 sorts of constructs. Dig for the real base register. */
1268 if (reload_in_progress
1269 && GET_CODE (op) == PLUS
1270 && GET_CODE (XEXP (op, 0)) == PLUS)
1271 base = XEXP (XEXP (op, 0), 0);
1272 else
1273 {
1274 if (! memory_address_p (mode, op))
1275 return 0;
1276 base = (GET_CODE (op) == PLUS ? XEXP (op, 0) : op);
1277 }
1278
1279 return (GET_CODE (base) == REG && REGNO_POINTER_ALIGN (REGNO (base)) < 32);
1280 }
1281
1282 /* Return 1 if OP is either a register or an unaligned memory location. */
1283
1284 int
1285 reg_or_unaligned_mem_operand (rtx op, enum machine_mode mode)
1286 {
1287 return register_operand (op, mode) || unaligned_memory_operand (op, mode);
1288 }
1289
1290 /* Return 1 if OP is any memory location. During reload a pseudo matches. */
1291
1292 int
1293 any_memory_operand (rtx op, enum machine_mode mode ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
1294 {
1295 return (GET_CODE (op) == MEM
1296 || (GET_CODE (op) == SUBREG && GET_CODE (SUBREG_REG (op)) == REG)
1297 || (reload_in_progress && GET_CODE (op) == REG
1298 && REGNO (op) >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
1299 || (reload_in_progress && GET_CODE (op) == SUBREG
1300 && GET_CODE (SUBREG_REG (op)) == REG
1301 && REGNO (SUBREG_REG (op)) >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER));
1302 }
1303
1304 /* Returns 1 if OP is not an eliminable register.
1305
1306 This exists to cure a pathological abort in the s8addq (et al) patterns,
1307
1308 long foo () { long t; bar(); return (long) &t * 26107; }
1309
1310 which run afoul of a hack in reload to cure a (presumably) similar
1311 problem with lea-type instructions on other targets. But there is
1312 one of us and many of them, so work around the problem by selectively
1313 preventing combine from making the optimization. */
1314
1315 int
1316 reg_not_elim_operand (rtx op, enum machine_mode mode)
1317 {
1318 rtx inner = op;
1319 if (GET_CODE (op) == SUBREG)
1320 inner = SUBREG_REG (op);
1321 if (inner == frame_pointer_rtx || inner == arg_pointer_rtx)
1322 return 0;
1323
1324 return register_operand (op, mode);
1325 }
1326
1327 /* Return 1 is OP is a memory location that is not a reference (using
1328 an AND) to an unaligned location. Take into account what reload
1329 will do. */
1330
1331 int
1332 normal_memory_operand (rtx op, enum machine_mode mode ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
1333 {
1334 if (reload_in_progress)
1335 {
1336 rtx tmp = op;
1337 if (GET_CODE (tmp) == SUBREG)
1338 tmp = SUBREG_REG (tmp);
1339 if (GET_CODE (tmp) == REG
1340 && REGNO (tmp) >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
1341 {
1342 op = reg_equiv_memory_loc[REGNO (tmp)];
1343
1344 /* This may not have been assigned an equivalent address if it will
1345 be eliminated. In that case, it doesn't matter what we do. */
1346 if (op == 0)
1347 return 1;
1348 }
1349 }
1350
1351 return GET_CODE (op) == MEM && GET_CODE (XEXP (op, 0)) != AND;
1352 }
1353
1354 /* Accept a register, but not a subreg of any kind. This allows us to
1355 avoid pathological cases in reload wrt data movement common in
1356 int->fp conversion. */
1357
1358 int
1359 reg_no_subreg_operand (rtx op, enum machine_mode mode)
1360 {
1361 if (GET_CODE (op) != REG)
1362 return 0;
1363 return register_operand (op, mode);
1364 }
1365
1366 /* Recognize an addition operation that includes a constant. Used to
1367 convince reload to canonize (plus (plus reg c1) c2) during register
1368 elimination. */
1369
1370 int
1371 addition_operation (rtx op, enum machine_mode mode)
1372 {
1373 if (GET_MODE (op) != mode && mode != VOIDmode)
1374 return 0;
1375 if (GET_CODE (op) == PLUS
1376 && register_operand (XEXP (op, 0), mode)
1377 && GET_CODE (XEXP (op, 1)) == CONST_INT
1378 && CONST_OK_FOR_LETTER_P (INTVAL (XEXP (op, 1)), 'K'))
1379 return 1;
1380 return 0;
1381 }
1382
1383 /* Implements CONST_OK_FOR_LETTER_P. Return true if the value matches
1384 the range defined for C in [I-P]. */
1385
1386 bool
1387 alpha_const_ok_for_letter_p (HOST_WIDE_INT value, int c)
1388 {
1389 switch (c)
1390 {
1391 case 'I':
1392 /* An unsigned 8 bit constant. */
1393 return (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) value < 0x100;
1394 case 'J':
1395 /* The constant zero. */
1396 return value == 0;
1397 case 'K':
1398 /* A signed 16 bit constant. */
1399 return (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) (value + 0x8000) < 0x10000;
1400 case 'L':
1401 /* A shifted signed 16 bit constant appropriate for LDAH. */
1402 return ((value & 0xffff) == 0
1403 && ((value) >> 31 == -1 || value >> 31 == 0));
1404 case 'M':
1405 /* A constant that can be AND'ed with using a ZAP insn. */
1406 return zap_mask (value);
1407 case 'N':
1408 /* A complemented unsigned 8 bit constant. */
1409 return (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) (~ value) < 0x100;
1410 case 'O':
1411 /* A negated unsigned 8 bit constant. */
1412 return (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) (- value) < 0x100;
1413 case 'P':
1414 /* The constant 1, 2 or 3. */
1415 return value == 1 || value == 2 || value == 3;
1416
1417 default:
1418 return false;
1419 }
1420 }
1421
1422 /* Implements CONST_DOUBLE_OK_FOR_LETTER_P. Return true if VALUE
1423 matches for C in [GH]. */
1424
1425 bool
1426 alpha_const_double_ok_for_letter_p (rtx value, int c)
1427 {
1428 switch (c)
1429 {
1430 case 'G':
1431 /* The floating point zero constant. */
1432 return (GET_MODE_CLASS (GET_MODE (value)) == MODE_FLOAT
1433 && value == CONST0_RTX (GET_MODE (value)));
1434
1435 case 'H':
1436 /* A valid operand of a ZAP insn. */
1437 return (GET_MODE (value) == VOIDmode
1438 && zap_mask (CONST_DOUBLE_LOW (value))
1439 && zap_mask (CONST_DOUBLE_HIGH (value)));
1440
1441 default:
1442 return false;
1443 }
1444 }
1445
1446 /* Implements CONST_DOUBLE_OK_FOR_LETTER_P. Return true if VALUE
1447 matches for C. */
1448
1449 bool
1450 alpha_extra_constraint (rtx value, int c)
1451 {
1452 switch (c)
1453 {
1454 case 'Q':
1455 return normal_memory_operand (value, VOIDmode);
1456 case 'R':
1457 return direct_call_operand (value, Pmode);
1458 case 'S':
1459 return (GET_CODE (value) == CONST_INT
1460 && (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) INTVAL (value) < 64);
1461 case 'T':
1462 return GET_CODE (value) == HIGH;
1463 case 'U':
1464 return TARGET_ABI_UNICOSMK && symbolic_operand (value, VOIDmode);
1465 case 'W':
1466 return (GET_CODE (value) == CONST_VECTOR
1467 && value == CONST0_RTX (GET_MODE (value)));
1468 default:
1469 return false;
1470 }
1471 }
1472
1473 /* Return 1 if this function can directly return via $26. */
1474
1475 int
1476 direct_return (void)
1477 {
1478 return (! TARGET_ABI_OPEN_VMS && ! TARGET_ABI_UNICOSMK
1479 && reload_completed
1480 && alpha_sa_size () == 0
1481 && get_frame_size () == 0
1482 && current_function_outgoing_args_size == 0
1483 && current_function_pretend_args_size == 0);
1484 }
1485
1486 /* Return the ADDR_VEC associated with a tablejump insn. */
1487
1488 rtx
1489 alpha_tablejump_addr_vec (rtx insn)
1490 {
1491 rtx tmp;
1492
1493 tmp = JUMP_LABEL (insn);
1494 if (!tmp)
1495 return NULL_RTX;
1496 tmp = NEXT_INSN (tmp);
1497 if (!tmp)
1498 return NULL_RTX;
1499 if (GET_CODE (tmp) == JUMP_INSN
1500 && GET_CODE (PATTERN (tmp)) == ADDR_DIFF_VEC)
1501 return PATTERN (tmp);
1502 return NULL_RTX;
1503 }
1504
1505 /* Return the label of the predicted edge, or CONST0_RTX if we don't know. */
1506
1507 rtx
1508 alpha_tablejump_best_label (rtx insn)
1509 {
1510 rtx jump_table = alpha_tablejump_addr_vec (insn);
1511 rtx best_label = NULL_RTX;
1512
1513 /* ??? Once the CFG doesn't keep getting completely rebuilt, look
1514 there for edge frequency counts from profile data. */
1515
1516 if (jump_table)
1517 {
1518 int n_labels = XVECLEN (jump_table, 1);
1519 int best_count = -1;
1520 int i, j;
1521
1522 for (i = 0; i < n_labels; i++)
1523 {
1524 int count = 1;
1525
1526 for (j = i + 1; j < n_labels; j++)
1527 if (XEXP (XVECEXP (jump_table, 1, i), 0)
1528 == XEXP (XVECEXP (jump_table, 1, j), 0))
1529 count++;
1530
1531 if (count > best_count)
1532 best_count = count, best_label = XVECEXP (jump_table, 1, i);
1533 }
1534 }
1535
1536 return best_label ? best_label : const0_rtx;
1537 }
1538
1539 /* Return the TLS model to use for SYMBOL. */
1540
1541 static enum tls_model
1542 tls_symbolic_operand_type (rtx symbol)
1543 {
1544 enum tls_model model;
1545
1546 if (GET_CODE (symbol) != SYMBOL_REF)
1547 return 0;
1548 model = SYMBOL_REF_TLS_MODEL (symbol);
1549
1550 /* Local-exec with a 64-bit size is the same code as initial-exec. */
1551 if (model == TLS_MODEL_LOCAL_EXEC && alpha_tls_size == 64)
1552 model = TLS_MODEL_INITIAL_EXEC;
1553
1554 return model;
1555 }
1556 \f
1557 /* Return true if the function DECL will share the same GP as any
1558 function in the current unit of translation. */
1559
1560 static bool
1561 decl_has_samegp (tree decl)
1562 {
1563 /* Functions that are not local can be overridden, and thus may
1564 not share the same gp. */
1565 if (!(*targetm.binds_local_p) (decl))
1566 return false;
1567
1568 /* If -msmall-data is in effect, assume that there is only one GP
1569 for the module, and so any local symbol has this property. We
1570 need explicit relocations to be able to enforce this for symbols
1571 not defined in this unit of translation, however. */
1572 if (TARGET_EXPLICIT_RELOCS && TARGET_SMALL_DATA)
1573 return true;
1574
1575 /* Functions that are not external are defined in this UoT. */
1576 /* ??? Irritatingly, static functions not yet emitted are still
1577 marked "external". Apply this to non-static functions only. */
1578 return !TREE_PUBLIC (decl) || !DECL_EXTERNAL (decl);
1579 }
1580
1581 /* Return true if EXP should be placed in the small data section. */
1582
1583 static bool
1584 alpha_in_small_data_p (tree exp)
1585 {
1586 /* We want to merge strings, so we never consider them small data. */
1587 if (TREE_CODE (exp) == STRING_CST)
1588 return false;
1589
1590 if (TREE_CODE (exp) == VAR_DECL && DECL_SECTION_NAME (exp))
1591 {
1592 const char *section = TREE_STRING_POINTER (DECL_SECTION_NAME (exp));
1593 if (strcmp (section, ".sdata") == 0
1594 || strcmp (section, ".sbss") == 0)
1595 return true;
1596 }
1597 else
1598 {
1599 HOST_WIDE_INT size = int_size_in_bytes (TREE_TYPE (exp));
1600
1601 /* If this is an incomplete type with size 0, then we can't put it
1602 in sdata because it might be too big when completed. */
1603 if (size > 0 && (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) size <= g_switch_value)
1604 return true;
1605 }
1606
1607 return false;
1608 }
1609
1610 #if TARGET_ABI_OPEN_VMS
1611 static bool
1612 alpha_linkage_symbol_p (const char *symname)
1613 {
1614 int symlen = strlen (symname);
1615
1616 if (symlen > 4)
1617 return strcmp (&symname [symlen - 4], "..lk") == 0;
1618
1619 return false;
1620 }
1621
1622 #define LINKAGE_SYMBOL_REF_P(X) \
1623 ((GET_CODE (X) == SYMBOL_REF \
1624 && alpha_linkage_symbol_p (XSTR (X, 0))) \
1625 || (GET_CODE (X) == CONST \
1626 && GET_CODE (XEXP (X, 0)) == PLUS \
1627 && GET_CODE (XEXP (XEXP (X, 0), 0)) == SYMBOL_REF \
1628 && alpha_linkage_symbol_p (XSTR (XEXP (XEXP (X, 0), 0), 0))))
1629 #endif
1630
1631 /* legitimate_address_p recognizes an RTL expression that is a valid
1632 memory address for an instruction. The MODE argument is the
1633 machine mode for the MEM expression that wants to use this address.
1634
1635 For Alpha, we have either a constant address or the sum of a
1636 register and a constant address, or just a register. For DImode,
1637 any of those forms can be surrounded with an AND that clear the
1638 low-order three bits; this is an "unaligned" access. */
1639
1640 bool
1641 alpha_legitimate_address_p (enum machine_mode mode, rtx x, int strict)
1642 {
1643 /* If this is an ldq_u type address, discard the outer AND. */
1644 if (mode == DImode
1645 && GET_CODE (x) == AND
1646 && GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 1)) == CONST_INT
1647 && INTVAL (XEXP (x, 1)) == -8)
1648 x = XEXP (x, 0);
1649
1650 /* Discard non-paradoxical subregs. */
1651 if (GET_CODE (x) == SUBREG
1652 && (GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (x))
1653 < GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (x)))))
1654 x = SUBREG_REG (x);
1655
1656 /* Unadorned general registers are valid. */
1657 if (REG_P (x)
1658 && (strict
1659 ? STRICT_REG_OK_FOR_BASE_P (x)
1660 : NONSTRICT_REG_OK_FOR_BASE_P (x)))
1661 return true;
1662
1663 /* Constant addresses (i.e. +/- 32k) are valid. */
1664 if (CONSTANT_ADDRESS_P (x))
1665 return true;
1666
1667 #if TARGET_ABI_OPEN_VMS
1668 if (LINKAGE_SYMBOL_REF_P (x))
1669 return true;
1670 #endif
1671
1672 /* Register plus a small constant offset is valid. */
1673 if (GET_CODE (x) == PLUS)
1674 {
1675 rtx ofs = XEXP (x, 1);
1676 x = XEXP (x, 0);
1677
1678 /* Discard non-paradoxical subregs. */
1679 if (GET_CODE (x) == SUBREG
1680 && (GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (x))
1681 < GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (x)))))
1682 x = SUBREG_REG (x);
1683
1684 if (REG_P (x))
1685 {
1686 if (! strict
1687 && NONSTRICT_REG_OK_FP_BASE_P (x)
1688 && GET_CODE (ofs) == CONST_INT)
1689 return true;
1690 if ((strict
1691 ? STRICT_REG_OK_FOR_BASE_P (x)
1692 : NONSTRICT_REG_OK_FOR_BASE_P (x))
1693 && CONSTANT_ADDRESS_P (ofs))
1694 return true;
1695 }
1696 else if (GET_CODE (x) == ADDRESSOF
1697 && GET_CODE (ofs) == CONST_INT)
1698 return true;
1699 }
1700
1701 /* If we're managing explicit relocations, LO_SUM is valid, as
1702 are small data symbols. */
1703 else if (TARGET_EXPLICIT_RELOCS)
1704 {
1705 if (small_symbolic_operand (x, Pmode))
1706 return true;
1707
1708 if (GET_CODE (x) == LO_SUM)
1709 {
1710 rtx ofs = XEXP (x, 1);
1711 x = XEXP (x, 0);
1712
1713 /* Discard non-paradoxical subregs. */
1714 if (GET_CODE (x) == SUBREG
1715 && (GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (x))
1716 < GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (x)))))
1717 x = SUBREG_REG (x);
1718
1719 /* Must have a valid base register. */
1720 if (! (REG_P (x)
1721 && (strict
1722 ? STRICT_REG_OK_FOR_BASE_P (x)
1723 : NONSTRICT_REG_OK_FOR_BASE_P (x))))
1724 return false;
1725
1726 /* The symbol must be local. */
1727 if (local_symbolic_operand (ofs, Pmode)
1728 || dtp32_symbolic_operand (ofs, Pmode)
1729 || tp32_symbolic_operand (ofs, Pmode))
1730 return true;
1731 }
1732 }
1733
1734 return false;
1735 }
1736
1737 /* Build the SYMBOL_REF for __tls_get_addr. */
1738
1739 static GTY(()) rtx tls_get_addr_libfunc;
1740
1741 static rtx
1742 get_tls_get_addr (void)
1743 {
1744 if (!tls_get_addr_libfunc)
1745 tls_get_addr_libfunc = init_one_libfunc ("__tls_get_addr");
1746 return tls_get_addr_libfunc;
1747 }
1748
1749 /* Try machine-dependent ways of modifying an illegitimate address
1750 to be legitimate. If we find one, return the new, valid address. */
1751
1752 rtx
1753 alpha_legitimize_address (rtx x, rtx scratch,
1754 enum machine_mode mode ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
1755 {
1756 HOST_WIDE_INT addend;
1757
1758 /* If the address is (plus reg const_int) and the CONST_INT is not a
1759 valid offset, compute the high part of the constant and add it to
1760 the register. Then our address is (plus temp low-part-const). */
1761 if (GET_CODE (x) == PLUS
1762 && GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 0)) == REG
1763 && GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 1)) == CONST_INT
1764 && ! CONSTANT_ADDRESS_P (XEXP (x, 1)))
1765 {
1766 addend = INTVAL (XEXP (x, 1));
1767 x = XEXP (x, 0);
1768 goto split_addend;
1769 }
1770
1771 /* If the address is (const (plus FOO const_int)), find the low-order
1772 part of the CONST_INT. Then load FOO plus any high-order part of the
1773 CONST_INT into a register. Our address is (plus reg low-part-const).
1774 This is done to reduce the number of GOT entries. */
1775 if (!no_new_pseudos
1776 && GET_CODE (x) == CONST
1777 && GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 0)) == PLUS
1778 && GET_CODE (XEXP (XEXP (x, 0), 1)) == CONST_INT)
1779 {
1780 addend = INTVAL (XEXP (XEXP (x, 0), 1));
1781 x = force_reg (Pmode, XEXP (XEXP (x, 0), 0));
1782 goto split_addend;
1783 }
1784
1785 /* If we have a (plus reg const), emit the load as in (2), then add
1786 the two registers, and finally generate (plus reg low-part-const) as
1787 our address. */
1788 if (!no_new_pseudos
1789 && GET_CODE (x) == PLUS
1790 && GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 0)) == REG
1791 && GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 1)) == CONST
1792 && GET_CODE (XEXP (XEXP (x, 1), 0)) == PLUS
1793 && GET_CODE (XEXP (XEXP (XEXP (x, 1), 0), 1)) == CONST_INT)
1794 {
1795 addend = INTVAL (XEXP (XEXP (XEXP (x, 1), 0), 1));
1796 x = expand_simple_binop (Pmode, PLUS, XEXP (x, 0),
1797 XEXP (XEXP (XEXP (x, 1), 0), 0),
1798 NULL_RTX, 1, OPTAB_LIB_WIDEN);
1799 goto split_addend;
1800 }
1801
1802 /* If this is a local symbol, split the address into HIGH/LO_SUM parts. */
1803 if (TARGET_EXPLICIT_RELOCS && symbolic_operand (x, Pmode))
1804 {
1805 rtx r0, r16, eqv, tga, tp, insn, dest, seq;
1806
1807 switch (tls_symbolic_operand_type (x))
1808 {
1809 case TLS_MODEL_GLOBAL_DYNAMIC:
1810 start_sequence ();
1811
1812 r0 = gen_rtx_REG (Pmode, 0);
1813 r16 = gen_rtx_REG (Pmode, 16);
1814 tga = get_tls_get_addr ();
1815 dest = gen_reg_rtx (Pmode);
1816 seq = GEN_INT (alpha_next_sequence_number++);
1817
1818 emit_insn (gen_movdi_er_tlsgd (r16, pic_offset_table_rtx, x, seq));
1819 insn = gen_call_value_osf_tlsgd (r0, tga, seq);
1820 insn = emit_call_insn (insn);
1821 CONST_OR_PURE_CALL_P (insn) = 1;
1822 use_reg (&CALL_INSN_FUNCTION_USAGE (insn), r16);
1823
1824 insn = get_insns ();
1825 end_sequence ();
1826
1827 emit_libcall_block (insn, dest, r0, x);
1828 return dest;
1829
1830 case TLS_MODEL_LOCAL_DYNAMIC:
1831 start_sequence ();
1832
1833 r0 = gen_rtx_REG (Pmode, 0);
1834 r16 = gen_rtx_REG (Pmode, 16);
1835 tga = get_tls_get_addr ();
1836 scratch = gen_reg_rtx (Pmode);
1837 seq = GEN_INT (alpha_next_sequence_number++);
1838
1839 emit_insn (gen_movdi_er_tlsldm (r16, pic_offset_table_rtx, seq));
1840 insn = gen_call_value_osf_tlsldm (r0, tga, seq);
1841 insn = emit_call_insn (insn);
1842 CONST_OR_PURE_CALL_P (insn) = 1;
1843 use_reg (&CALL_INSN_FUNCTION_USAGE (insn), r16);
1844
1845 insn = get_insns ();
1846 end_sequence ();
1847
1848 eqv = gen_rtx_UNSPEC (Pmode, gen_rtvec (1, const0_rtx),
1849 UNSPEC_TLSLDM_CALL);
1850 emit_libcall_block (insn, scratch, r0, eqv);
1851
1852 eqv = gen_rtx_UNSPEC (Pmode, gen_rtvec (1, x), UNSPEC_DTPREL);
1853 eqv = gen_rtx_CONST (Pmode, eqv);
1854
1855 if (alpha_tls_size == 64)
1856 {
1857 dest = gen_reg_rtx (Pmode);
1858 emit_insn (gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, dest, eqv));
1859 emit_insn (gen_adddi3 (dest, dest, scratch));
1860 return dest;
1861 }
1862 if (alpha_tls_size == 32)
1863 {
1864 insn = gen_rtx_HIGH (Pmode, eqv);
1865 insn = gen_rtx_PLUS (Pmode, scratch, insn);
1866 scratch = gen_reg_rtx (Pmode);
1867 emit_insn (gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, scratch, insn));
1868 }
1869 return gen_rtx_LO_SUM (Pmode, scratch, eqv);
1870
1871 case TLS_MODEL_INITIAL_EXEC:
1872 eqv = gen_rtx_UNSPEC (Pmode, gen_rtvec (1, x), UNSPEC_TPREL);
1873 eqv = gen_rtx_CONST (Pmode, eqv);
1874 tp = gen_reg_rtx (Pmode);
1875 scratch = gen_reg_rtx (Pmode);
1876 dest = gen_reg_rtx (Pmode);
1877
1878 emit_insn (gen_load_tp (tp));
1879 emit_insn (gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, scratch, eqv));
1880 emit_insn (gen_adddi3 (dest, tp, scratch));
1881 return dest;
1882
1883 case TLS_MODEL_LOCAL_EXEC:
1884 eqv = gen_rtx_UNSPEC (Pmode, gen_rtvec (1, x), UNSPEC_TPREL);
1885 eqv = gen_rtx_CONST (Pmode, eqv);
1886 tp = gen_reg_rtx (Pmode);
1887
1888 emit_insn (gen_load_tp (tp));
1889 if (alpha_tls_size == 32)
1890 {
1891 insn = gen_rtx_HIGH (Pmode, eqv);
1892 insn = gen_rtx_PLUS (Pmode, tp, insn);
1893 tp = gen_reg_rtx (Pmode);
1894 emit_insn (gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, tp, insn));
1895 }
1896 return gen_rtx_LO_SUM (Pmode, tp, eqv);
1897 }
1898
1899 if (local_symbolic_operand (x, Pmode))
1900 {
1901 if (small_symbolic_operand (x, Pmode))
1902 return x;
1903 else
1904 {
1905 if (!no_new_pseudos)
1906 scratch = gen_reg_rtx (Pmode);
1907 emit_insn (gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, scratch,
1908 gen_rtx_HIGH (Pmode, x)));
1909 return gen_rtx_LO_SUM (Pmode, scratch, x);
1910 }
1911 }
1912 }
1913
1914 return NULL;
1915
1916 split_addend:
1917 {
1918 HOST_WIDE_INT low, high;
1919
1920 low = ((addend & 0xffff) ^ 0x8000) - 0x8000;
1921 addend -= low;
1922 high = ((addend & 0xffffffff) ^ 0x80000000) - 0x80000000;
1923 addend -= high;
1924
1925 if (addend)
1926 x = expand_simple_binop (Pmode, PLUS, x, GEN_INT (addend),
1927 (no_new_pseudos ? scratch : NULL_RTX),
1928 1, OPTAB_LIB_WIDEN);
1929 if (high)
1930 x = expand_simple_binop (Pmode, PLUS, x, GEN_INT (high),
1931 (no_new_pseudos ? scratch : NULL_RTX),
1932 1, OPTAB_LIB_WIDEN);
1933
1934 return plus_constant (x, low);
1935 }
1936 }
1937
1938 /* We do not allow indirect calls to be optimized into sibling calls, nor
1939 can we allow a call to a function with a different GP to be optimized
1940 into a sibcall. */
1941
1942 static bool
1943 alpha_function_ok_for_sibcall (tree decl, tree exp ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
1944 {
1945 /* Can't do indirect tail calls, since we don't know if the target
1946 uses the same GP. */
1947 if (!decl)
1948 return false;
1949
1950 /* Otherwise, we can make a tail call if the target function shares
1951 the same GP. */
1952 return decl_has_samegp (decl);
1953 }
1954
1955 /* For TARGET_EXPLICIT_RELOCS, we don't obfuscate a SYMBOL_REF to a
1956 small symbolic operand until after reload. At which point we need
1957 to replace (mem (symbol_ref)) with (mem (lo_sum $29 symbol_ref))
1958 so that sched2 has the proper dependency information. */
1959
1960 static int
1961 some_small_symbolic_operand_1 (rtx *px, void *data ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
1962 {
1963 rtx x = *px;
1964
1965 /* Don't re-split. */
1966 if (GET_CODE (x) == LO_SUM)
1967 return -1;
1968
1969 return small_symbolic_operand (x, Pmode) != 0;
1970 }
1971
1972 int
1973 some_small_symbolic_operand (rtx x, enum machine_mode mode ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
1974 {
1975 return for_each_rtx (&x, some_small_symbolic_operand_1, NULL);
1976 }
1977
1978 static int
1979 split_small_symbolic_operand_1 (rtx *px, void *data ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
1980 {
1981 rtx x = *px;
1982
1983 /* Don't re-split. */
1984 if (GET_CODE (x) == LO_SUM)
1985 return -1;
1986
1987 if (small_symbolic_operand (x, Pmode))
1988 {
1989 x = gen_rtx_LO_SUM (Pmode, pic_offset_table_rtx, x);
1990 *px = x;
1991 return -1;
1992 }
1993
1994 return 0;
1995 }
1996
1997 rtx
1998 split_small_symbolic_operand (rtx x)
1999 {
2000 x = copy_insn (x);
2001 for_each_rtx (&x, split_small_symbolic_operand_1, NULL);
2002 return x;
2003 }
2004
2005 /* Indicate that INSN cannot be duplicated. This is true for any insn
2006 that we've marked with gpdisp relocs, since those have to stay in
2007 1-1 correspondence with one another.
2008
2009 Techinically we could copy them if we could set up a mapping from one
2010 sequence number to another, across the set of insns to be duplicated.
2011 This seems overly complicated and error-prone since interblock motion
2012 from sched-ebb could move one of the pair of insns to a different block. */
2013
2014 static bool
2015 alpha_cannot_copy_insn_p (rtx insn)
2016 {
2017 rtx pat;
2018
2019 if (!reload_completed || !TARGET_EXPLICIT_RELOCS)
2020 return false;
2021
2022 if (GET_CODE (insn) != INSN)
2023 return false;
2024 if (asm_noperands (insn) >= 0)
2025 return false;
2026
2027 pat = PATTERN (insn);
2028 if (GET_CODE (pat) != SET)
2029 return false;
2030 pat = SET_SRC (pat);
2031 if (GET_CODE (pat) == UNSPEC_VOLATILE)
2032 {
2033 if (XINT (pat, 1) == UNSPECV_LDGP1
2034 || XINT (pat, 1) == UNSPECV_PLDGP2)
2035 return true;
2036 }
2037 else if (GET_CODE (pat) == UNSPEC)
2038 {
2039 if (XINT (pat, 1) == UNSPEC_LDGP2)
2040 return true;
2041 }
2042
2043 return false;
2044 }
2045
2046
2047 /* Try a machine-dependent way of reloading an illegitimate address
2048 operand. If we find one, push the reload and return the new rtx. */
2049
2050 rtx
2051 alpha_legitimize_reload_address (rtx x,
2052 enum machine_mode mode ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
2053 int opnum, int type,
2054 int ind_levels ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
2055 {
2056 /* We must recognize output that we have already generated ourselves. */
2057 if (GET_CODE (x) == PLUS
2058 && GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 0)) == PLUS
2059 && GET_CODE (XEXP (XEXP (x, 0), 0)) == REG
2060 && GET_CODE (XEXP (XEXP (x, 0), 1)) == CONST_INT
2061 && GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 1)) == CONST_INT)
2062 {
2063 push_reload (XEXP (x, 0), NULL_RTX, &XEXP (x, 0), NULL,
2064 BASE_REG_CLASS, GET_MODE (x), VOIDmode, 0, 0,
2065 opnum, type);
2066 return x;
2067 }
2068
2069 /* We wish to handle large displacements off a base register by
2070 splitting the addend across an ldah and the mem insn. This
2071 cuts number of extra insns needed from 3 to 1. */
2072 if (GET_CODE (x) == PLUS
2073 && GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 0)) == REG
2074 && REGNO (XEXP (x, 0)) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
2075 && REGNO_OK_FOR_BASE_P (REGNO (XEXP (x, 0)))
2076 && GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 1)) == CONST_INT)
2077 {
2078 HOST_WIDE_INT val = INTVAL (XEXP (x, 1));
2079 HOST_WIDE_INT low = ((val & 0xffff) ^ 0x8000) - 0x8000;
2080 HOST_WIDE_INT high
2081 = (((val - low) & 0xffffffff) ^ 0x80000000) - 0x80000000;
2082
2083 /* Check for 32-bit overflow. */
2084 if (high + low != val)
2085 return NULL_RTX;
2086
2087 /* Reload the high part into a base reg; leave the low part
2088 in the mem directly. */
2089 x = gen_rtx_PLUS (GET_MODE (x),
2090 gen_rtx_PLUS (GET_MODE (x), XEXP (x, 0),
2091 GEN_INT (high)),
2092 GEN_INT (low));
2093
2094 push_reload (XEXP (x, 0), NULL_RTX, &XEXP (x, 0), NULL,
2095 BASE_REG_CLASS, GET_MODE (x), VOIDmode, 0, 0,
2096 opnum, type);
2097 return x;
2098 }
2099
2100 return NULL_RTX;
2101 }
2102 \f
2103 /* Compute a (partial) cost for rtx X. Return true if the complete
2104 cost has been computed, and false if subexpressions should be
2105 scanned. In either case, *TOTAL contains the cost result. */
2106
2107 static bool
2108 alpha_rtx_costs (rtx x, int code, int outer_code, int *total)
2109 {
2110 enum machine_mode mode = GET_MODE (x);
2111 bool float_mode_p = FLOAT_MODE_P (mode);
2112
2113 switch (code)
2114 {
2115 /* If this is an 8-bit constant, return zero since it can be used
2116 nearly anywhere with no cost. If it is a valid operand for an
2117 ADD or AND, likewise return 0 if we know it will be used in that
2118 context. Otherwise, return 2 since it might be used there later.
2119 All other constants take at least two insns. */
2120 case CONST_INT:
2121 if (INTVAL (x) >= 0 && INTVAL (x) < 256)
2122 {
2123 *total = 0;
2124 return true;
2125 }
2126 /* FALLTHRU */
2127
2128 case CONST_DOUBLE:
2129 if (x == CONST0_RTX (mode))
2130 *total = 0;
2131 else if ((outer_code == PLUS && add_operand (x, VOIDmode))
2132 || (outer_code == AND && and_operand (x, VOIDmode)))
2133 *total = 0;
2134 else if (add_operand (x, VOIDmode) || and_operand (x, VOIDmode))
2135 *total = 2;
2136 else
2137 *total = COSTS_N_INSNS (2);
2138 return true;
2139
2140 case CONST:
2141 case SYMBOL_REF:
2142 case LABEL_REF:
2143 if (TARGET_EXPLICIT_RELOCS && small_symbolic_operand (x, VOIDmode))
2144 *total = COSTS_N_INSNS (outer_code != MEM);
2145 else if (TARGET_EXPLICIT_RELOCS && local_symbolic_operand (x, VOIDmode))
2146 *total = COSTS_N_INSNS (1 + (outer_code != MEM));
2147 else if (tls_symbolic_operand_type (x))
2148 /* Estimate of cost for call_pal rduniq. */
2149 *total = COSTS_N_INSNS (15);
2150 else
2151 /* Otherwise we do a load from the GOT. */
2152 *total = COSTS_N_INSNS (alpha_memory_latency);
2153 return true;
2154
2155 case PLUS:
2156 case MINUS:
2157 if (float_mode_p)
2158 *total = alpha_rtx_cost_data[alpha_cpu].fp_add;
2159 else if (GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 0)) == MULT
2160 && const48_operand (XEXP (XEXP (x, 0), 1), VOIDmode))
2161 {
2162 *total = (rtx_cost (XEXP (XEXP (x, 0), 0), outer_code)
2163 + rtx_cost (XEXP (x, 1), outer_code) + 2);
2164 return true;
2165 }
2166 return false;
2167
2168 case MULT:
2169 if (float_mode_p)
2170 *total = alpha_rtx_cost_data[alpha_cpu].fp_mult;
2171 else if (mode == DImode)
2172 *total = alpha_rtx_cost_data[alpha_cpu].int_mult_di;
2173 else
2174 *total = alpha_rtx_cost_data[alpha_cpu].int_mult_si;
2175 return false;
2176
2177 case ASHIFT:
2178 if (GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 1)) == CONST_INT
2179 && INTVAL (XEXP (x, 1)) <= 3)
2180 {
2181 *total = COSTS_N_INSNS (1);
2182 return false;
2183 }
2184 /* FALLTHRU */
2185
2186 case ASHIFTRT:
2187 case LSHIFTRT:
2188 *total = alpha_rtx_cost_data[alpha_cpu].int_shift;
2189 return false;
2190
2191 case IF_THEN_ELSE:
2192 if (float_mode_p)
2193 *total = alpha_rtx_cost_data[alpha_cpu].fp_add;
2194 else
2195 *total = alpha_rtx_cost_data[alpha_cpu].int_cmov;
2196 return false;
2197
2198 case DIV:
2199 case UDIV:
2200 case MOD:
2201 case UMOD:
2202 if (!float_mode_p)
2203 *total = COSTS_N_INSNS (70); /* ??? */
2204 else if (mode == SFmode)
2205 *total = alpha_rtx_cost_data[alpha_cpu].fp_div_sf;
2206 else
2207 *total = alpha_rtx_cost_data[alpha_cpu].fp_div_df;
2208 return false;
2209
2210 case MEM:
2211 *total = COSTS_N_INSNS (alpha_memory_latency);
2212 return true;
2213
2214 case NEG:
2215 if (! float_mode_p)
2216 {
2217 *total = COSTS_N_INSNS (1);
2218 return false;
2219 }
2220 /* FALLTHRU */
2221
2222 case ABS:
2223 if (! float_mode_p)
2224 {
2225 *total = COSTS_N_INSNS (1) + alpha_rtx_cost_data[alpha_cpu].int_cmov;
2226 return false;
2227 }
2228 /* FALLTHRU */
2229
2230 case FLOAT:
2231 case UNSIGNED_FLOAT:
2232 case FIX:
2233 case UNSIGNED_FIX:
2234 case FLOAT_EXTEND:
2235 case FLOAT_TRUNCATE:
2236 *total = alpha_rtx_cost_data[alpha_cpu].fp_add;
2237 return false;
2238
2239 default:
2240 return false;
2241 }
2242 }
2243 \f
2244 /* REF is an alignable memory location. Place an aligned SImode
2245 reference into *PALIGNED_MEM and the number of bits to shift into
2246 *PBITNUM. SCRATCH is a free register for use in reloading out
2247 of range stack slots. */
2248
2249 void
2250 get_aligned_mem (rtx ref, rtx *paligned_mem, rtx *pbitnum)
2251 {
2252 rtx base;
2253 HOST_WIDE_INT offset = 0;
2254
2255 if (GET_CODE (ref) != MEM)
2256 abort ();
2257
2258 if (reload_in_progress
2259 && ! memory_address_p (GET_MODE (ref), XEXP (ref, 0)))
2260 {
2261 base = find_replacement (&XEXP (ref, 0));
2262
2263 if (! memory_address_p (GET_MODE (ref), base))
2264 abort ();
2265 }
2266 else
2267 {
2268 base = XEXP (ref, 0);
2269 }
2270
2271 if (GET_CODE (base) == PLUS)
2272 offset += INTVAL (XEXP (base, 1)), base = XEXP (base, 0);
2273
2274 *paligned_mem
2275 = widen_memory_access (ref, SImode, (offset & ~3) - offset);
2276
2277 if (WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN)
2278 *pbitnum = GEN_INT (32 - (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (GET_MODE (ref))
2279 + (offset & 3) * 8));
2280 else
2281 *pbitnum = GEN_INT ((offset & 3) * 8);
2282 }
2283
2284 /* Similar, but just get the address. Handle the two reload cases.
2285 Add EXTRA_OFFSET to the address we return. */
2286
2287 rtx
2288 get_unaligned_address (rtx ref, int extra_offset)
2289 {
2290 rtx base;
2291 HOST_WIDE_INT offset = 0;
2292
2293 if (GET_CODE (ref) != MEM)
2294 abort ();
2295
2296 if (reload_in_progress
2297 && ! memory_address_p (GET_MODE (ref), XEXP (ref, 0)))
2298 {
2299 base = find_replacement (&XEXP (ref, 0));
2300
2301 if (! memory_address_p (GET_MODE (ref), base))
2302 abort ();
2303 }
2304 else
2305 {
2306 base = XEXP (ref, 0);
2307 }
2308
2309 if (GET_CODE (base) == PLUS)
2310 offset += INTVAL (XEXP (base, 1)), base = XEXP (base, 0);
2311
2312 return plus_constant (base, offset + extra_offset);
2313 }
2314
2315 /* On the Alpha, all (non-symbolic) constants except zero go into
2316 a floating-point register via memory. Note that we cannot
2317 return anything that is not a subset of CLASS, and that some
2318 symbolic constants cannot be dropped to memory. */
2319
2320 enum reg_class
2321 alpha_preferred_reload_class(rtx x, enum reg_class class)
2322 {
2323 /* Zero is present in any register class. */
2324 if (x == CONST0_RTX (GET_MODE (x)))
2325 return class;
2326
2327 /* These sorts of constants we can easily drop to memory. */
2328 if (GET_CODE (x) == CONST_INT || GET_CODE (x) == CONST_DOUBLE)
2329 {
2330 if (class == FLOAT_REGS)
2331 return NO_REGS;
2332 if (class == ALL_REGS)
2333 return GENERAL_REGS;
2334 return class;
2335 }
2336
2337 /* All other kinds of constants should not (and in the case of HIGH
2338 cannot) be dropped to memory -- instead we use a GENERAL_REGS
2339 secondary reload. */
2340 if (CONSTANT_P (x))
2341 return (class == ALL_REGS ? GENERAL_REGS : class);
2342
2343 return class;
2344 }
2345
2346 /* Loading and storing HImode or QImode values to and from memory
2347 usually requires a scratch register. The exceptions are loading
2348 QImode and HImode from an aligned address to a general register
2349 unless byte instructions are permitted.
2350
2351 We also cannot load an unaligned address or a paradoxical SUBREG
2352 into an FP register.
2353
2354 We also cannot do integral arithmetic into FP regs, as might result
2355 from register elimination into a DImode fp register. */
2356
2357 enum reg_class
2358 secondary_reload_class (enum reg_class class, enum machine_mode mode,
2359 rtx x, int in)
2360 {
2361 if ((mode == QImode || mode == HImode) && ! TARGET_BWX)
2362 {
2363 if (GET_CODE (x) == MEM
2364 || (GET_CODE (x) == REG && REGNO (x) >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
2365 || (GET_CODE (x) == SUBREG
2366 && (GET_CODE (SUBREG_REG (x)) == MEM
2367 || (GET_CODE (SUBREG_REG (x)) == REG
2368 && REGNO (SUBREG_REG (x)) >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER))))
2369 {
2370 if (!in || !aligned_memory_operand(x, mode))
2371 return GENERAL_REGS;
2372 }
2373 }
2374
2375 if (class == FLOAT_REGS)
2376 {
2377 if (GET_CODE (x) == MEM && GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 0)) == AND)
2378 return GENERAL_REGS;
2379
2380 if (GET_CODE (x) == SUBREG
2381 && (GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (x))
2382 > GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (x)))))
2383 return GENERAL_REGS;
2384
2385 if (in && INTEGRAL_MODE_P (mode)
2386 && ! (memory_operand (x, mode) || x == const0_rtx))
2387 return GENERAL_REGS;
2388 }
2389
2390 return NO_REGS;
2391 }
2392 \f
2393 /* Subfunction of the following function. Update the flags of any MEM
2394 found in part of X. */
2395
2396 static void
2397 alpha_set_memflags_1 (rtx x, int in_struct_p, int volatile_p, int unchanging_p)
2398 {
2399 int i;
2400
2401 switch (GET_CODE (x))
2402 {
2403 case SEQUENCE:
2404 abort ();
2405
2406 case PARALLEL:
2407 for (i = XVECLEN (x, 0) - 1; i >= 0; i--)
2408 alpha_set_memflags_1 (XVECEXP (x, 0, i), in_struct_p, volatile_p,
2409 unchanging_p);
2410 break;
2411
2412 case INSN:
2413 alpha_set_memflags_1 (PATTERN (x), in_struct_p, volatile_p,
2414 unchanging_p);
2415 break;
2416
2417 case SET:
2418 alpha_set_memflags_1 (SET_DEST (x), in_struct_p, volatile_p,
2419 unchanging_p);
2420 alpha_set_memflags_1 (SET_SRC (x), in_struct_p, volatile_p,
2421 unchanging_p);
2422 break;
2423
2424 case MEM:
2425 MEM_IN_STRUCT_P (x) = in_struct_p;
2426 MEM_VOLATILE_P (x) = volatile_p;
2427 RTX_UNCHANGING_P (x) = unchanging_p;
2428 /* Sadly, we cannot use alias sets because the extra aliasing
2429 produced by the AND interferes. Given that two-byte quantities
2430 are the only thing we would be able to differentiate anyway,
2431 there does not seem to be any point in convoluting the early
2432 out of the alias check. */
2433 break;
2434
2435 default:
2436 break;
2437 }
2438 }
2439
2440 /* Given INSN, which is an INSN list or the PATTERN of a single insn
2441 generated to perform a memory operation, look for any MEMs in either
2442 a SET_DEST or a SET_SRC and copy the in-struct, unchanging, and
2443 volatile flags from REF into each of the MEMs found. If REF is not
2444 a MEM, don't do anything. */
2445
2446 void
2447 alpha_set_memflags (rtx insn, rtx ref)
2448 {
2449 int in_struct_p, volatile_p, unchanging_p;
2450
2451 if (GET_CODE (ref) != MEM)
2452 return;
2453
2454 in_struct_p = MEM_IN_STRUCT_P (ref);
2455 volatile_p = MEM_VOLATILE_P (ref);
2456 unchanging_p = RTX_UNCHANGING_P (ref);
2457
2458 /* This is only called from alpha.md, after having had something
2459 generated from one of the insn patterns. So if everything is
2460 zero, the pattern is already up-to-date. */
2461 if (! in_struct_p && ! volatile_p && ! unchanging_p)
2462 return;
2463
2464 alpha_set_memflags_1 (insn, in_struct_p, volatile_p, unchanging_p);
2465 }
2466 \f
2467 /* Internal routine for alpha_emit_set_const to check for N or below insns. */
2468
2469 static rtx
2470 alpha_emit_set_const_1 (rtx target, enum machine_mode mode,
2471 HOST_WIDE_INT c, int n)
2472 {
2473 HOST_WIDE_INT new;
2474 int i, bits;
2475 /* Use a pseudo if highly optimizing and still generating RTL. */
2476 rtx subtarget
2477 = (flag_expensive_optimizations && !no_new_pseudos ? 0 : target);
2478 rtx temp, insn;
2479
2480 /* If this is a sign-extended 32-bit constant, we can do this in at most
2481 three insns, so do it if we have enough insns left. We always have
2482 a sign-extended 32-bit constant when compiling on a narrow machine. */
2483
2484 if (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT != 64
2485 || c >> 31 == -1 || c >> 31 == 0)
2486 {
2487 HOST_WIDE_INT low = ((c & 0xffff) ^ 0x8000) - 0x8000;
2488 HOST_WIDE_INT tmp1 = c - low;
2489 HOST_WIDE_INT high = (((tmp1 >> 16) & 0xffff) ^ 0x8000) - 0x8000;
2490 HOST_WIDE_INT extra = 0;
2491
2492 /* If HIGH will be interpreted as negative but the constant is
2493 positive, we must adjust it to do two ldha insns. */
2494
2495 if ((high & 0x8000) != 0 && c >= 0)
2496 {
2497 extra = 0x4000;
2498 tmp1 -= 0x40000000;
2499 high = ((tmp1 >> 16) & 0xffff) - 2 * ((tmp1 >> 16) & 0x8000);
2500 }
2501
2502 if (c == low || (low == 0 && extra == 0))
2503 {
2504 /* We used to use copy_to_suggested_reg (GEN_INT (c), target, mode)
2505 but that meant that we can't handle INT_MIN on 32-bit machines
2506 (like NT/Alpha), because we recurse indefinitely through
2507 emit_move_insn to gen_movdi. So instead, since we know exactly
2508 what we want, create it explicitly. */
2509
2510 if (target == NULL)
2511 target = gen_reg_rtx (mode);
2512 emit_insn (gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, target, GEN_INT (c)));
2513 return target;
2514 }
2515 else if (n >= 2 + (extra != 0))
2516 {
2517 temp = copy_to_suggested_reg (GEN_INT (high << 16), subtarget, mode);
2518
2519 /* As of 2002-02-23, addsi3 is only available when not optimizing.
2520 This means that if we go through expand_binop, we'll try to
2521 generate extensions, etc, which will require new pseudos, which
2522 will fail during some split phases. The SImode add patterns
2523 still exist, but are not named. So build the insns by hand. */
2524
2525 if (extra != 0)
2526 {
2527 if (! subtarget)
2528 subtarget = gen_reg_rtx (mode);
2529 insn = gen_rtx_PLUS (mode, temp, GEN_INT (extra << 16));
2530 insn = gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, subtarget, insn);
2531 emit_insn (insn);
2532 temp = subtarget;
2533 }
2534
2535 if (target == NULL)
2536 target = gen_reg_rtx (mode);
2537 insn = gen_rtx_PLUS (mode, temp, GEN_INT (low));
2538 insn = gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, target, insn);
2539 emit_insn (insn);
2540 return target;
2541 }
2542 }
2543
2544 /* If we couldn't do it that way, try some other methods. But if we have
2545 no instructions left, don't bother. Likewise, if this is SImode and
2546 we can't make pseudos, we can't do anything since the expand_binop
2547 and expand_unop calls will widen and try to make pseudos. */
2548
2549 if (n == 1 || (mode == SImode && no_new_pseudos))
2550 return 0;
2551
2552 /* Next, see if we can load a related constant and then shift and possibly
2553 negate it to get the constant we want. Try this once each increasing
2554 numbers of insns. */
2555
2556 for (i = 1; i < n; i++)
2557 {
2558 /* First, see if minus some low bits, we've an easy load of
2559 high bits. */
2560
2561 new = ((c & 0xffff) ^ 0x8000) - 0x8000;
2562 if (new != 0
2563 && (temp = alpha_emit_set_const (subtarget, mode, c - new, i)) != 0)
2564 return expand_binop (mode, add_optab, temp, GEN_INT (new),
2565 target, 0, OPTAB_WIDEN);
2566
2567 /* Next try complementing. */
2568 if ((temp = alpha_emit_set_const (subtarget, mode, ~ c, i)) != 0)
2569 return expand_unop (mode, one_cmpl_optab, temp, target, 0);
2570
2571 /* Next try to form a constant and do a left shift. We can do this
2572 if some low-order bits are zero; the exact_log2 call below tells
2573 us that information. The bits we are shifting out could be any
2574 value, but here we'll just try the 0- and sign-extended forms of
2575 the constant. To try to increase the chance of having the same
2576 constant in more than one insn, start at the highest number of
2577 bits to shift, but try all possibilities in case a ZAPNOT will
2578 be useful. */
2579
2580 if ((bits = exact_log2 (c & - c)) > 0)
2581 for (; bits > 0; bits--)
2582 if ((temp = (alpha_emit_set_const
2583 (subtarget, mode, c >> bits, i))) != 0
2584 || ((temp = (alpha_emit_set_const
2585 (subtarget, mode,
2586 ((unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) c) >> bits, i)))
2587 != 0))
2588 return expand_binop (mode, ashl_optab, temp, GEN_INT (bits),
2589 target, 0, OPTAB_WIDEN);
2590
2591 /* Now try high-order zero bits. Here we try the shifted-in bits as
2592 all zero and all ones. Be careful to avoid shifting outside the
2593 mode and to avoid shifting outside the host wide int size. */
2594 /* On narrow hosts, don't shift a 1 into the high bit, since we'll
2595 confuse the recursive call and set all of the high 32 bits. */
2596
2597 if ((bits = (MIN (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT, GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) * 8)
2598 - floor_log2 (c) - 1 - (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT < 64))) > 0)
2599 for (; bits > 0; bits--)
2600 if ((temp = alpha_emit_set_const (subtarget, mode,
2601 c << bits, i)) != 0
2602 || ((temp = (alpha_emit_set_const
2603 (subtarget, mode,
2604 ((c << bits) | (((HOST_WIDE_INT) 1 << bits) - 1)),
2605 i)))
2606 != 0))
2607 return expand_binop (mode, lshr_optab, temp, GEN_INT (bits),
2608 target, 1, OPTAB_WIDEN);
2609
2610 /* Now try high-order 1 bits. We get that with a sign-extension.
2611 But one bit isn't enough here. Be careful to avoid shifting outside
2612 the mode and to avoid shifting outside the host wide int size. */
2613
2614 if ((bits = (MIN (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT, GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) * 8)
2615 - floor_log2 (~ c) - 2)) > 0)
2616 for (; bits > 0; bits--)
2617 if ((temp = alpha_emit_set_const (subtarget, mode,
2618 c << bits, i)) != 0
2619 || ((temp = (alpha_emit_set_const
2620 (subtarget, mode,
2621 ((c << bits) | (((HOST_WIDE_INT) 1 << bits) - 1)),
2622 i)))
2623 != 0))
2624 return expand_binop (mode, ashr_optab, temp, GEN_INT (bits),
2625 target, 0, OPTAB_WIDEN);
2626 }
2627
2628 #if HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT == 64
2629 /* Finally, see if can load a value into the target that is the same as the
2630 constant except that all bytes that are 0 are changed to be 0xff. If we
2631 can, then we can do a ZAPNOT to obtain the desired constant. */
2632
2633 new = c;
2634 for (i = 0; i < 64; i += 8)
2635 if ((new & ((HOST_WIDE_INT) 0xff << i)) == 0)
2636 new |= (HOST_WIDE_INT) 0xff << i;
2637
2638 /* We are only called for SImode and DImode. If this is SImode, ensure that
2639 we are sign extended to a full word. */
2640
2641 if (mode == SImode)
2642 new = ((new & 0xffffffff) ^ 0x80000000) - 0x80000000;
2643
2644 if (new != c && new != -1
2645 && (temp = alpha_emit_set_const (subtarget, mode, new, n - 1)) != 0)
2646 return expand_binop (mode, and_optab, temp, GEN_INT (c | ~ new),
2647 target, 0, OPTAB_WIDEN);
2648 #endif
2649
2650 return 0;
2651 }
2652
2653 /* Try to output insns to set TARGET equal to the constant C if it can be
2654 done in less than N insns. Do all computations in MODE. Returns the place
2655 where the output has been placed if it can be done and the insns have been
2656 emitted. If it would take more than N insns, zero is returned and no
2657 insns and emitted. */
2658
2659 rtx
2660 alpha_emit_set_const (rtx target, enum machine_mode mode,
2661 HOST_WIDE_INT c, int n)
2662 {
2663 rtx result = 0;
2664 rtx orig_target = target;
2665 int i;
2666
2667 /* If we can't make any pseudos, TARGET is an SImode hard register, we
2668 can't load this constant in one insn, do this in DImode. */
2669 if (no_new_pseudos && mode == SImode
2670 && GET_CODE (target) == REG && REGNO (target) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
2671 && (result = alpha_emit_set_const_1 (target, mode, c, 1)) == 0)
2672 {
2673 target = gen_lowpart (DImode, target);
2674 mode = DImode;
2675 }
2676
2677 /* Try 1 insn, then 2, then up to N. */
2678 for (i = 1; i <= n; i++)
2679 {
2680 result = alpha_emit_set_const_1 (target, mode, c, i);
2681 if (result)
2682 {
2683 rtx insn = get_last_insn ();
2684 rtx set = single_set (insn);
2685 if (! CONSTANT_P (SET_SRC (set)))
2686 set_unique_reg_note (get_last_insn (), REG_EQUAL, GEN_INT (c));
2687 break;
2688 }
2689 }
2690
2691 /* Allow for the case where we changed the mode of TARGET. */
2692 if (result == target)
2693 result = orig_target;
2694
2695 return result;
2696 }
2697
2698 /* Having failed to find a 3 insn sequence in alpha_emit_set_const,
2699 fall back to a straight forward decomposition. We do this to avoid
2700 exponential run times encountered when looking for longer sequences
2701 with alpha_emit_set_const. */
2702
2703 rtx
2704 alpha_emit_set_long_const (rtx target, HOST_WIDE_INT c1, HOST_WIDE_INT c2)
2705 {
2706 HOST_WIDE_INT d1, d2, d3, d4;
2707
2708 /* Decompose the entire word */
2709 #if HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT >= 64
2710 if (c2 != -(c1 < 0))
2711 abort ();
2712 d1 = ((c1 & 0xffff) ^ 0x8000) - 0x8000;
2713 c1 -= d1;
2714 d2 = ((c1 & 0xffffffff) ^ 0x80000000) - 0x80000000;
2715 c1 = (c1 - d2) >> 32;
2716 d3 = ((c1 & 0xffff) ^ 0x8000) - 0x8000;
2717 c1 -= d3;
2718 d4 = ((c1 & 0xffffffff) ^ 0x80000000) - 0x80000000;
2719 if (c1 != d4)
2720 abort ();
2721 #else
2722 d1 = ((c1 & 0xffff) ^ 0x8000) - 0x8000;
2723 c1 -= d1;
2724 d2 = ((c1 & 0xffffffff) ^ 0x80000000) - 0x80000000;
2725 if (c1 != d2)
2726 abort ();
2727 c2 += (d2 < 0);
2728 d3 = ((c2 & 0xffff) ^ 0x8000) - 0x8000;
2729 c2 -= d3;
2730 d4 = ((c2 & 0xffffffff) ^ 0x80000000) - 0x80000000;
2731 if (c2 != d4)
2732 abort ();
2733 #endif
2734
2735 /* Construct the high word */
2736 if (d4)
2737 {
2738 emit_move_insn (target, GEN_INT (d4));
2739 if (d3)
2740 emit_move_insn (target, gen_rtx_PLUS (DImode, target, GEN_INT (d3)));
2741 }
2742 else
2743 emit_move_insn (target, GEN_INT (d3));
2744
2745 /* Shift it into place */
2746 emit_move_insn (target, gen_rtx_ASHIFT (DImode, target, GEN_INT (32)));
2747
2748 /* Add in the low bits. */
2749 if (d2)
2750 emit_move_insn (target, gen_rtx_PLUS (DImode, target, GEN_INT (d2)));
2751 if (d1)
2752 emit_move_insn (target, gen_rtx_PLUS (DImode, target, GEN_INT (d1)));
2753
2754 return target;
2755 }
2756
2757 /* Expand a move instruction; return true if all work is done.
2758 We don't handle non-bwx subword loads here. */
2759
2760 bool
2761 alpha_expand_mov (enum machine_mode mode, rtx *operands)
2762 {
2763 /* If the output is not a register, the input must be. */
2764 if (GET_CODE (operands[0]) == MEM
2765 && ! reg_or_0_operand (operands[1], mode))
2766 operands[1] = force_reg (mode, operands[1]);
2767
2768 /* Allow legitimize_address to perform some simplifications. */
2769 if (mode == Pmode && symbolic_operand (operands[1], mode))
2770 {
2771 rtx tmp;
2772
2773 /* With RTL inlining, at -O3, rtl is generated, stored, then actually
2774 compiled at the end of compilation. In the meantime, someone can
2775 re-encode-section-info on some symbol changing it e.g. from global
2776 to local-not-small. If this happens, we'd have emitted a plain
2777 load rather than a high+losum load and not recognize the insn.
2778
2779 So if rtl inlining is in effect, we delay the global/not-global
2780 decision until rest_of_compilation by wrapping it in an
2781 UNSPEC_SYMBOL. */
2782 if (TARGET_EXPLICIT_RELOCS && flag_inline_functions
2783 && rtx_equal_function_value_matters
2784 && global_symbolic_operand (operands[1], mode))
2785 {
2786 emit_insn (gen_movdi_er_maybe_g (operands[0], operands[1]));
2787 return true;
2788 }
2789
2790 tmp = alpha_legitimize_address (operands[1], operands[0], mode);
2791 if (tmp)
2792 {
2793 if (tmp == operands[0])
2794 return true;
2795 operands[1] = tmp;
2796 return false;
2797 }
2798 }
2799
2800 /* Early out for non-constants and valid constants. */
2801 if (! CONSTANT_P (operands[1]) || input_operand (operands[1], mode))
2802 return false;
2803
2804 /* Split large integers. */
2805 if (GET_CODE (operands[1]) == CONST_INT
2806 || GET_CODE (operands[1]) == CONST_DOUBLE)
2807 {
2808 HOST_WIDE_INT i0, i1;
2809 rtx temp = NULL_RTX;
2810
2811 if (GET_CODE (operands[1]) == CONST_INT)
2812 {
2813 i0 = INTVAL (operands[1]);
2814 i1 = -(i0 < 0);
2815 }
2816 else if (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT >= 64)
2817 {
2818 i0 = CONST_DOUBLE_LOW (operands[1]);
2819 i1 = -(i0 < 0);
2820 }
2821 else
2822 {
2823 i0 = CONST_DOUBLE_LOW (operands[1]);
2824 i1 = CONST_DOUBLE_HIGH (operands[1]);
2825 }
2826
2827 if (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT >= 64 || i1 == -(i0 < 0))
2828 temp = alpha_emit_set_const (operands[0], mode, i0, 3);
2829
2830 if (!temp && TARGET_BUILD_CONSTANTS)
2831 temp = alpha_emit_set_long_const (operands[0], i0, i1);
2832
2833 if (temp)
2834 {
2835 if (rtx_equal_p (operands[0], temp))
2836 return true;
2837 operands[1] = temp;
2838 return false;
2839 }
2840 }
2841
2842 /* Otherwise we've nothing left but to drop the thing to memory. */
2843 operands[1] = force_const_mem (mode, operands[1]);
2844 if (reload_in_progress)
2845 {
2846 emit_move_insn (operands[0], XEXP (operands[1], 0));
2847 operands[1] = copy_rtx (operands[1]);
2848 XEXP (operands[1], 0) = operands[0];
2849 }
2850 else
2851 operands[1] = validize_mem (operands[1]);
2852 return false;
2853 }
2854
2855 /* Expand a non-bwx QImode or HImode move instruction;
2856 return true if all work is done. */
2857
2858 bool
2859 alpha_expand_mov_nobwx (enum machine_mode mode, rtx *operands)
2860 {
2861 /* If the output is not a register, the input must be. */
2862 if (GET_CODE (operands[0]) == MEM)
2863 operands[1] = force_reg (mode, operands[1]);
2864
2865 /* Handle four memory cases, unaligned and aligned for either the input
2866 or the output. The only case where we can be called during reload is
2867 for aligned loads; all other cases require temporaries. */
2868
2869 if (GET_CODE (operands[1]) == MEM
2870 || (GET_CODE (operands[1]) == SUBREG
2871 && GET_CODE (SUBREG_REG (operands[1])) == MEM)
2872 || (reload_in_progress && GET_CODE (operands[1]) == REG
2873 && REGNO (operands[1]) >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
2874 || (reload_in_progress && GET_CODE (operands[1]) == SUBREG
2875 && GET_CODE (SUBREG_REG (operands[1])) == REG
2876 && REGNO (SUBREG_REG (operands[1])) >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER))
2877 {
2878 if (aligned_memory_operand (operands[1], mode))
2879 {
2880 if (reload_in_progress)
2881 {
2882 emit_insn ((mode == QImode
2883 ? gen_reload_inqi_help
2884 : gen_reload_inhi_help)
2885 (operands[0], operands[1],
2886 gen_rtx_REG (SImode, REGNO (operands[0]))));
2887 }
2888 else
2889 {
2890 rtx aligned_mem, bitnum;
2891 rtx scratch = gen_reg_rtx (SImode);
2892
2893 get_aligned_mem (operands[1], &aligned_mem, &bitnum);
2894
2895 emit_insn ((mode == QImode
2896 ? gen_aligned_loadqi
2897 : gen_aligned_loadhi)
2898 (operands[0], aligned_mem, bitnum, scratch));
2899 }
2900 }
2901 else
2902 {
2903 /* Don't pass these as parameters since that makes the generated
2904 code depend on parameter evaluation order which will cause
2905 bootstrap failures. */
2906
2907 rtx temp1 = gen_reg_rtx (DImode);
2908 rtx temp2 = gen_reg_rtx (DImode);
2909 rtx seq = ((mode == QImode
2910 ? gen_unaligned_loadqi
2911 : gen_unaligned_loadhi)
2912 (operands[0], get_unaligned_address (operands[1], 0),
2913 temp1, temp2));
2914
2915 alpha_set_memflags (seq, operands[1]);
2916 emit_insn (seq);
2917 }
2918 return true;
2919 }
2920
2921 if (GET_CODE (operands[0]) == MEM
2922 || (GET_CODE (operands[0]) == SUBREG
2923 && GET_CODE (SUBREG_REG (operands[0])) == MEM)
2924 || (reload_in_progress && GET_CODE (operands[0]) == REG
2925 && REGNO (operands[0]) >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
2926 || (reload_in_progress && GET_CODE (operands[0]) == SUBREG
2927 && GET_CODE (SUBREG_REG (operands[0])) == REG
2928 && REGNO (operands[0]) >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER))
2929 {
2930 if (aligned_memory_operand (operands[0], mode))
2931 {
2932 rtx aligned_mem, bitnum;
2933 rtx temp1 = gen_reg_rtx (SImode);
2934 rtx temp2 = gen_reg_rtx (SImode);
2935
2936 get_aligned_mem (operands[0], &aligned_mem, &bitnum);
2937
2938 emit_insn (gen_aligned_store (aligned_mem, operands[1], bitnum,
2939 temp1, temp2));
2940 }
2941 else
2942 {
2943 rtx temp1 = gen_reg_rtx (DImode);
2944 rtx temp2 = gen_reg_rtx (DImode);
2945 rtx temp3 = gen_reg_rtx (DImode);
2946 rtx seq = ((mode == QImode
2947 ? gen_unaligned_storeqi
2948 : gen_unaligned_storehi)
2949 (get_unaligned_address (operands[0], 0),
2950 operands[1], temp1, temp2, temp3));
2951
2952 alpha_set_memflags (seq, operands[0]);
2953 emit_insn (seq);
2954 }
2955 return true;
2956 }
2957
2958 return false;
2959 }
2960
2961 /* Generate an unsigned DImode to FP conversion. This is the same code
2962 optabs would emit if we didn't have TFmode patterns.
2963
2964 For SFmode, this is the only construction I've found that can pass
2965 gcc.c-torture/execute/ieee/rbug.c. No scenario that uses DFmode
2966 intermediates will work, because you'll get intermediate rounding
2967 that ruins the end result. Some of this could be fixed by turning
2968 on round-to-positive-infinity, but that requires diddling the fpsr,
2969 which kills performance. I tried turning this around and converting
2970 to a negative number, so that I could turn on /m, but either I did
2971 it wrong or there's something else cause I wound up with the exact
2972 same single-bit error. There is a branch-less form of this same code:
2973
2974 srl $16,1,$1
2975 and $16,1,$2
2976 cmplt $16,0,$3
2977 or $1,$2,$2
2978 cmovge $16,$16,$2
2979 itoft $3,$f10
2980 itoft $2,$f11
2981 cvtqs $f11,$f11
2982 adds $f11,$f11,$f0
2983 fcmoveq $f10,$f11,$f0
2984
2985 I'm not using it because it's the same number of instructions as
2986 this branch-full form, and it has more serialized long latency
2987 instructions on the critical path.
2988
2989 For DFmode, we can avoid rounding errors by breaking up the word
2990 into two pieces, converting them separately, and adding them back:
2991
2992 LC0: .long 0,0x5f800000
2993
2994 itoft $16,$f11
2995 lda $2,LC0
2996 cmplt $16,0,$1
2997 cpyse $f11,$f31,$f10
2998 cpyse $f31,$f11,$f11
2999 s4addq $1,$2,$1
3000 lds $f12,0($1)
3001 cvtqt $f10,$f10
3002 cvtqt $f11,$f11
3003 addt $f12,$f10,$f0
3004 addt $f0,$f11,$f0
3005
3006 This doesn't seem to be a clear-cut win over the optabs form.
3007 It probably all depends on the distribution of numbers being
3008 converted -- in the optabs form, all but high-bit-set has a
3009 much lower minimum execution time. */
3010
3011 void
3012 alpha_emit_floatuns (rtx operands[2])
3013 {
3014 rtx neglab, donelab, i0, i1, f0, in, out;
3015 enum machine_mode mode;
3016
3017 out = operands[0];
3018 in = force_reg (DImode, operands[1]);
3019 mode = GET_MODE (out);
3020 neglab = gen_label_rtx ();
3021 donelab = gen_label_rtx ();
3022 i0 = gen_reg_rtx (DImode);
3023 i1 = gen_reg_rtx (DImode);
3024 f0 = gen_reg_rtx (mode);
3025
3026 emit_cmp_and_jump_insns (in, const0_rtx, LT, const0_rtx, DImode, 0, neglab);
3027
3028 emit_insn (gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, out, gen_rtx_FLOAT (mode, in)));
3029 emit_jump_insn (gen_jump (donelab));
3030 emit_barrier ();
3031
3032 emit_label (neglab);
3033
3034 emit_insn (gen_lshrdi3 (i0, in, const1_rtx));
3035 emit_insn (gen_anddi3 (i1, in, const1_rtx));
3036 emit_insn (gen_iordi3 (i0, i0, i1));
3037 emit_insn (gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, f0, gen_rtx_FLOAT (mode, i0)));
3038 emit_insn (gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, out, gen_rtx_PLUS (mode, f0, f0)));
3039
3040 emit_label (donelab);
3041 }
3042
3043 /* Generate the comparison for a conditional branch. */
3044
3045 rtx
3046 alpha_emit_conditional_branch (enum rtx_code code)
3047 {
3048 enum rtx_code cmp_code, branch_code;
3049 enum machine_mode cmp_mode, branch_mode = VOIDmode;
3050 rtx op0 = alpha_compare.op0, op1 = alpha_compare.op1;
3051 rtx tem;
3052
3053 if (alpha_compare.fp_p && GET_MODE (op0) == TFmode)
3054 {
3055 if (! TARGET_HAS_XFLOATING_LIBS)
3056 abort ();
3057
3058 /* X_floating library comparison functions return
3059 -1 unordered
3060 0 false
3061 1 true
3062 Convert the compare against the raw return value. */
3063
3064 switch (code)
3065 {
3066 case UNORDERED:
3067 cmp_code = EQ;
3068 code = LT;
3069 break;
3070 case ORDERED:
3071 cmp_code = EQ;
3072 code = GE;
3073 break;
3074 case NE:
3075 cmp_code = NE;
3076 code = NE;
3077 break;
3078 default:
3079 cmp_code = code;
3080 code = GT;
3081 break;
3082 }
3083
3084 op0 = alpha_emit_xfloating_compare (cmp_code, op0, op1);
3085 op1 = const0_rtx;
3086 alpha_compare.fp_p = 0;
3087 }
3088
3089 /* The general case: fold the comparison code to the types of compares
3090 that we have, choosing the branch as necessary. */
3091 switch (code)
3092 {
3093 case EQ: case LE: case LT: case LEU: case LTU:
3094 case UNORDERED:
3095 /* We have these compares: */
3096 cmp_code = code, branch_code = NE;
3097 break;
3098
3099 case NE:
3100 case ORDERED:
3101 /* These must be reversed. */
3102 cmp_code = reverse_condition (code), branch_code = EQ;
3103 break;
3104
3105 case GE: case GT: case GEU: case GTU:
3106 /* For FP, we swap them, for INT, we reverse them. */
3107 if (alpha_compare.fp_p)
3108 {
3109 cmp_code = swap_condition (code);
3110 branch_code = NE;
3111 tem = op0, op0 = op1, op1 = tem;
3112 }
3113 else
3114 {
3115 cmp_code = reverse_condition (code);
3116 branch_code = EQ;
3117 }
3118 break;
3119
3120 default:
3121 abort ();
3122 }
3123
3124 if (alpha_compare.fp_p)
3125 {
3126 cmp_mode = DFmode;
3127 if (flag_unsafe_math_optimizations)
3128 {
3129 /* When we are not as concerned about non-finite values, and we
3130 are comparing against zero, we can branch directly. */
3131 if (op1 == CONST0_RTX (DFmode))
3132 cmp_code = NIL, branch_code = code;
3133 else if (op0 == CONST0_RTX (DFmode))
3134 {
3135 /* Undo the swap we probably did just above. */
3136 tem = op0, op0 = op1, op1 = tem;
3137 branch_code = swap_condition (cmp_code);
3138 cmp_code = NIL;
3139 }
3140 }
3141 else
3142 {
3143 /* ??? We mark the branch mode to be CCmode to prevent the
3144 compare and branch from being combined, since the compare
3145 insn follows IEEE rules that the branch does not. */
3146 branch_mode = CCmode;
3147 }
3148 }
3149 else
3150 {
3151 cmp_mode = DImode;
3152
3153 /* The following optimizations are only for signed compares. */
3154 if (code != LEU && code != LTU && code != GEU && code != GTU)
3155 {
3156 /* Whee. Compare and branch against 0 directly. */
3157 if (op1 == const0_rtx)
3158 cmp_code = NIL, branch_code = code;
3159
3160 /* We want to use cmpcc/bcc when we can, since there is a zero delay
3161 bypass between logicals and br/cmov on EV5. But we don't want to
3162 force valid immediate constants into registers needlessly. */
3163 else if (GET_CODE (op1) == CONST_INT)
3164 {
3165 HOST_WIDE_INT v = INTVAL (op1), n = -v;
3166
3167 if (! CONST_OK_FOR_LETTER_P (v, 'I')
3168 && (CONST_OK_FOR_LETTER_P (n, 'K')
3169 || CONST_OK_FOR_LETTER_P (n, 'L')))
3170 {
3171 cmp_code = PLUS, branch_code = code;
3172 op1 = GEN_INT (n);
3173 }
3174 }
3175 }
3176
3177 if (!reg_or_0_operand (op0, DImode))
3178 op0 = force_reg (DImode, op0);
3179 if (cmp_code != PLUS && !reg_or_8bit_operand (op1, DImode))
3180 op1 = force_reg (DImode, op1);
3181 }
3182
3183 /* Emit an initial compare instruction, if necessary. */
3184 tem = op0;
3185 if (cmp_code != NIL)
3186 {
3187 tem = gen_reg_rtx (cmp_mode);
3188 emit_move_insn (tem, gen_rtx_fmt_ee (cmp_code, cmp_mode, op0, op1));
3189 }
3190
3191 /* Zero the operands. */
3192 memset (&alpha_compare, 0, sizeof (alpha_compare));
3193
3194 /* Return the branch comparison. */
3195 return gen_rtx_fmt_ee (branch_code, branch_mode, tem, CONST0_RTX (cmp_mode));
3196 }
3197
3198 /* Certain simplifications can be done to make invalid setcc operations
3199 valid. Return the final comparison, or NULL if we can't work. */
3200
3201 rtx
3202 alpha_emit_setcc (enum rtx_code code)
3203 {
3204 enum rtx_code cmp_code;
3205 rtx op0 = alpha_compare.op0, op1 = alpha_compare.op1;
3206 int fp_p = alpha_compare.fp_p;
3207 rtx tmp;
3208
3209 /* Zero the operands. */
3210 memset (&alpha_compare, 0, sizeof (alpha_compare));
3211
3212 if (fp_p && GET_MODE (op0) == TFmode)
3213 {
3214 if (! TARGET_HAS_XFLOATING_LIBS)
3215 abort ();
3216
3217 /* X_floating library comparison functions return
3218 -1 unordered
3219 0 false
3220 1 true
3221 Convert the compare against the raw return value. */
3222
3223 if (code == UNORDERED || code == ORDERED)
3224 cmp_code = EQ;
3225 else
3226 cmp_code = code;
3227
3228 op0 = alpha_emit_xfloating_compare (cmp_code, op0, op1);
3229 op1 = const0_rtx;
3230 fp_p = 0;
3231
3232 if (code == UNORDERED)
3233 code = LT;
3234 else if (code == ORDERED)
3235 code = GE;
3236 else
3237 code = GT;
3238 }
3239
3240 if (fp_p && !TARGET_FIX)
3241 return NULL_RTX;
3242
3243 /* The general case: fold the comparison code to the types of compares
3244 that we have, choosing the branch as necessary. */
3245
3246 cmp_code = NIL;
3247 switch (code)
3248 {
3249 case EQ: case LE: case LT: case LEU: case LTU:
3250 case UNORDERED:
3251 /* We have these compares. */
3252 if (fp_p)
3253 cmp_code = code, code = NE;
3254 break;
3255
3256 case NE:
3257 if (!fp_p && op1 == const0_rtx)
3258 break;
3259 /* FALLTHRU */
3260
3261 case ORDERED:
3262 cmp_code = reverse_condition (code);
3263 code = EQ;
3264 break;
3265
3266 case GE: case GT: case GEU: case GTU:
3267 /* These normally need swapping, but for integer zero we have
3268 special patterns that recognize swapped operands. */
3269 if (!fp_p && op1 == const0_rtx)
3270 break;
3271 code = swap_condition (code);
3272 if (fp_p)
3273 cmp_code = code, code = NE;
3274 tmp = op0, op0 = op1, op1 = tmp;
3275 break;
3276
3277 default:
3278 abort ();
3279 }
3280
3281 if (!fp_p)
3282 {
3283 if (!register_operand (op0, DImode))
3284 op0 = force_reg (DImode, op0);
3285 if (!reg_or_8bit_operand (op1, DImode))
3286 op1 = force_reg (DImode, op1);
3287 }
3288
3289 /* Emit an initial compare instruction, if necessary. */
3290 if (cmp_code != NIL)
3291 {
3292 enum machine_mode mode = fp_p ? DFmode : DImode;
3293
3294 tmp = gen_reg_rtx (mode);
3295 emit_insn (gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, tmp,
3296 gen_rtx_fmt_ee (cmp_code, mode, op0, op1)));
3297
3298 op0 = fp_p ? gen_lowpart (DImode, tmp) : tmp;
3299 op1 = const0_rtx;
3300 }
3301
3302 /* Return the setcc comparison. */
3303 return gen_rtx_fmt_ee (code, DImode, op0, op1);
3304 }
3305
3306
3307 /* Rewrite a comparison against zero CMP of the form
3308 (CODE (cc0) (const_int 0)) so it can be written validly in
3309 a conditional move (if_then_else CMP ...).
3310 If both of the operands that set cc0 are nonzero we must emit
3311 an insn to perform the compare (it can't be done within
3312 the conditional move). */
3313
3314 rtx
3315 alpha_emit_conditional_move (rtx cmp, enum machine_mode mode)
3316 {
3317 enum rtx_code code = GET_CODE (cmp);
3318 enum rtx_code cmov_code = NE;
3319 rtx op0 = alpha_compare.op0;
3320 rtx op1 = alpha_compare.op1;
3321 int fp_p = alpha_compare.fp_p;
3322 enum machine_mode cmp_mode
3323 = (GET_MODE (op0) == VOIDmode ? DImode : GET_MODE (op0));
3324 enum machine_mode cmp_op_mode = fp_p ? DFmode : DImode;
3325 enum machine_mode cmov_mode = VOIDmode;
3326 int local_fast_math = flag_unsafe_math_optimizations;
3327 rtx tem;
3328
3329 /* Zero the operands. */
3330 memset (&alpha_compare, 0, sizeof (alpha_compare));
3331
3332 if (fp_p != FLOAT_MODE_P (mode))
3333 {
3334 enum rtx_code cmp_code;
3335
3336 if (! TARGET_FIX)
3337 return 0;
3338
3339 /* If we have fp<->int register move instructions, do a cmov by
3340 performing the comparison in fp registers, and move the
3341 zero/nonzero value to integer registers, where we can then
3342 use a normal cmov, or vice-versa. */
3343
3344 switch (code)
3345 {
3346 case EQ: case LE: case LT: case LEU: case LTU:
3347 /* We have these compares. */
3348 cmp_code = code, code = NE;
3349 break;
3350
3351 case NE:
3352 /* This must be reversed. */
3353 cmp_code = EQ, code = EQ;
3354 break;
3355
3356 case GE: case GT: case GEU: case GTU:
3357 /* These normally need swapping, but for integer zero we have
3358 special patterns that recognize swapped operands. */
3359 if (!fp_p && op1 == const0_rtx)
3360 cmp_code = code, code = NE;
3361 else
3362 {
3363 cmp_code = swap_condition (code);
3364 code = NE;
3365 tem = op0, op0 = op1, op1 = tem;
3366 }
3367 break;
3368
3369 default:
3370 abort ();
3371 }
3372
3373 tem = gen_reg_rtx (cmp_op_mode);
3374 emit_insn (gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, tem,
3375 gen_rtx_fmt_ee (cmp_code, cmp_op_mode,
3376 op0, op1)));
3377
3378 cmp_mode = cmp_op_mode = fp_p ? DImode : DFmode;
3379 op0 = gen_lowpart (cmp_op_mode, tem);
3380 op1 = CONST0_RTX (cmp_op_mode);
3381 fp_p = !fp_p;
3382 local_fast_math = 1;
3383 }
3384
3385 /* We may be able to use a conditional move directly.
3386 This avoids emitting spurious compares. */
3387 if (signed_comparison_operator (cmp, VOIDmode)
3388 && (!fp_p || local_fast_math)
3389 && (op0 == CONST0_RTX (cmp_mode) || op1 == CONST0_RTX (cmp_mode)))
3390 return gen_rtx_fmt_ee (code, VOIDmode, op0, op1);
3391
3392 /* We can't put the comparison inside the conditional move;
3393 emit a compare instruction and put that inside the
3394 conditional move. Make sure we emit only comparisons we have;
3395 swap or reverse as necessary. */
3396
3397 if (no_new_pseudos)
3398 return NULL_RTX;
3399
3400 switch (code)
3401 {
3402 case EQ: case LE: case LT: case LEU: case LTU:
3403 /* We have these compares: */
3404 break;
3405
3406 case NE:
3407 /* This must be reversed. */
3408 code = reverse_condition (code);
3409 cmov_code = EQ;
3410 break;
3411
3412 case GE: case GT: case GEU: case GTU:
3413 /* These must be swapped. */
3414 if (op1 != CONST0_RTX (cmp_mode))
3415 {
3416 code = swap_condition (code);
3417 tem = op0, op0 = op1, op1 = tem;
3418 }
3419 break;
3420
3421 default:
3422 abort ();
3423 }
3424
3425 if (!fp_p)
3426 {
3427 if (!reg_or_0_operand (op0, DImode))
3428 op0 = force_reg (DImode, op0);
3429 if (!reg_or_8bit_operand (op1, DImode))
3430 op1 = force_reg (DImode, op1);
3431 }
3432
3433 /* ??? We mark the branch mode to be CCmode to prevent the compare
3434 and cmov from being combined, since the compare insn follows IEEE
3435 rules that the cmov does not. */
3436 if (fp_p && !local_fast_math)
3437 cmov_mode = CCmode;
3438
3439 tem = gen_reg_rtx (cmp_op_mode);
3440 emit_move_insn (tem, gen_rtx_fmt_ee (code, cmp_op_mode, op0, op1));
3441 return gen_rtx_fmt_ee (cmov_code, cmov_mode, tem, CONST0_RTX (cmp_op_mode));
3442 }
3443
3444 /* Simplify a conditional move of two constants into a setcc with
3445 arithmetic. This is done with a splitter since combine would
3446 just undo the work if done during code generation. It also catches
3447 cases we wouldn't have before cse. */
3448
3449 int
3450 alpha_split_conditional_move (enum rtx_code code, rtx dest, rtx cond,
3451 rtx t_rtx, rtx f_rtx)
3452 {
3453 HOST_WIDE_INT t, f, diff;
3454 enum machine_mode mode;
3455 rtx target, subtarget, tmp;
3456
3457 mode = GET_MODE (dest);
3458 t = INTVAL (t_rtx);
3459 f = INTVAL (f_rtx);
3460 diff = t - f;
3461
3462 if (((code == NE || code == EQ) && diff < 0)
3463 || (code == GE || code == GT))
3464 {
3465 code = reverse_condition (code);
3466 diff = t, t = f, f = diff;
3467 diff = t - f;
3468 }
3469
3470 subtarget = target = dest;
3471 if (mode != DImode)
3472 {
3473 target = gen_lowpart (DImode, dest);
3474 if (! no_new_pseudos)
3475 subtarget = gen_reg_rtx (DImode);
3476 else
3477 subtarget = target;
3478 }
3479 /* Below, we must be careful to use copy_rtx on target and subtarget
3480 in intermediate insns, as they may be a subreg rtx, which may not
3481 be shared. */
3482
3483 if (f == 0 && exact_log2 (diff) > 0
3484 /* On EV6, we've got enough shifters to make non-arithmatic shifts
3485 viable over a longer latency cmove. On EV5, the E0 slot is a
3486 scarce resource, and on EV4 shift has the same latency as a cmove. */
3487 && (diff <= 8 || alpha_cpu == PROCESSOR_EV6))
3488 {
3489 tmp = gen_rtx_fmt_ee (code, DImode, cond, const0_rtx);
3490 emit_insn (gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, copy_rtx (subtarget), tmp));
3491
3492 tmp = gen_rtx_ASHIFT (DImode, copy_rtx (subtarget),
3493 GEN_INT (exact_log2 (t)));
3494 emit_insn (gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, target, tmp));
3495 }
3496 else if (f == 0 && t == -1)
3497 {
3498 tmp = gen_rtx_fmt_ee (code, DImode, cond, const0_rtx);
3499 emit_insn (gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, copy_rtx (subtarget), tmp));
3500
3501 emit_insn (gen_negdi2 (target, copy_rtx (subtarget)));
3502 }
3503 else if (diff == 1 || diff == 4 || diff == 8)
3504 {
3505 rtx add_op;
3506
3507 tmp = gen_rtx_fmt_ee (code, DImode, cond, const0_rtx);
3508 emit_insn (gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, copy_rtx (subtarget), tmp));
3509
3510 if (diff == 1)
3511 emit_insn (gen_adddi3 (target, copy_rtx (subtarget), GEN_INT (f)));
3512 else
3513 {
3514 add_op = GEN_INT (f);
3515 if (sext_add_operand (add_op, mode))
3516 {
3517 tmp = gen_rtx_MULT (DImode, copy_rtx (subtarget),
3518 GEN_INT (diff));
3519 tmp = gen_rtx_PLUS (DImode, tmp, add_op);
3520 emit_insn (gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, target, tmp));
3521 }
3522 else
3523 return 0;
3524 }
3525 }
3526 else
3527 return 0;
3528
3529 return 1;
3530 }
3531 \f
3532 /* Look up the function X_floating library function name for the
3533 given operation. */
3534
3535 static const char *
3536 alpha_lookup_xfloating_lib_func (enum rtx_code code)
3537 {
3538 struct xfloating_op
3539 {
3540 const enum rtx_code code;
3541 const char *const func;
3542 };
3543
3544 static const struct xfloating_op vms_xfloating_ops[] =
3545 {
3546 { PLUS, "OTS$ADD_X" },
3547 { MINUS, "OTS$SUB_X" },
3548 { MULT, "OTS$MUL_X" },
3549 { DIV, "OTS$DIV_X" },
3550 { EQ, "OTS$EQL_X" },
3551 { NE, "OTS$NEQ_X" },
3552 { LT, "OTS$LSS_X" },
3553 { LE, "OTS$LEQ_X" },
3554 { GT, "OTS$GTR_X" },
3555 { GE, "OTS$GEQ_X" },
3556 { FIX, "OTS$CVTXQ" },
3557 { FLOAT, "OTS$CVTQX" },
3558 { UNSIGNED_FLOAT, "OTS$CVTQUX" },
3559 { FLOAT_EXTEND, "OTS$CVT_FLOAT_T_X" },
3560 { FLOAT_TRUNCATE, "OTS$CVT_FLOAT_X_T" },
3561 };
3562
3563 static const struct xfloating_op osf_xfloating_ops[] =
3564 {
3565 { PLUS, "_OtsAddX" },
3566 { MINUS, "_OtsSubX" },
3567 { MULT, "_OtsMulX" },
3568 { DIV, "_OtsDivX" },
3569 { EQ, "_OtsEqlX" },
3570 { NE, "_OtsNeqX" },
3571 { LT, "_OtsLssX" },
3572 { LE, "_OtsLeqX" },
3573 { GT, "_OtsGtrX" },
3574 { GE, "_OtsGeqX" },
3575 { FIX, "_OtsCvtXQ" },
3576 { FLOAT, "_OtsCvtQX" },
3577 { UNSIGNED_FLOAT, "_OtsCvtQUX" },
3578 { FLOAT_EXTEND, "_OtsConvertFloatTX" },
3579 { FLOAT_TRUNCATE, "_OtsConvertFloatXT" },
3580 };
3581
3582 const struct xfloating_op *ops;
3583 const long n = ARRAY_SIZE (osf_xfloating_ops);
3584 long i;
3585
3586 /* How irritating. Nothing to key off for the table. Hardcode
3587 knowledge of the G_floating routines. */
3588 if (TARGET_FLOAT_VAX)
3589 {
3590 if (TARGET_ABI_OPEN_VMS)
3591 {
3592 if (code == FLOAT_EXTEND)
3593 return "OTS$CVT_FLOAT_G_X";
3594 if (code == FLOAT_TRUNCATE)
3595 return "OTS$CVT_FLOAT_X_G";
3596 }
3597 else
3598 {
3599 if (code == FLOAT_EXTEND)
3600 return "_OtsConvertFloatGX";
3601 if (code == FLOAT_TRUNCATE)
3602 return "_OtsConvertFloatXG";
3603 }
3604 }
3605
3606 if (TARGET_ABI_OPEN_VMS)
3607 ops = vms_xfloating_ops;
3608 else
3609 ops = osf_xfloating_ops;
3610
3611 for (i = 0; i < n; ++i)
3612 if (ops[i].code == code)
3613 return ops[i].func;
3614
3615 abort();
3616 }
3617
3618 /* Most X_floating operations take the rounding mode as an argument.
3619 Compute that here. */
3620
3621 static int
3622 alpha_compute_xfloating_mode_arg (enum rtx_code code,
3623 enum alpha_fp_rounding_mode round)
3624 {
3625 int mode;
3626
3627 switch (round)
3628 {
3629 case ALPHA_FPRM_NORM:
3630 mode = 2;
3631 break;
3632 case ALPHA_FPRM_MINF:
3633 mode = 1;
3634 break;
3635 case ALPHA_FPRM_CHOP:
3636 mode = 0;
3637 break;
3638 case ALPHA_FPRM_DYN:
3639 mode = 4;
3640 break;
3641 default:
3642 abort ();
3643
3644 /* XXX For reference, round to +inf is mode = 3. */
3645 }
3646
3647 if (code == FLOAT_TRUNCATE && alpha_fptm == ALPHA_FPTM_N)
3648 mode |= 0x10000;
3649
3650 return mode;
3651 }
3652
3653 /* Emit an X_floating library function call.
3654
3655 Note that these functions do not follow normal calling conventions:
3656 TFmode arguments are passed in two integer registers (as opposed to
3657 indirect); TFmode return values appear in R16+R17.
3658
3659 FUNC is the function name to call.
3660 TARGET is where the output belongs.
3661 OPERANDS are the inputs.
3662 NOPERANDS is the count of inputs.
3663 EQUIV is the expression equivalent for the function.
3664 */
3665
3666 static void
3667 alpha_emit_xfloating_libcall (const char *func, rtx target, rtx operands[],
3668 int noperands, rtx equiv)
3669 {
3670 rtx usage = NULL_RTX, tmp, reg;
3671 int regno = 16, i;
3672
3673 start_sequence ();
3674
3675 for (i = 0; i < noperands; ++i)
3676 {
3677 switch (GET_MODE (operands[i]))
3678 {
3679 case TFmode:
3680 reg = gen_rtx_REG (TFmode, regno);
3681 regno += 2;
3682 break;
3683
3684 case DFmode:
3685 reg = gen_rtx_REG (DFmode, regno + 32);
3686 regno += 1;
3687 break;
3688
3689 case VOIDmode:
3690 if (GET_CODE (operands[i]) != CONST_INT)
3691 abort ();
3692 /* FALLTHRU */
3693 case DImode:
3694 reg = gen_rtx_REG (DImode, regno);
3695 regno += 1;
3696 break;
3697
3698 default:
3699 abort ();
3700 }
3701
3702 emit_move_insn (reg, operands[i]);
3703 usage = alloc_EXPR_LIST (0, gen_rtx_USE (VOIDmode, reg), usage);
3704 }
3705
3706 switch (GET_MODE (target))
3707 {
3708 case TFmode:
3709 reg = gen_rtx_REG (TFmode, 16);
3710 break;
3711 case DFmode:
3712 reg = gen_rtx_REG (DFmode, 32);
3713 break;
3714 case DImode:
3715 reg = gen_rtx_REG (DImode, 0);
3716 break;
3717 default:
3718 abort ();
3719 }
3720
3721 tmp = gen_rtx_MEM (QImode, init_one_libfunc (func));
3722 tmp = emit_call_insn (GEN_CALL_VALUE (reg, tmp, const0_rtx,
3723 const0_rtx, const0_rtx));
3724 CALL_INSN_FUNCTION_USAGE (tmp) = usage;
3725
3726 tmp = get_insns ();
3727 end_sequence ();
3728
3729 emit_libcall_block (tmp, target, reg, equiv);
3730 }
3731
3732 /* Emit an X_floating library function call for arithmetic (+,-,*,/). */
3733
3734 void
3735 alpha_emit_xfloating_arith (enum rtx_code code, rtx operands[])
3736 {
3737 const char *func;
3738 int mode;
3739 rtx out_operands[3];
3740
3741 func = alpha_lookup_xfloating_lib_func (code);
3742 mode = alpha_compute_xfloating_mode_arg (code, alpha_fprm);
3743
3744 out_operands[0] = operands[1];
3745 out_operands[1] = operands[2];
3746 out_operands[2] = GEN_INT (mode);
3747 alpha_emit_xfloating_libcall (func, operands[0], out_operands, 3,
3748 gen_rtx_fmt_ee (code, TFmode, operands[1],
3749 operands[2]));
3750 }
3751
3752 /* Emit an X_floating library function call for a comparison. */
3753
3754 static rtx
3755 alpha_emit_xfloating_compare (enum rtx_code code, rtx op0, rtx op1)
3756 {
3757 const char *func;
3758 rtx out, operands[2];
3759
3760 func = alpha_lookup_xfloating_lib_func (code);
3761
3762 operands[0] = op0;
3763 operands[1] = op1;
3764 out = gen_reg_rtx (DImode);
3765
3766 /* ??? Strange mode for equiv because what's actually returned
3767 is -1,0,1, not a proper boolean value. */
3768 alpha_emit_xfloating_libcall (func, out, operands, 2,
3769 gen_rtx_fmt_ee (code, CCmode, op0, op1));
3770
3771 return out;
3772 }
3773
3774 /* Emit an X_floating library function call for a conversion. */
3775
3776 void
3777 alpha_emit_xfloating_cvt (enum rtx_code code, rtx operands[])
3778 {
3779 int noperands = 1, mode;
3780 rtx out_operands[2];
3781 const char *func;
3782
3783 func = alpha_lookup_xfloating_lib_func (code);
3784
3785 out_operands[0] = operands[1];
3786
3787 switch (code)
3788 {
3789 case FIX:
3790 mode = alpha_compute_xfloating_mode_arg (code, ALPHA_FPRM_CHOP);
3791 out_operands[1] = GEN_INT (mode);
3792 noperands = 2;
3793 break;
3794 case FLOAT_TRUNCATE:
3795 mode = alpha_compute_xfloating_mode_arg (code, alpha_fprm);
3796 out_operands[1] = GEN_INT (mode);
3797 noperands = 2;
3798 break;
3799 default:
3800 break;
3801 }
3802
3803 alpha_emit_xfloating_libcall (func, operands[0], out_operands, noperands,
3804 gen_rtx_fmt_e (code, GET_MODE (operands[0]),
3805 operands[1]));
3806 }
3807
3808 /* Split a TFmode OP[1] into DImode OP[2,3] and likewise for
3809 OP[0] into OP[0,1]. Naturally, output operand ordering is
3810 little-endian. */
3811
3812 void
3813 alpha_split_tfmode_pair (rtx operands[4])
3814 {
3815 if (GET_CODE (operands[1]) == REG)
3816 {
3817 operands[3] = gen_rtx_REG (DImode, REGNO (operands[1]) + 1);
3818 operands[2] = gen_rtx_REG (DImode, REGNO (operands[1]));
3819 }
3820 else if (GET_CODE (operands[1]) == MEM)
3821 {
3822 operands[3] = adjust_address (operands[1], DImode, 8);
3823 operands[2] = adjust_address (operands[1], DImode, 0);
3824 }
3825 else if (operands[1] == CONST0_RTX (TFmode))
3826 operands[2] = operands[3] = const0_rtx;
3827 else
3828 abort ();
3829
3830 if (GET_CODE (operands[0]) == REG)
3831 {
3832 operands[1] = gen_rtx_REG (DImode, REGNO (operands[0]) + 1);
3833 operands[0] = gen_rtx_REG (DImode, REGNO (operands[0]));
3834 }
3835 else if (GET_CODE (operands[0]) == MEM)
3836 {
3837 operands[1] = adjust_address (operands[0], DImode, 8);
3838 operands[0] = adjust_address (operands[0], DImode, 0);
3839 }
3840 else
3841 abort ();
3842 }
3843
3844 /* Implement negtf2 or abstf2. Op0 is destination, op1 is source,
3845 op2 is a register containing the sign bit, operation is the
3846 logical operation to be performed. */
3847
3848 void
3849 alpha_split_tfmode_frobsign (rtx operands[3], rtx (*operation) (rtx, rtx, rtx))
3850 {
3851 rtx high_bit = operands[2];
3852 rtx scratch;
3853 int move;
3854
3855 alpha_split_tfmode_pair (operands);
3856
3857 /* Detect three flavors of operand overlap. */
3858 move = 1;
3859 if (rtx_equal_p (operands[0], operands[2]))
3860 move = 0;
3861 else if (rtx_equal_p (operands[1], operands[2]))
3862 {
3863 if (rtx_equal_p (operands[0], high_bit))
3864 move = 2;
3865 else
3866 move = -1;
3867 }
3868
3869 if (move < 0)
3870 emit_move_insn (operands[0], operands[2]);
3871
3872 /* ??? If the destination overlaps both source tf and high_bit, then
3873 assume source tf is dead in its entirety and use the other half
3874 for a scratch register. Otherwise "scratch" is just the proper
3875 destination register. */
3876 scratch = operands[move < 2 ? 1 : 3];
3877
3878 emit_insn ((*operation) (scratch, high_bit, operands[3]));
3879
3880 if (move > 0)
3881 {
3882 emit_move_insn (operands[0], operands[2]);
3883 if (move > 1)
3884 emit_move_insn (operands[1], scratch);
3885 }
3886 }
3887 \f
3888 /* Use ext[wlq][lh] as the Architecture Handbook describes for extracting
3889 unaligned data:
3890
3891 unsigned: signed:
3892 word: ldq_u r1,X(r11) ldq_u r1,X(r11)
3893 ldq_u r2,X+1(r11) ldq_u r2,X+1(r11)
3894 lda r3,X(r11) lda r3,X+2(r11)
3895 extwl r1,r3,r1 extql r1,r3,r1
3896 extwh r2,r3,r2 extqh r2,r3,r2
3897 or r1.r2.r1 or r1,r2,r1
3898 sra r1,48,r1
3899
3900 long: ldq_u r1,X(r11) ldq_u r1,X(r11)
3901 ldq_u r2,X+3(r11) ldq_u r2,X+3(r11)
3902 lda r3,X(r11) lda r3,X(r11)
3903 extll r1,r3,r1 extll r1,r3,r1
3904 extlh r2,r3,r2 extlh r2,r3,r2
3905 or r1.r2.r1 addl r1,r2,r1
3906
3907 quad: ldq_u r1,X(r11)
3908 ldq_u r2,X+7(r11)
3909 lda r3,X(r11)
3910 extql r1,r3,r1
3911 extqh r2,r3,r2
3912 or r1.r2.r1
3913 */
3914
3915 void
3916 alpha_expand_unaligned_load (rtx tgt, rtx mem, HOST_WIDE_INT size,
3917 HOST_WIDE_INT ofs, int sign)
3918 {
3919 rtx meml, memh, addr, extl, exth, tmp, mema;
3920 enum machine_mode mode;
3921
3922 meml = gen_reg_rtx (DImode);
3923 memh = gen_reg_rtx (DImode);
3924 addr = gen_reg_rtx (DImode);
3925 extl = gen_reg_rtx (DImode);
3926 exth = gen_reg_rtx (DImode);
3927
3928 mema = XEXP (mem, 0);
3929 if (GET_CODE (mema) == LO_SUM)
3930 mema = force_reg (Pmode, mema);
3931
3932 /* AND addresses cannot be in any alias set, since they may implicitly
3933 alias surrounding code. Ideally we'd have some alias set that
3934 covered all types except those with alignment 8 or higher. */
3935
3936 tmp = change_address (mem, DImode,
3937 gen_rtx_AND (DImode,
3938 plus_constant (mema, ofs),
3939 GEN_INT (-8)));
3940 set_mem_alias_set (tmp, 0);
3941 emit_move_insn (meml, tmp);
3942
3943 tmp = change_address (mem, DImode,
3944 gen_rtx_AND (DImode,
3945 plus_constant (mema, ofs + size - 1),
3946 GEN_INT (-8)));
3947 set_mem_alias_set (tmp, 0);
3948 emit_move_insn (memh, tmp);
3949
3950 if (WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN && sign && (size == 2 || size == 4))
3951 {
3952 emit_move_insn (addr, plus_constant (mema, -1));
3953
3954 emit_insn (gen_extqh_be (extl, meml, addr));
3955 emit_insn (gen_extxl_be (exth, memh, GEN_INT (64), addr));
3956
3957 addr = expand_binop (DImode, ior_optab, extl, exth, tgt, 1, OPTAB_WIDEN);
3958 addr = expand_binop (DImode, ashr_optab, addr, GEN_INT (64 - size*8),
3959 addr, 1, OPTAB_WIDEN);
3960 }
3961 else if (sign && size == 2)
3962 {
3963 emit_move_insn (addr, plus_constant (mema, ofs+2));
3964
3965 emit_insn (gen_extxl_le (extl, meml, GEN_INT (64), addr));
3966 emit_insn (gen_extqh_le (exth, memh, addr));
3967
3968 /* We must use tgt here for the target. Alpha-vms port fails if we use
3969 addr for the target, because addr is marked as a pointer and combine
3970 knows that pointers are always sign-extended 32 bit values. */
3971 addr = expand_binop (DImode, ior_optab, extl, exth, tgt, 1, OPTAB_WIDEN);
3972 addr = expand_binop (DImode, ashr_optab, addr, GEN_INT (48),
3973 addr, 1, OPTAB_WIDEN);
3974 }
3975 else
3976 {
3977 if (WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN)
3978 {
3979 emit_move_insn (addr, plus_constant (mema, ofs+size-1));
3980 switch ((int) size)
3981 {
3982 case 2:
3983 emit_insn (gen_extwh_be (extl, meml, addr));
3984 mode = HImode;
3985 break;
3986
3987 case 4:
3988 emit_insn (gen_extlh_be (extl, meml, addr));
3989 mode = SImode;
3990 break;
3991
3992 case 8:
3993 emit_insn (gen_extqh_be (extl, meml, addr));
3994 mode = DImode;
3995 break;
3996
3997 default:
3998 abort ();
3999 }
4000 emit_insn (gen_extxl_be (exth, memh, GEN_INT (size*8), addr));
4001 }
4002 else
4003 {
4004 emit_move_insn (addr, plus_constant (mema, ofs));
4005 emit_insn (gen_extxl_le (extl, meml, GEN_INT (size*8), addr));
4006 switch ((int) size)
4007 {
4008 case 2:
4009 emit_insn (gen_extwh_le (exth, memh, addr));
4010 mode = HImode;
4011 break;
4012
4013 case 4:
4014 emit_insn (gen_extlh_le (exth, memh, addr));
4015 mode = SImode;
4016 break;
4017
4018 case 8:
4019 emit_insn (gen_extqh_le (exth, memh, addr));
4020 mode = DImode;
4021 break;
4022
4023 default:
4024 abort();
4025 }
4026 }
4027
4028 addr = expand_binop (mode, ior_optab, gen_lowpart (mode, extl),
4029 gen_lowpart (mode, exth), gen_lowpart (mode, tgt),
4030 sign, OPTAB_WIDEN);
4031 }
4032
4033 if (addr != tgt)
4034 emit_move_insn (tgt, gen_lowpart(GET_MODE (tgt), addr));
4035 }
4036
4037 /* Similarly, use ins and msk instructions to perform unaligned stores. */
4038
4039 void
4040 alpha_expand_unaligned_store (rtx dst, rtx src,
4041 HOST_WIDE_INT size, HOST_WIDE_INT ofs)
4042 {
4043 rtx dstl, dsth, addr, insl, insh, meml, memh, dsta;
4044
4045 dstl = gen_reg_rtx (DImode);
4046 dsth = gen_reg_rtx (DImode);
4047 insl = gen_reg_rtx (DImode);
4048 insh = gen_reg_rtx (DImode);
4049
4050 dsta = XEXP (dst, 0);
4051 if (GET_CODE (dsta) == LO_SUM)
4052 dsta = force_reg (Pmode, dsta);
4053
4054 /* AND addresses cannot be in any alias set, since they may implicitly
4055 alias surrounding code. Ideally we'd have some alias set that
4056 covered all types except those with alignment 8 or higher. */
4057
4058 meml = change_address (dst, DImode,
4059 gen_rtx_AND (DImode,
4060 plus_constant (dsta, ofs),
4061 GEN_INT (-8)));
4062 set_mem_alias_set (meml, 0);
4063
4064 memh = change_address (dst, DImode,
4065 gen_rtx_AND (DImode,
4066 plus_constant (dsta, ofs + size - 1),
4067 GEN_INT (-8)));
4068 set_mem_alias_set (memh, 0);
4069
4070 emit_move_insn (dsth, memh);
4071 emit_move_insn (dstl, meml);
4072 if (WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN)
4073 {
4074 addr = copy_addr_to_reg (plus_constant (dsta, ofs+size-1));
4075
4076 if (src != const0_rtx)
4077 {
4078 switch ((int) size)
4079 {
4080 case 2:
4081 emit_insn (gen_inswl_be (insh, gen_lowpart (HImode,src), addr));
4082 break;
4083 case 4:
4084 emit_insn (gen_insll_be (insh, gen_lowpart (SImode,src), addr));
4085 break;
4086 case 8:
4087 emit_insn (gen_insql_be (insh, gen_lowpart (DImode,src), addr));
4088 break;
4089 }
4090 emit_insn (gen_insxh (insl, gen_lowpart (DImode, src),
4091 GEN_INT (size*8), addr));
4092 }
4093
4094 switch ((int) size)
4095 {
4096 case 2:
4097 emit_insn (gen_mskxl_be (dsth, dsth, GEN_INT (0xffff), addr));
4098 break;
4099 case 4:
4100 {
4101 rtx msk = immed_double_const (0xffffffff, 0, DImode);
4102 emit_insn (gen_mskxl_be (dsth, dsth, msk, addr));
4103 break;
4104 }
4105 case 8:
4106 emit_insn (gen_mskxl_be (dsth, dsth, constm1_rtx, addr));
4107 break;
4108 }
4109
4110 emit_insn (gen_mskxh (dstl, dstl, GEN_INT (size*8), addr));
4111 }
4112 else
4113 {
4114 addr = copy_addr_to_reg (plus_constant (dsta, ofs));
4115
4116 if (src != const0_rtx)
4117 {
4118 emit_insn (gen_insxh (insh, gen_lowpart (DImode, src),
4119 GEN_INT (size*8), addr));
4120
4121 switch ((int) size)
4122 {
4123 case 2:
4124 emit_insn (gen_inswl_le (insl, gen_lowpart (HImode, src), addr));
4125 break;
4126 case 4:
4127 emit_insn (gen_insll_le (insl, gen_lowpart (SImode, src), addr));
4128 break;
4129 case 8:
4130 emit_insn (gen_insql_le (insl, src, addr));
4131 break;
4132 }
4133 }
4134
4135 emit_insn (gen_mskxh (dsth, dsth, GEN_INT (size*8), addr));
4136
4137 switch ((int) size)
4138 {
4139 case 2:
4140 emit_insn (gen_mskxl_le (dstl, dstl, GEN_INT (0xffff), addr));
4141 break;
4142 case 4:
4143 {
4144 rtx msk = immed_double_const (0xffffffff, 0, DImode);
4145 emit_insn (gen_mskxl_le (dstl, dstl, msk, addr));
4146 break;
4147 }
4148 case 8:
4149 emit_insn (gen_mskxl_le (dstl, dstl, constm1_rtx, addr));
4150 break;
4151 }
4152 }
4153
4154 if (src != const0_rtx)
4155 {
4156 dsth = expand_binop (DImode, ior_optab, insh, dsth, dsth, 0, OPTAB_WIDEN);
4157 dstl = expand_binop (DImode, ior_optab, insl, dstl, dstl, 0, OPTAB_WIDEN);
4158 }
4159
4160 if (WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN)
4161 {
4162 emit_move_insn (meml, dstl);
4163 emit_move_insn (memh, dsth);
4164 }
4165 else
4166 {
4167 /* Must store high before low for degenerate case of aligned. */
4168 emit_move_insn (memh, dsth);
4169 emit_move_insn (meml, dstl);
4170 }
4171 }
4172
4173 /* The block move code tries to maximize speed by separating loads and
4174 stores at the expense of register pressure: we load all of the data
4175 before we store it back out. There are two secondary effects worth
4176 mentioning, that this speeds copying to/from aligned and unaligned
4177 buffers, and that it makes the code significantly easier to write. */
4178
4179 #define MAX_MOVE_WORDS 8
4180
4181 /* Load an integral number of consecutive unaligned quadwords. */
4182
4183 static void
4184 alpha_expand_unaligned_load_words (rtx *out_regs, rtx smem,
4185 HOST_WIDE_INT words, HOST_WIDE_INT ofs)
4186 {
4187 rtx const im8 = GEN_INT (-8);
4188 rtx const i64 = GEN_INT (64);
4189 rtx ext_tmps[MAX_MOVE_WORDS], data_regs[MAX_MOVE_WORDS+1];
4190 rtx sreg, areg, tmp, smema;
4191 HOST_WIDE_INT i;
4192
4193 smema = XEXP (smem, 0);
4194 if (GET_CODE (smema) == LO_SUM)
4195 smema = force_reg (Pmode, smema);
4196
4197 /* Generate all the tmp registers we need. */
4198 for (i = 0; i < words; ++i)
4199 {
4200 data_regs[i] = out_regs[i];
4201 ext_tmps[i] = gen_reg_rtx (DImode);
4202 }
4203 data_regs[words] = gen_reg_rtx (DImode);
4204
4205 if (ofs != 0)
4206 smem = adjust_address (smem, GET_MODE (smem), ofs);
4207
4208 /* Load up all of the source data. */
4209 for (i = 0; i < words; ++i)
4210 {
4211 tmp = change_address (smem, DImode,
4212 gen_rtx_AND (DImode,
4213 plus_constant (smema, 8*i),
4214 im8));
4215 set_mem_alias_set (tmp, 0);
4216 emit_move_insn (data_regs[i], tmp);
4217 }
4218
4219 tmp = change_address (smem, DImode,
4220 gen_rtx_AND (DImode,
4221 plus_constant (smema, 8*words - 1),
4222 im8));
4223 set_mem_alias_set (tmp, 0);
4224 emit_move_insn (data_regs[words], tmp);
4225
4226 /* Extract the half-word fragments. Unfortunately DEC decided to make
4227 extxh with offset zero a noop instead of zeroing the register, so
4228 we must take care of that edge condition ourselves with cmov. */
4229
4230 sreg = copy_addr_to_reg (smema);
4231 areg = expand_binop (DImode, and_optab, sreg, GEN_INT (7), NULL,
4232 1, OPTAB_WIDEN);
4233 if (WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN)
4234 emit_move_insn (sreg, plus_constant (sreg, 7));
4235 for (i = 0; i < words; ++i)
4236 {
4237 if (WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN)
4238 {
4239 emit_insn (gen_extqh_be (data_regs[i], data_regs[i], sreg));
4240 emit_insn (gen_extxl_be (ext_tmps[i], data_regs[i+1], i64, sreg));
4241 }
4242 else
4243 {
4244 emit_insn (gen_extxl_le (data_regs[i], data_regs[i], i64, sreg));
4245 emit_insn (gen_extqh_le (ext_tmps[i], data_regs[i+1], sreg));
4246 }
4247 emit_insn (gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, ext_tmps[i],
4248 gen_rtx_IF_THEN_ELSE (DImode,
4249 gen_rtx_EQ (DImode, areg,
4250 const0_rtx),
4251 const0_rtx, ext_tmps[i])));
4252 }
4253
4254 /* Merge the half-words into whole words. */
4255 for (i = 0; i < words; ++i)
4256 {
4257 out_regs[i] = expand_binop (DImode, ior_optab, data_regs[i],
4258 ext_tmps[i], data_regs[i], 1, OPTAB_WIDEN);
4259 }
4260 }
4261
4262 /* Store an integral number of consecutive unaligned quadwords. DATA_REGS
4263 may be NULL to store zeros. */
4264
4265 static void
4266 alpha_expand_unaligned_store_words (rtx *data_regs, rtx dmem,
4267 HOST_WIDE_INT words, HOST_WIDE_INT ofs)
4268 {
4269 rtx const im8 = GEN_INT (-8);
4270 rtx const i64 = GEN_INT (64);
4271 rtx ins_tmps[MAX_MOVE_WORDS];
4272 rtx st_tmp_1, st_tmp_2, dreg;
4273 rtx st_addr_1, st_addr_2, dmema;
4274 HOST_WIDE_INT i;
4275
4276 dmema = XEXP (dmem, 0);
4277 if (GET_CODE (dmema) == LO_SUM)
4278 dmema = force_reg (Pmode, dmema);
4279
4280 /* Generate all the tmp registers we need. */
4281 if (data_regs != NULL)
4282 for (i = 0; i < words; ++i)
4283 ins_tmps[i] = gen_reg_rtx(DImode);
4284 st_tmp_1 = gen_reg_rtx(DImode);
4285 st_tmp_2 = gen_reg_rtx(DImode);
4286
4287 if (ofs != 0)
4288 dmem = adjust_address (dmem, GET_MODE (dmem), ofs);
4289
4290 st_addr_2 = change_address (dmem, DImode,
4291 gen_rtx_AND (DImode,
4292 plus_constant (dmema, words*8 - 1),
4293 im8));
4294 set_mem_alias_set (st_addr_2, 0);
4295
4296 st_addr_1 = change_address (dmem, DImode,
4297 gen_rtx_AND (DImode, dmema, im8));
4298 set_mem_alias_set (st_addr_1, 0);
4299
4300 /* Load up the destination end bits. */
4301 emit_move_insn (st_tmp_2, st_addr_2);
4302 emit_move_insn (st_tmp_1, st_addr_1);
4303
4304 /* Shift the input data into place. */
4305 dreg = copy_addr_to_reg (dmema);
4306 if (WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN)
4307 emit_move_insn (dreg, plus_constant (dreg, 7));
4308 if (data_regs != NULL)
4309 {
4310 for (i = words-1; i >= 0; --i)
4311 {
4312 if (WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN)
4313 {
4314 emit_insn (gen_insql_be (ins_tmps[i], data_regs[i], dreg));
4315 emit_insn (gen_insxh (data_regs[i], data_regs[i], i64, dreg));
4316 }
4317 else
4318 {
4319 emit_insn (gen_insxh (ins_tmps[i], data_regs[i], i64, dreg));
4320 emit_insn (gen_insql_le (data_regs[i], data_regs[i], dreg));
4321 }
4322 }
4323 for (i = words-1; i > 0; --i)
4324 {
4325 ins_tmps[i-1] = expand_binop (DImode, ior_optab, data_regs[i],
4326 ins_tmps[i-1], ins_tmps[i-1], 1,
4327 OPTAB_WIDEN);
4328 }
4329 }
4330
4331 /* Split and merge the ends with the destination data. */
4332 if (WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN)
4333 {
4334 emit_insn (gen_mskxl_be (st_tmp_2, st_tmp_2, constm1_rtx, dreg));
4335 emit_insn (gen_mskxh (st_tmp_1, st_tmp_1, i64, dreg));
4336 }
4337 else
4338 {
4339 emit_insn (gen_mskxh (st_tmp_2, st_tmp_2, i64, dreg));
4340 emit_insn (gen_mskxl_le (st_tmp_1, st_tmp_1, constm1_rtx, dreg));
4341 }
4342
4343 if (data_regs != NULL)
4344 {
4345 st_tmp_2 = expand_binop (DImode, ior_optab, st_tmp_2, ins_tmps[words-1],
4346 st_tmp_2, 1, OPTAB_WIDEN);
4347 st_tmp_1 = expand_binop (DImode, ior_optab, st_tmp_1, data_regs[0],
4348 st_tmp_1, 1, OPTAB_WIDEN);
4349 }
4350
4351 /* Store it all. */
4352 if (WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN)
4353 emit_move_insn (st_addr_1, st_tmp_1);
4354 else
4355 emit_move_insn (st_addr_2, st_tmp_2);
4356 for (i = words-1; i > 0; --i)
4357 {
4358 rtx tmp = change_address (dmem, DImode,
4359 gen_rtx_AND (DImode,
4360 plus_constant(dmema,
4361 WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN ? i*8-1 : i*8),
4362 im8));
4363 set_mem_alias_set (tmp, 0);
4364 emit_move_insn (tmp, data_regs ? ins_tmps[i-1] : const0_rtx);
4365 }
4366 if (WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN)
4367 emit_move_insn (st_addr_2, st_tmp_2);
4368 else
4369 emit_move_insn (st_addr_1, st_tmp_1);
4370 }
4371
4372
4373 /* Expand string/block move operations.
4374
4375 operands[0] is the pointer to the destination.
4376 operands[1] is the pointer to the source.
4377 operands[2] is the number of bytes to move.
4378 operands[3] is the alignment. */
4379
4380 int
4381 alpha_expand_block_move (rtx operands[])
4382 {
4383 rtx bytes_rtx = operands[2];
4384 rtx align_rtx = operands[3];
4385 HOST_WIDE_INT orig_bytes = INTVAL (bytes_rtx);
4386 HOST_WIDE_INT bytes = orig_bytes;
4387 HOST_WIDE_INT src_align = INTVAL (align_rtx) * BITS_PER_UNIT;
4388 HOST_WIDE_INT dst_align = src_align;
4389 rtx orig_src = operands[1];
4390 rtx orig_dst = operands[0];
4391 rtx data_regs[2 * MAX_MOVE_WORDS + 16];
4392 rtx tmp;
4393 unsigned int i, words, ofs, nregs = 0;
4394
4395 if (orig_bytes <= 0)
4396 return 1;
4397 else if (orig_bytes > MAX_MOVE_WORDS * UNITS_PER_WORD)
4398 return 0;
4399
4400 /* Look for additional alignment information from recorded register info. */
4401
4402 tmp = XEXP (orig_src, 0);
4403 if (GET_CODE (tmp) == REG)
4404 src_align = MAX (src_align, REGNO_POINTER_ALIGN (REGNO (tmp)));
4405 else if (GET_CODE (tmp) == PLUS
4406 && GET_CODE (XEXP (tmp, 0)) == REG
4407 && GET_CODE (XEXP (tmp, 1)) == CONST_INT)
4408 {
4409 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT c = INTVAL (XEXP (tmp, 1));
4410 unsigned int a = REGNO_POINTER_ALIGN (REGNO (XEXP (tmp, 0)));
4411
4412 if (a > src_align)
4413 {
4414 if (a >= 64 && c % 8 == 0)
4415 src_align = 64;
4416 else if (a >= 32 && c % 4 == 0)
4417 src_align = 32;
4418 else if (a >= 16 && c % 2 == 0)
4419 src_align = 16;
4420 }
4421 }
4422
4423 tmp = XEXP (orig_dst, 0);
4424 if (GET_CODE (tmp) == REG)
4425 dst_align = MAX (dst_align, REGNO_POINTER_ALIGN (REGNO (tmp)));
4426 else if (GET_CODE (tmp) == PLUS
4427 && GET_CODE (XEXP (tmp, 0)) == REG
4428 && GET_CODE (XEXP (tmp, 1)) == CONST_INT)
4429 {
4430 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT c = INTVAL (XEXP (tmp, 1));
4431 unsigned int a = REGNO_POINTER_ALIGN (REGNO (XEXP (tmp, 0)));
4432
4433 if (a > dst_align)
4434 {
4435 if (a >= 64 && c % 8 == 0)
4436 dst_align = 64;
4437 else if (a >= 32 && c % 4 == 0)
4438 dst_align = 32;
4439 else if (a >= 16 && c % 2 == 0)
4440 dst_align = 16;
4441 }
4442 }
4443
4444 /* Load the entire block into registers. */
4445 if (GET_CODE (XEXP (orig_src, 0)) == ADDRESSOF)
4446 {
4447 enum machine_mode mode;
4448
4449 tmp = XEXP (XEXP (orig_src, 0), 0);
4450
4451 /* Don't use the existing register if we're reading more than
4452 is held in the register. Nor if there is not a mode that
4453 handles the exact size. */
4454 mode = mode_for_size (bytes * BITS_PER_UNIT, MODE_INT, 1);
4455 if (mode != BLKmode
4456 && GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (tmp)) >= bytes)
4457 {
4458 if (mode == TImode)
4459 {
4460 data_regs[nregs] = gen_lowpart (DImode, tmp);
4461 data_regs[nregs + 1] = gen_highpart (DImode, tmp);
4462 nregs += 2;
4463 }
4464 else
4465 data_regs[nregs++] = gen_lowpart (mode, tmp);
4466
4467 goto src_done;
4468 }
4469
4470 /* No appropriate mode; fall back on memory. */
4471 orig_src = replace_equiv_address (orig_src,
4472 copy_addr_to_reg (XEXP (orig_src, 0)));
4473 src_align = GET_MODE_BITSIZE (GET_MODE (tmp));
4474 }
4475
4476 ofs = 0;
4477 if (src_align >= 64 && bytes >= 8)
4478 {
4479 words = bytes / 8;
4480
4481 for (i = 0; i < words; ++i)
4482 data_regs[nregs + i] = gen_reg_rtx (DImode);
4483
4484 for (i = 0; i < words; ++i)
4485 emit_move_insn (data_regs[nregs + i],
4486 adjust_address (orig_src, DImode, ofs + i * 8));
4487
4488 nregs += words;
4489 bytes -= words * 8;
4490 ofs += words * 8;
4491 }
4492
4493 if (src_align >= 32 && bytes >= 4)
4494 {
4495 words = bytes / 4;
4496
4497 for (i = 0; i < words; ++i)
4498 data_regs[nregs + i] = gen_reg_rtx (SImode);
4499
4500 for (i = 0; i < words; ++i)
4501 emit_move_insn (data_regs[nregs + i],
4502 adjust_address (orig_src, SImode, ofs + i * 4));
4503
4504 nregs += words;
4505 bytes -= words * 4;
4506 ofs += words * 4;
4507 }
4508
4509 if (bytes >= 8)
4510 {
4511 words = bytes / 8;
4512
4513 for (i = 0; i < words+1; ++i)
4514 data_regs[nregs + i] = gen_reg_rtx (DImode);
4515
4516 alpha_expand_unaligned_load_words (data_regs + nregs, orig_src,
4517 words, ofs);
4518
4519 nregs += words;
4520 bytes -= words * 8;
4521 ofs += words * 8;
4522 }
4523
4524 if (! TARGET_BWX && bytes >= 4)
4525 {
4526 data_regs[nregs++] = tmp = gen_reg_rtx (SImode);
4527 alpha_expand_unaligned_load (tmp, orig_src, 4, ofs, 0);
4528 bytes -= 4;
4529 ofs += 4;
4530 }
4531
4532 if (bytes >= 2)
4533 {
4534 if (src_align >= 16)
4535 {
4536 do {
4537 data_regs[nregs++] = tmp = gen_reg_rtx (HImode);
4538 emit_move_insn (tmp, adjust_address (orig_src, HImode, ofs));
4539 bytes -= 2;
4540 ofs += 2;
4541 } while (bytes >= 2);
4542 }
4543 else if (! TARGET_BWX)
4544 {
4545 data_regs[nregs++] = tmp = gen_reg_rtx (HImode);
4546 alpha_expand_unaligned_load (tmp, orig_src, 2, ofs, 0);
4547 bytes -= 2;
4548 ofs += 2;
4549 }
4550 }
4551
4552 while (bytes > 0)
4553 {
4554 data_regs[nregs++] = tmp = gen_reg_rtx (QImode);
4555 emit_move_insn (tmp, adjust_address (orig_src, QImode, ofs));
4556 bytes -= 1;
4557 ofs += 1;
4558 }
4559
4560 src_done:
4561
4562 if (nregs > ARRAY_SIZE (data_regs))
4563 abort ();
4564
4565 /* Now save it back out again. */
4566
4567 i = 0, ofs = 0;
4568
4569 if (GET_CODE (XEXP (orig_dst, 0)) == ADDRESSOF)
4570 {
4571 enum machine_mode mode;
4572 tmp = XEXP (XEXP (orig_dst, 0), 0);
4573
4574 mode = mode_for_size (orig_bytes * BITS_PER_UNIT, MODE_INT, 1);
4575 if (GET_MODE (tmp) == mode)
4576 {
4577 if (nregs == 1)
4578 {
4579 emit_move_insn (tmp, data_regs[0]);
4580 i = 1;
4581 goto dst_done;
4582 }
4583
4584 else if (nregs == 2 && mode == TImode)
4585 {
4586 /* Undo the subregging done above when copying between
4587 two TImode registers. */
4588 if (GET_CODE (data_regs[0]) == SUBREG
4589 && GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (data_regs[0])) == TImode)
4590 emit_move_insn (tmp, SUBREG_REG (data_regs[0]));
4591 else
4592 {
4593 rtx seq;
4594
4595 start_sequence ();
4596 emit_move_insn (gen_lowpart (DImode, tmp), data_regs[0]);
4597 emit_move_insn (gen_highpart (DImode, tmp), data_regs[1]);
4598 seq = get_insns ();
4599 end_sequence ();
4600
4601 emit_no_conflict_block (seq, tmp, data_regs[0],
4602 data_regs[1], NULL_RTX);
4603 }
4604
4605 i = 2;
4606 goto dst_done;
4607 }
4608 }
4609
4610 /* ??? If nregs > 1, consider reconstructing the word in regs. */
4611 /* ??? Optimize mode < dst_mode with strict_low_part. */
4612
4613 /* No appropriate mode; fall back on memory. We can speed things
4614 up by recognizing extra alignment information. */
4615 orig_dst = replace_equiv_address (orig_dst,
4616 copy_addr_to_reg (XEXP (orig_dst, 0)));
4617 dst_align = GET_MODE_BITSIZE (GET_MODE (tmp));
4618 }
4619
4620 /* Write out the data in whatever chunks reading the source allowed. */
4621 if (dst_align >= 64)
4622 {
4623 while (i < nregs && GET_MODE (data_regs[i]) == DImode)
4624 {
4625 emit_move_insn (adjust_address (orig_dst, DImode, ofs),
4626 data_regs[i]);
4627 ofs += 8;
4628 i++;
4629 }
4630 }
4631
4632 if (dst_align >= 32)
4633 {
4634 /* If the source has remaining DImode regs, write them out in
4635 two pieces. */
4636 while (i < nregs && GET_MODE (data_regs[i]) == DImode)
4637 {
4638 tmp = expand_binop (DImode, lshr_optab, data_regs[i], GEN_INT (32),
4639 NULL_RTX, 1, OPTAB_WIDEN);
4640
4641 emit_move_insn (adjust_address (orig_dst, SImode, ofs),
4642 gen_lowpart (SImode, data_regs[i]));
4643 emit_move_insn (adjust_address (orig_dst, SImode, ofs + 4),
4644 gen_lowpart (SImode, tmp));
4645 ofs += 8;
4646 i++;
4647 }
4648
4649 while (i < nregs && GET_MODE (data_regs[i]) == SImode)
4650 {
4651 emit_move_insn (adjust_address (orig_dst, SImode, ofs),
4652 data_regs[i]);
4653 ofs += 4;
4654 i++;
4655 }
4656 }
4657
4658 if (i < nregs && GET_MODE (data_regs[i]) == DImode)
4659 {
4660 /* Write out a remaining block of words using unaligned methods. */
4661
4662 for (words = 1; i + words < nregs; words++)
4663 if (GET_MODE (data_regs[i + words]) != DImode)
4664 break;
4665
4666 if (words == 1)
4667 alpha_expand_unaligned_store (orig_dst, data_regs[i], 8, ofs);
4668 else
4669 alpha_expand_unaligned_store_words (data_regs + i, orig_dst,
4670 words, ofs);
4671
4672 i += words;
4673 ofs += words * 8;
4674 }
4675
4676 /* Due to the above, this won't be aligned. */
4677 /* ??? If we have more than one of these, consider constructing full
4678 words in registers and using alpha_expand_unaligned_store_words. */
4679 while (i < nregs && GET_MODE (data_regs[i]) == SImode)
4680 {
4681 alpha_expand_unaligned_store (orig_dst, data_regs[i], 4, ofs);
4682 ofs += 4;
4683 i++;
4684 }
4685
4686 if (dst_align >= 16)
4687 while (i < nregs && GET_MODE (data_regs[i]) == HImode)
4688 {
4689 emit_move_insn (adjust_address (orig_dst, HImode, ofs), data_regs[i]);
4690 i++;
4691 ofs += 2;
4692 }
4693 else
4694 while (i < nregs && GET_MODE (data_regs[i]) == HImode)
4695 {
4696 alpha_expand_unaligned_store (orig_dst, data_regs[i], 2, ofs);
4697 i++;
4698 ofs += 2;
4699 }
4700
4701 while (i < nregs && GET_MODE (data_regs[i]) == QImode)
4702 {
4703 emit_move_insn (adjust_address (orig_dst, QImode, ofs), data_regs[i]);
4704 i++;
4705 ofs += 1;
4706 }
4707
4708 dst_done:
4709
4710 if (i != nregs)
4711 abort ();
4712
4713 return 1;
4714 }
4715
4716 int
4717 alpha_expand_block_clear (rtx operands[])
4718 {
4719 rtx bytes_rtx = operands[1];
4720 rtx align_rtx = operands[2];
4721 HOST_WIDE_INT orig_bytes = INTVAL (bytes_rtx);
4722 HOST_WIDE_INT bytes = orig_bytes;
4723 HOST_WIDE_INT align = INTVAL (align_rtx) * BITS_PER_UNIT;
4724 HOST_WIDE_INT alignofs = 0;
4725 rtx orig_dst = operands[0];
4726 rtx tmp;
4727 int i, words, ofs = 0;
4728
4729 if (orig_bytes <= 0)
4730 return 1;
4731 if (orig_bytes > MAX_MOVE_WORDS * UNITS_PER_WORD)
4732 return 0;
4733
4734 /* Look for stricter alignment. */
4735 tmp = XEXP (orig_dst, 0);
4736 if (GET_CODE (tmp) == REG)
4737 align = MAX (align, REGNO_POINTER_ALIGN (REGNO (tmp)));
4738 else if (GET_CODE (tmp) == PLUS
4739 && GET_CODE (XEXP (tmp, 0)) == REG
4740 && GET_CODE (XEXP (tmp, 1)) == CONST_INT)
4741 {
4742 HOST_WIDE_INT c = INTVAL (XEXP (tmp, 1));
4743 int a = REGNO_POINTER_ALIGN (REGNO (XEXP (tmp, 0)));
4744
4745 if (a > align)
4746 {
4747 if (a >= 64)
4748 align = a, alignofs = 8 - c % 8;
4749 else if (a >= 32)
4750 align = a, alignofs = 4 - c % 4;
4751 else if (a >= 16)
4752 align = a, alignofs = 2 - c % 2;
4753 }
4754 }
4755 else if (GET_CODE (tmp) == ADDRESSOF)
4756 {
4757 enum machine_mode mode;
4758
4759 mode = mode_for_size (bytes * BITS_PER_UNIT, MODE_INT, 1);
4760 if (GET_MODE (XEXP (tmp, 0)) == mode)
4761 {
4762 emit_move_insn (XEXP (tmp, 0), const0_rtx);
4763 return 1;
4764 }
4765
4766 /* No appropriate mode; fall back on memory. */
4767 orig_dst = replace_equiv_address (orig_dst, copy_addr_to_reg (tmp));
4768 align = GET_MODE_BITSIZE (GET_MODE (XEXP (tmp, 0)));
4769 }
4770
4771 /* Handle an unaligned prefix first. */
4772
4773 if (alignofs > 0)
4774 {
4775 #if HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT >= 64
4776 /* Given that alignofs is bounded by align, the only time BWX could
4777 generate three stores is for a 7 byte fill. Prefer two individual
4778 stores over a load/mask/store sequence. */
4779 if ((!TARGET_BWX || alignofs == 7)
4780 && align >= 32
4781 && !(alignofs == 4 && bytes >= 4))
4782 {
4783 enum machine_mode mode = (align >= 64 ? DImode : SImode);
4784 int inv_alignofs = (align >= 64 ? 8 : 4) - alignofs;
4785 rtx mem, tmp;
4786 HOST_WIDE_INT mask;
4787
4788 mem = adjust_address (orig_dst, mode, ofs - inv_alignofs);
4789 set_mem_alias_set (mem, 0);
4790
4791 mask = ~(~(HOST_WIDE_INT)0 << (inv_alignofs * 8));
4792 if (bytes < alignofs)
4793 {
4794 mask |= ~(HOST_WIDE_INT)0 << ((inv_alignofs + bytes) * 8);
4795 ofs += bytes;
4796 bytes = 0;
4797 }
4798 else
4799 {
4800 bytes -= alignofs;
4801 ofs += alignofs;
4802 }
4803 alignofs = 0;
4804
4805 tmp = expand_binop (mode, and_optab, mem, GEN_INT (mask),
4806 NULL_RTX, 1, OPTAB_WIDEN);
4807
4808 emit_move_insn (mem, tmp);
4809 }
4810 #endif
4811
4812 if (TARGET_BWX && (alignofs & 1) && bytes >= 1)
4813 {
4814 emit_move_insn (adjust_address (orig_dst, QImode, ofs), const0_rtx);
4815 bytes -= 1;
4816 ofs += 1;
4817 alignofs -= 1;
4818 }
4819 if (TARGET_BWX && align >= 16 && (alignofs & 3) == 2 && bytes >= 2)
4820 {
4821 emit_move_insn (adjust_address (orig_dst, HImode, ofs), const0_rtx);
4822 bytes -= 2;
4823 ofs += 2;
4824 alignofs -= 2;
4825 }
4826 if (alignofs == 4 && bytes >= 4)
4827 {
4828 emit_move_insn (adjust_address (orig_dst, SImode, ofs), const0_rtx);
4829 bytes -= 4;
4830 ofs += 4;
4831 alignofs = 0;
4832 }
4833
4834 /* If we've not used the extra lead alignment information by now,
4835 we won't be able to. Downgrade align to match what's left over. */
4836 if (alignofs > 0)
4837 {
4838 alignofs = alignofs & -alignofs;
4839 align = MIN (align, alignofs * BITS_PER_UNIT);
4840 }
4841 }
4842
4843 /* Handle a block of contiguous long-words. */
4844
4845 if (align >= 64 && bytes >= 8)
4846 {
4847 words = bytes / 8;
4848
4849 for (i = 0; i < words; ++i)
4850 emit_move_insn (adjust_address (orig_dst, DImode, ofs + i * 8),
4851 const0_rtx);
4852
4853 bytes -= words * 8;
4854 ofs += words * 8;
4855 }
4856
4857 /* If the block is large and appropriately aligned, emit a single
4858 store followed by a sequence of stq_u insns. */
4859
4860 if (align >= 32 && bytes > 16)
4861 {
4862 rtx orig_dsta;
4863
4864 emit_move_insn (adjust_address (orig_dst, SImode, ofs), const0_rtx);
4865 bytes -= 4;
4866 ofs += 4;
4867
4868 orig_dsta = XEXP (orig_dst, 0);
4869 if (GET_CODE (orig_dsta) == LO_SUM)
4870 orig_dsta = force_reg (Pmode, orig_dsta);
4871
4872 words = bytes / 8;
4873 for (i = 0; i < words; ++i)
4874 {
4875 rtx mem
4876 = change_address (orig_dst, DImode,
4877 gen_rtx_AND (DImode,
4878 plus_constant (orig_dsta, ofs + i*8),
4879 GEN_INT (-8)));
4880 set_mem_alias_set (mem, 0);
4881 emit_move_insn (mem, const0_rtx);
4882 }
4883
4884 /* Depending on the alignment, the first stq_u may have overlapped
4885 with the initial stl, which means that the last stq_u didn't
4886 write as much as it would appear. Leave those questionable bytes
4887 unaccounted for. */
4888 bytes -= words * 8 - 4;
4889 ofs += words * 8 - 4;
4890 }
4891
4892 /* Handle a smaller block of aligned words. */
4893
4894 if ((align >= 64 && bytes == 4)
4895 || (align == 32 && bytes >= 4))
4896 {
4897 words = bytes / 4;
4898
4899 for (i = 0; i < words; ++i)
4900 emit_move_insn (adjust_address (orig_dst, SImode, ofs + i * 4),
4901 const0_rtx);
4902
4903 bytes -= words * 4;
4904 ofs += words * 4;
4905 }
4906
4907 /* An unaligned block uses stq_u stores for as many as possible. */
4908
4909 if (bytes >= 8)
4910 {
4911 words = bytes / 8;
4912
4913 alpha_expand_unaligned_store_words (NULL, orig_dst, words, ofs);
4914
4915 bytes -= words * 8;
4916 ofs += words * 8;
4917 }
4918
4919 /* Next clean up any trailing pieces. */
4920
4921 #if HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT >= 64
4922 /* Count the number of bits in BYTES for which aligned stores could
4923 be emitted. */
4924 words = 0;
4925 for (i = (TARGET_BWX ? 1 : 4); i * BITS_PER_UNIT <= align ; i <<= 1)
4926 if (bytes & i)
4927 words += 1;
4928
4929 /* If we have appropriate alignment (and it wouldn't take too many
4930 instructions otherwise), mask out the bytes we need. */
4931 if (TARGET_BWX ? words > 2 : bytes > 0)
4932 {
4933 if (align >= 64)
4934 {
4935 rtx mem, tmp;
4936 HOST_WIDE_INT mask;
4937
4938 mem = adjust_address (orig_dst, DImode, ofs);
4939 set_mem_alias_set (mem, 0);
4940
4941 mask = ~(HOST_WIDE_INT)0 << (bytes * 8);
4942
4943 tmp = expand_binop (DImode, and_optab, mem, GEN_INT (mask),
4944 NULL_RTX, 1, OPTAB_WIDEN);
4945
4946 emit_move_insn (mem, tmp);
4947 return 1;
4948 }
4949 else if (align >= 32 && bytes < 4)
4950 {
4951 rtx mem, tmp;
4952 HOST_WIDE_INT mask;
4953
4954 mem = adjust_address (orig_dst, SImode, ofs);
4955 set_mem_alias_set (mem, 0);
4956
4957 mask = ~(HOST_WIDE_INT)0 << (bytes * 8);
4958
4959 tmp = expand_binop (SImode, and_optab, mem, GEN_INT (mask),
4960 NULL_RTX, 1, OPTAB_WIDEN);
4961
4962 emit_move_insn (mem, tmp);
4963 return 1;
4964 }
4965 }
4966 #endif
4967
4968 if (!TARGET_BWX && bytes >= 4)
4969 {
4970 alpha_expand_unaligned_store (orig_dst, const0_rtx, 4, ofs);
4971 bytes -= 4;
4972 ofs += 4;
4973 }
4974
4975 if (bytes >= 2)
4976 {
4977 if (align >= 16)
4978 {
4979 do {
4980 emit_move_insn (adjust_address (orig_dst, HImode, ofs),
4981 const0_rtx);
4982 bytes -= 2;
4983 ofs += 2;
4984 } while (bytes >= 2);
4985 }
4986 else if (! TARGET_BWX)
4987 {
4988 alpha_expand_unaligned_store (orig_dst, const0_rtx, 2, ofs);
4989 bytes -= 2;
4990 ofs += 2;
4991 }
4992 }
4993
4994 while (bytes > 0)
4995 {
4996 emit_move_insn (adjust_address (orig_dst, QImode, ofs), const0_rtx);
4997 bytes -= 1;
4998 ofs += 1;
4999 }
5000
5001 return 1;
5002 }
5003
5004 /* Returns a mask so that zap(x, value) == x & mask. */
5005
5006 rtx
5007 alpha_expand_zap_mask (HOST_WIDE_INT value)
5008 {
5009 rtx result;
5010 int i;
5011
5012 if (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT >= 64)
5013 {
5014 HOST_WIDE_INT mask = 0;
5015
5016 for (i = 7; i >= 0; --i)
5017 {
5018 mask <<= 8;
5019 if (!((value >> i) & 1))
5020 mask |= 0xff;
5021 }
5022
5023 result = gen_int_mode (mask, DImode);
5024 }
5025 else if (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT == 32)
5026 {
5027 HOST_WIDE_INT mask_lo = 0, mask_hi = 0;
5028
5029 for (i = 7; i >= 4; --i)
5030 {
5031 mask_hi <<= 8;
5032 if (!((value >> i) & 1))
5033 mask_hi |= 0xff;
5034 }
5035
5036 for (i = 3; i >= 0; --i)
5037 {
5038 mask_lo <<= 8;
5039 if (!((value >> i) & 1))
5040 mask_lo |= 0xff;
5041 }
5042
5043 result = immed_double_const (mask_lo, mask_hi, DImode);
5044 }
5045 else
5046 abort ();
5047
5048 return result;
5049 }
5050
5051 void
5052 alpha_expand_builtin_vector_binop (rtx (*gen) (rtx, rtx, rtx),
5053 enum machine_mode mode,
5054 rtx op0, rtx op1, rtx op2)
5055 {
5056 op0 = gen_lowpart (mode, op0);
5057
5058 if (op1 == const0_rtx)
5059 op1 = CONST0_RTX (mode);
5060 else
5061 op1 = gen_lowpart (mode, op1);
5062
5063 if (op2 == const0_rtx)
5064 op2 = CONST0_RTX (mode);
5065 else
5066 op2 = gen_lowpart (mode, op2);
5067
5068 emit_insn ((*gen) (op0, op1, op2));
5069 }
5070 \f
5071 /* Adjust the cost of a scheduling dependency. Return the new cost of
5072 a dependency LINK or INSN on DEP_INSN. COST is the current cost. */
5073
5074 static int
5075 alpha_adjust_cost (rtx insn, rtx link, rtx dep_insn, int cost)
5076 {
5077 enum attr_type insn_type, dep_insn_type;
5078
5079 /* If the dependence is an anti-dependence, there is no cost. For an
5080 output dependence, there is sometimes a cost, but it doesn't seem
5081 worth handling those few cases. */
5082 if (REG_NOTE_KIND (link) != 0)
5083 return cost;
5084
5085 /* If we can't recognize the insns, we can't really do anything. */
5086 if (recog_memoized (insn) < 0 || recog_memoized (dep_insn) < 0)
5087 return cost;
5088
5089 insn_type = get_attr_type (insn);
5090 dep_insn_type = get_attr_type (dep_insn);
5091
5092 /* Bring in the user-defined memory latency. */
5093 if (dep_insn_type == TYPE_ILD
5094 || dep_insn_type == TYPE_FLD
5095 || dep_insn_type == TYPE_LDSYM)
5096 cost += alpha_memory_latency-1;
5097
5098 /* Everything else handled in DFA bypasses now. */
5099
5100 return cost;
5101 }
5102
5103 /* The number of instructions that can be issued per cycle. */
5104
5105 static int
5106 alpha_issue_rate (void)
5107 {
5108 return (alpha_cpu == PROCESSOR_EV4 ? 2 : 4);
5109 }
5110
5111 static int
5112 alpha_use_dfa_pipeline_interface (void)
5113 {
5114 return true;
5115 }
5116
5117 /* How many alternative schedules to try. This should be as wide as the
5118 scheduling freedom in the DFA, but no wider. Making this value too
5119 large results extra work for the scheduler.
5120
5121 For EV4, loads can be issued to either IB0 or IB1, thus we have 2
5122 alternative schedules. For EV5, we can choose between E0/E1 and
5123 FA/FM. For EV6, an arithmatic insn can be issued to U0/U1/L0/L1. */
5124
5125 static int
5126 alpha_multipass_dfa_lookahead (void)
5127 {
5128 return (alpha_cpu == PROCESSOR_EV6 ? 4 : 2);
5129 }
5130 \f
5131 /* Machine-specific function data. */
5132
5133 struct machine_function GTY(())
5134 {
5135 /* For unicosmk. */
5136 /* List of call information words for calls from this function. */
5137 struct rtx_def *first_ciw;
5138 struct rtx_def *last_ciw;
5139 int ciw_count;
5140
5141 /* List of deferred case vectors. */
5142 struct rtx_def *addr_list;
5143
5144 /* For OSF. */
5145 const char *some_ld_name;
5146 };
5147
5148 /* How to allocate a 'struct machine_function'. */
5149
5150 static struct machine_function *
5151 alpha_init_machine_status (void)
5152 {
5153 return ((struct machine_function *)
5154 ggc_alloc_cleared (sizeof (struct machine_function)));
5155 }
5156
5157 /* Functions to save and restore alpha_return_addr_rtx. */
5158
5159 /* Start the ball rolling with RETURN_ADDR_RTX. */
5160
5161 rtx
5162 alpha_return_addr (int count, rtx frame ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
5163 {
5164 if (count != 0)
5165 return const0_rtx;
5166
5167 return get_hard_reg_initial_val (Pmode, REG_RA);
5168 }
5169
5170 /* Return or create a pseudo containing the gp value for the current
5171 function. Needed only if TARGET_LD_BUGGY_LDGP. */
5172
5173 rtx
5174 alpha_gp_save_rtx (void)
5175 {
5176 rtx r = get_hard_reg_initial_val (DImode, 29);
5177 if (GET_CODE (r) != MEM)
5178 r = gen_mem_addressof (r, NULL_TREE, /*rescan=*/true);
5179 return r;
5180 }
5181
5182 static int
5183 alpha_ra_ever_killed (void)
5184 {
5185 rtx top;
5186
5187 if (!has_hard_reg_initial_val (Pmode, REG_RA))
5188 return regs_ever_live[REG_RA];
5189
5190 push_topmost_sequence ();
5191 top = get_insns ();
5192 pop_topmost_sequence ();
5193
5194 return reg_set_between_p (gen_rtx_REG (Pmode, REG_RA), top, NULL_RTX);
5195 }
5196
5197 \f
5198 /* Return the trap mode suffix applicable to the current
5199 instruction, or NULL. */
5200
5201 static const char *
5202 get_trap_mode_suffix (void)
5203 {
5204 enum attr_trap_suffix s = get_attr_trap_suffix (current_output_insn);
5205
5206 switch (s)
5207 {
5208 case TRAP_SUFFIX_NONE:
5209 return NULL;
5210
5211 case TRAP_SUFFIX_SU:
5212 if (alpha_fptm >= ALPHA_FPTM_SU)
5213 return "su";
5214 return NULL;
5215
5216 case TRAP_SUFFIX_SUI:
5217 if (alpha_fptm >= ALPHA_FPTM_SUI)
5218 return "sui";
5219 return NULL;
5220
5221 case TRAP_SUFFIX_V_SV:
5222 switch (alpha_fptm)
5223 {
5224 case ALPHA_FPTM_N:
5225 return NULL;
5226 case ALPHA_FPTM_U:
5227 return "v";
5228 case ALPHA_FPTM_SU:
5229 case ALPHA_FPTM_SUI:
5230 return "sv";
5231 }
5232 break;
5233
5234 case TRAP_SUFFIX_V_SV_SVI:
5235 switch (alpha_fptm)
5236 {
5237 case ALPHA_FPTM_N:
5238 return NULL;
5239 case ALPHA_FPTM_U:
5240 return "v";
5241 case ALPHA_FPTM_SU:
5242 return "sv";
5243 case ALPHA_FPTM_SUI:
5244 return "svi";
5245 }
5246 break;
5247
5248 case TRAP_SUFFIX_U_SU_SUI:
5249 switch (alpha_fptm)
5250 {
5251 case ALPHA_FPTM_N:
5252 return NULL;
5253 case ALPHA_FPTM_U:
5254 return "u";
5255 case ALPHA_FPTM_SU:
5256 return "su";
5257 case ALPHA_FPTM_SUI:
5258 return "sui";
5259 }
5260 break;
5261 }
5262 abort ();
5263 }
5264
5265 /* Return the rounding mode suffix applicable to the current
5266 instruction, or NULL. */
5267
5268 static const char *
5269 get_round_mode_suffix (void)
5270 {
5271 enum attr_round_suffix s = get_attr_round_suffix (current_output_insn);
5272
5273 switch (s)
5274 {
5275 case ROUND_SUFFIX_NONE:
5276 return NULL;
5277 case ROUND_SUFFIX_NORMAL:
5278 switch (alpha_fprm)
5279 {
5280 case ALPHA_FPRM_NORM:
5281 return NULL;
5282 case ALPHA_FPRM_MINF:
5283 return "m";
5284 case ALPHA_FPRM_CHOP:
5285 return "c";
5286 case ALPHA_FPRM_DYN:
5287 return "d";
5288 }
5289 break;
5290
5291 case ROUND_SUFFIX_C:
5292 return "c";
5293 }
5294 abort ();
5295 }
5296
5297 /* Locate some local-dynamic symbol still in use by this function
5298 so that we can print its name in some movdi_er_tlsldm pattern. */
5299
5300 static int
5301 get_some_local_dynamic_name_1 (rtx *px, void *data ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
5302 {
5303 rtx x = *px;
5304
5305 if (GET_CODE (x) == SYMBOL_REF
5306 && SYMBOL_REF_TLS_MODEL (x) == TLS_MODEL_LOCAL_DYNAMIC)
5307 {
5308 cfun->machine->some_ld_name = XSTR (x, 0);
5309 return 1;
5310 }
5311
5312 return 0;
5313 }
5314
5315 static const char *
5316 get_some_local_dynamic_name (void)
5317 {
5318 rtx insn;
5319
5320 if (cfun->machine->some_ld_name)
5321 return cfun->machine->some_ld_name;
5322
5323 for (insn = get_insns (); insn ; insn = NEXT_INSN (insn))
5324 if (INSN_P (insn)
5325 && for_each_rtx (&PATTERN (insn), get_some_local_dynamic_name_1, 0))
5326 return cfun->machine->some_ld_name;
5327
5328 abort ();
5329 }
5330
5331 /* Print an operand. Recognize special options, documented below. */
5332
5333 void
5334 print_operand (FILE *file, rtx x, int code)
5335 {
5336 int i;
5337
5338 switch (code)
5339 {
5340 case '~':
5341 /* Print the assembler name of the current function. */
5342 assemble_name (file, alpha_fnname);
5343 break;
5344
5345 case '&':
5346 assemble_name (file, get_some_local_dynamic_name ());
5347 break;
5348
5349 case '/':
5350 {
5351 const char *trap = get_trap_mode_suffix ();
5352 const char *round = get_round_mode_suffix ();
5353
5354 if (trap || round)
5355 fprintf (file, (TARGET_AS_SLASH_BEFORE_SUFFIX ? "/%s%s" : "%s%s"),
5356 (trap ? trap : ""), (round ? round : ""));
5357 break;
5358 }
5359
5360 case ',':
5361 /* Generates single precision instruction suffix. */
5362 fputc ((TARGET_FLOAT_VAX ? 'f' : 's'), file);
5363 break;
5364
5365 case '-':
5366 /* Generates double precision instruction suffix. */
5367 fputc ((TARGET_FLOAT_VAX ? 'g' : 't'), file);
5368 break;
5369
5370 case '+':
5371 /* Generates a nop after a noreturn call at the very end of the
5372 function. */
5373 if (next_real_insn (current_output_insn) == 0)
5374 fprintf (file, "\n\tnop");
5375 break;
5376
5377 case '#':
5378 if (alpha_this_literal_sequence_number == 0)
5379 alpha_this_literal_sequence_number = alpha_next_sequence_number++;
5380 fprintf (file, "%d", alpha_this_literal_sequence_number);
5381 break;
5382
5383 case '*':
5384 if (alpha_this_gpdisp_sequence_number == 0)
5385 alpha_this_gpdisp_sequence_number = alpha_next_sequence_number++;
5386 fprintf (file, "%d", alpha_this_gpdisp_sequence_number);
5387 break;
5388
5389 case 'H':
5390 if (GET_CODE (x) == HIGH)
5391 output_addr_const (file, XEXP (x, 0));
5392 else
5393 output_operand_lossage ("invalid %%H value");
5394 break;
5395
5396 case 'J':
5397 {
5398 const char *lituse;
5399
5400 if (GET_CODE (x) == UNSPEC && XINT (x, 1) == UNSPEC_TLSGD_CALL)
5401 {
5402 x = XVECEXP (x, 0, 0);
5403 lituse = "lituse_tlsgd";
5404 }
5405 else if (GET_CODE (x) == UNSPEC && XINT (x, 1) == UNSPEC_TLSLDM_CALL)
5406 {
5407 x = XVECEXP (x, 0, 0);
5408 lituse = "lituse_tlsldm";
5409 }
5410 else if (GET_CODE (x) == CONST_INT)
5411 lituse = "lituse_jsr";
5412 else
5413 {
5414 output_operand_lossage ("invalid %%J value");
5415 break;
5416 }
5417
5418 if (x != const0_rtx)
5419 fprintf (file, "\t\t!%s!%d", lituse, (int) INTVAL (x));
5420 }
5421 break;
5422
5423 case 'r':
5424 /* If this operand is the constant zero, write it as "$31". */
5425 if (GET_CODE (x) == REG)
5426 fprintf (file, "%s", reg_names[REGNO (x)]);
5427 else if (x == CONST0_RTX (GET_MODE (x)))
5428 fprintf (file, "$31");
5429 else
5430 output_operand_lossage ("invalid %%r value");
5431 break;
5432
5433 case 'R':
5434 /* Similar, but for floating-point. */
5435 if (GET_CODE (x) == REG)
5436 fprintf (file, "%s", reg_names[REGNO (x)]);
5437 else if (x == CONST0_RTX (GET_MODE (x)))
5438 fprintf (file, "$f31");
5439 else
5440 output_operand_lossage ("invalid %%R value");
5441 break;
5442
5443 case 'N':
5444 /* Write the 1's complement of a constant. */
5445 if (GET_CODE (x) != CONST_INT)
5446 output_operand_lossage ("invalid %%N value");
5447
5448 fprintf (file, HOST_WIDE_INT_PRINT_DEC, ~ INTVAL (x));
5449 break;
5450
5451 case 'P':
5452 /* Write 1 << C, for a constant C. */
5453 if (GET_CODE (x) != CONST_INT)
5454 output_operand_lossage ("invalid %%P value");
5455
5456 fprintf (file, HOST_WIDE_INT_PRINT_DEC, (HOST_WIDE_INT) 1 << INTVAL (x));
5457 break;
5458
5459 case 'h':
5460 /* Write the high-order 16 bits of a constant, sign-extended. */
5461 if (GET_CODE (x) != CONST_INT)
5462 output_operand_lossage ("invalid %%h value");
5463
5464 fprintf (file, HOST_WIDE_INT_PRINT_DEC, INTVAL (x) >> 16);
5465 break;
5466
5467 case 'L':
5468 /* Write the low-order 16 bits of a constant, sign-extended. */
5469 if (GET_CODE (x) != CONST_INT)
5470 output_operand_lossage ("invalid %%L value");
5471
5472 fprintf (file, HOST_WIDE_INT_PRINT_DEC,
5473 (INTVAL (x) & 0xffff) - 2 * (INTVAL (x) & 0x8000));
5474 break;
5475
5476 case 'm':
5477 /* Write mask for ZAP insn. */
5478 if (GET_CODE (x) == CONST_DOUBLE)
5479 {
5480 HOST_WIDE_INT mask = 0;
5481 HOST_WIDE_INT value;
5482
5483 value = CONST_DOUBLE_LOW (x);
5484 for (i = 0; i < HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT / HOST_BITS_PER_CHAR;
5485 i++, value >>= 8)
5486 if (value & 0xff)
5487 mask |= (1 << i);
5488
5489 value = CONST_DOUBLE_HIGH (x);
5490 for (i = 0; i < HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT / HOST_BITS_PER_CHAR;
5491 i++, value >>= 8)
5492 if (value & 0xff)
5493 mask |= (1 << (i + sizeof (int)));
5494
5495 fprintf (file, HOST_WIDE_INT_PRINT_DEC, mask & 0xff);
5496 }
5497
5498 else if (GET_CODE (x) == CONST_INT)
5499 {
5500 HOST_WIDE_INT mask = 0, value = INTVAL (x);
5501
5502 for (i = 0; i < 8; i++, value >>= 8)
5503 if (value & 0xff)
5504 mask |= (1 << i);
5505
5506 fprintf (file, HOST_WIDE_INT_PRINT_DEC, mask);
5507 }
5508 else
5509 output_operand_lossage ("invalid %%m value");
5510 break;
5511
5512 case 'M':
5513 /* 'b', 'w', 'l', or 'q' as the value of the constant. */
5514 if (GET_CODE (x) != CONST_INT
5515 || (INTVAL (x) != 8 && INTVAL (x) != 16
5516 && INTVAL (x) != 32 && INTVAL (x) != 64))
5517 output_operand_lossage ("invalid %%M value");
5518
5519 fprintf (file, "%s",
5520 (INTVAL (x) == 8 ? "b"
5521 : INTVAL (x) == 16 ? "w"
5522 : INTVAL (x) == 32 ? "l"
5523 : "q"));
5524 break;
5525
5526 case 'U':
5527 /* Similar, except do it from the mask. */
5528 if (GET_CODE (x) == CONST_INT)
5529 {
5530 HOST_WIDE_INT value = INTVAL (x);
5531
5532 if (value == 0xff)
5533 {
5534 fputc ('b', file);
5535 break;
5536 }
5537 if (value == 0xffff)
5538 {
5539 fputc ('w', file);
5540 break;
5541 }
5542 if (value == 0xffffffff)
5543 {
5544 fputc ('l', file);
5545 break;
5546 }
5547 if (value == -1)
5548 {
5549 fputc ('q', file);
5550 break;
5551 }
5552 }
5553 else if (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT == 32
5554 && GET_CODE (x) == CONST_DOUBLE
5555 && CONST_DOUBLE_LOW (x) == 0xffffffff
5556 && CONST_DOUBLE_HIGH (x) == 0)
5557 {
5558 fputc ('l', file);
5559 break;
5560 }
5561 output_operand_lossage ("invalid %%U value");
5562 break;
5563
5564 case 's':
5565 /* Write the constant value divided by 8 for little-endian mode or
5566 (56 - value) / 8 for big-endian mode. */
5567
5568 if (GET_CODE (x) != CONST_INT
5569 || (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) INTVAL (x) >= (WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN
5570 ? 56
5571 : 64)
5572 || (INTVAL (x) & 7) != 0)
5573 output_operand_lossage ("invalid %%s value");
5574
5575 fprintf (file, HOST_WIDE_INT_PRINT_DEC,
5576 WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN
5577 ? (56 - INTVAL (x)) / 8
5578 : INTVAL (x) / 8);
5579 break;
5580
5581 case 'S':
5582 /* Same, except compute (64 - c) / 8 */
5583
5584 if (GET_CODE (x) != CONST_INT
5585 && (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) INTVAL (x) >= 64
5586 && (INTVAL (x) & 7) != 8)
5587 output_operand_lossage ("invalid %%s value");
5588
5589 fprintf (file, HOST_WIDE_INT_PRINT_DEC, (64 - INTVAL (x)) / 8);
5590 break;
5591
5592 case 't':
5593 {
5594 /* On Unicos/Mk systems: use a DEX expression if the symbol
5595 clashes with a register name. */
5596 int dex = unicosmk_need_dex (x);
5597 if (dex)
5598 fprintf (file, "DEX(%d)", dex);
5599 else
5600 output_addr_const (file, x);
5601 }
5602 break;
5603
5604 case 'C': case 'D': case 'c': case 'd':
5605 /* Write out comparison name. */
5606 {
5607 enum rtx_code c = GET_CODE (x);
5608
5609 if (GET_RTX_CLASS (c) != '<')
5610 output_operand_lossage ("invalid %%C value");
5611
5612 else if (code == 'D')
5613 c = reverse_condition (c);
5614 else if (code == 'c')
5615 c = swap_condition (c);
5616 else if (code == 'd')
5617 c = swap_condition (reverse_condition (c));
5618
5619 if (c == LEU)
5620 fprintf (file, "ule");
5621 else if (c == LTU)
5622 fprintf (file, "ult");
5623 else if (c == UNORDERED)
5624 fprintf (file, "un");
5625 else
5626 fprintf (file, "%s", GET_RTX_NAME (c));
5627 }
5628 break;
5629
5630 case 'E':
5631 /* Write the divide or modulus operator. */
5632 switch (GET_CODE (x))
5633 {
5634 case DIV:
5635 fprintf (file, "div%s", GET_MODE (x) == SImode ? "l" : "q");
5636 break;
5637 case UDIV:
5638 fprintf (file, "div%su", GET_MODE (x) == SImode ? "l" : "q");
5639 break;
5640 case MOD:
5641 fprintf (file, "rem%s", GET_MODE (x) == SImode ? "l" : "q");
5642 break;
5643 case UMOD:
5644 fprintf (file, "rem%su", GET_MODE (x) == SImode ? "l" : "q");
5645 break;
5646 default:
5647 output_operand_lossage ("invalid %%E value");
5648 break;
5649 }
5650 break;
5651
5652 case 'A':
5653 /* Write "_u" for unaligned access. */
5654 if (GET_CODE (x) == MEM && GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 0)) == AND)
5655 fprintf (file, "_u");
5656 break;
5657
5658 case 0:
5659 if (GET_CODE (x) == REG)
5660 fprintf (file, "%s", reg_names[REGNO (x)]);
5661 else if (GET_CODE (x) == MEM)
5662 output_address (XEXP (x, 0));
5663 else if (GET_CODE (x) == CONST && GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 0)) == UNSPEC)
5664 {
5665 switch (XINT (XEXP (x, 0), 1))
5666 {
5667 case UNSPEC_DTPREL:
5668 case UNSPEC_TPREL:
5669 output_addr_const (file, XVECEXP (XEXP (x, 0), 0, 0));
5670 break;
5671 default:
5672 output_operand_lossage ("unknown relocation unspec");
5673 break;
5674 }
5675 }
5676 else
5677 output_addr_const (file, x);
5678 break;
5679
5680 default:
5681 output_operand_lossage ("invalid %%xn code");
5682 }
5683 }
5684
5685 void
5686 print_operand_address (FILE *file, rtx addr)
5687 {
5688 int basereg = 31;
5689 HOST_WIDE_INT offset = 0;
5690
5691 if (GET_CODE (addr) == AND)
5692 addr = XEXP (addr, 0);
5693
5694 if (GET_CODE (addr) == PLUS
5695 && GET_CODE (XEXP (addr, 1)) == CONST_INT)
5696 {
5697 offset = INTVAL (XEXP (addr, 1));
5698 addr = XEXP (addr, 0);
5699 }
5700
5701 if (GET_CODE (addr) == LO_SUM)
5702 {
5703 const char *reloc16, *reloclo;
5704 rtx op1 = XEXP (addr, 1);
5705
5706 if (GET_CODE (op1) == CONST && GET_CODE (XEXP (op1, 0)) == UNSPEC)
5707 {
5708 op1 = XEXP (op1, 0);
5709 switch (XINT (op1, 1))
5710 {
5711 case UNSPEC_DTPREL:
5712 reloc16 = NULL;
5713 reloclo = (alpha_tls_size == 16 ? "dtprel" : "dtprello");
5714 break;
5715 case UNSPEC_TPREL:
5716 reloc16 = NULL;
5717 reloclo = (alpha_tls_size == 16 ? "tprel" : "tprello");
5718 break;
5719 default:
5720 output_operand_lossage ("unknown relocation unspec");
5721 return;
5722 }
5723
5724 output_addr_const (file, XVECEXP (op1, 0, 0));
5725 }
5726 else
5727 {
5728 reloc16 = "gprel";
5729 reloclo = "gprellow";
5730 output_addr_const (file, op1);
5731 }
5732
5733 if (offset)
5734 fprintf (file, "+" HOST_WIDE_INT_PRINT_DEC, offset);
5735
5736 addr = XEXP (addr, 0);
5737 if (GET_CODE (addr) == REG)
5738 basereg = REGNO (addr);
5739 else if (GET_CODE (addr) == SUBREG
5740 && GET_CODE (SUBREG_REG (addr)) == REG)
5741 basereg = subreg_regno (addr);
5742 else
5743 abort ();
5744
5745 fprintf (file, "($%d)\t\t!%s", basereg,
5746 (basereg == 29 ? reloc16 : reloclo));
5747 return;
5748 }
5749
5750 if (GET_CODE (addr) == REG)
5751 basereg = REGNO (addr);
5752 else if (GET_CODE (addr) == SUBREG
5753 && GET_CODE (SUBREG_REG (addr)) == REG)
5754 basereg = subreg_regno (addr);
5755 else if (GET_CODE (addr) == CONST_INT)
5756 offset = INTVAL (addr);
5757
5758 #if TARGET_ABI_OPEN_VMS
5759 else if (GET_CODE (addr) == SYMBOL_REF)
5760 {
5761 fprintf (file, "%s", XSTR (addr, 0));
5762 return;
5763 }
5764 else if (GET_CODE (addr) == CONST
5765 && GET_CODE (XEXP (addr, 0)) == PLUS
5766 && GET_CODE (XEXP (XEXP (addr, 0), 0)) == SYMBOL_REF)
5767 {
5768 fprintf (file, "%s+" HOST_WIDE_INT_PRINT_DEC,
5769 XSTR (XEXP (XEXP (addr, 0), 0), 0),
5770 INTVAL (XEXP (XEXP (addr, 0), 1)));
5771 return;
5772 }
5773 #endif
5774
5775 else
5776 abort ();
5777
5778 fprintf (file, HOST_WIDE_INT_PRINT_DEC "($%d)", offset, basereg);
5779 }
5780 \f
5781 /* Emit RTL insns to initialize the variable parts of a trampoline at
5782 TRAMP. FNADDR is an RTX for the address of the function's pure
5783 code. CXT is an RTX for the static chain value for the function.
5784
5785 The three offset parameters are for the individual template's
5786 layout. A JMPOFS < 0 indicates that the trampoline does not
5787 contain instructions at all.
5788
5789 We assume here that a function will be called many more times than
5790 its address is taken (e.g., it might be passed to qsort), so we
5791 take the trouble to initialize the "hint" field in the JMP insn.
5792 Note that the hint field is PC (new) + 4 * bits 13:0. */
5793
5794 void
5795 alpha_initialize_trampoline (rtx tramp, rtx fnaddr, rtx cxt,
5796 int fnofs, int cxtofs, int jmpofs)
5797 {
5798 rtx temp, temp1, addr;
5799 /* VMS really uses DImode pointers in memory at this point. */
5800 enum machine_mode mode = TARGET_ABI_OPEN_VMS ? Pmode : ptr_mode;
5801
5802 #ifdef POINTERS_EXTEND_UNSIGNED
5803 fnaddr = convert_memory_address (mode, fnaddr);
5804 cxt = convert_memory_address (mode, cxt);
5805 #endif
5806
5807 /* Store function address and CXT. */
5808 addr = memory_address (mode, plus_constant (tramp, fnofs));
5809 emit_move_insn (gen_rtx_MEM (mode, addr), fnaddr);
5810 addr = memory_address (mode, plus_constant (tramp, cxtofs));
5811 emit_move_insn (gen_rtx_MEM (mode, addr), cxt);
5812
5813 /* This has been disabled since the hint only has a 32k range, and in
5814 no existing OS is the stack within 32k of the text segment. */
5815 if (0 && jmpofs >= 0)
5816 {
5817 /* Compute hint value. */
5818 temp = force_operand (plus_constant (tramp, jmpofs+4), NULL_RTX);
5819 temp = expand_binop (DImode, sub_optab, fnaddr, temp, temp, 1,
5820 OPTAB_WIDEN);
5821 temp = expand_shift (RSHIFT_EXPR, Pmode, temp,
5822 build_int_2 (2, 0), NULL_RTX, 1);
5823 temp = expand_and (SImode, gen_lowpart (SImode, temp),
5824 GEN_INT (0x3fff), 0);
5825
5826 /* Merge in the hint. */
5827 addr = memory_address (SImode, plus_constant (tramp, jmpofs));
5828 temp1 = force_reg (SImode, gen_rtx_MEM (SImode, addr));
5829 temp1 = expand_and (SImode, temp1, GEN_INT (0xffffc000), NULL_RTX);
5830 temp1 = expand_binop (SImode, ior_optab, temp1, temp, temp1, 1,
5831 OPTAB_WIDEN);
5832 emit_move_insn (gen_rtx_MEM (SImode, addr), temp1);
5833 }
5834
5835 #ifdef TRANSFER_FROM_TRAMPOLINE
5836 emit_library_call (init_one_libfunc ("__enable_execute_stack"),
5837 0, VOIDmode, 1, tramp, Pmode);
5838 #endif
5839
5840 if (jmpofs >= 0)
5841 emit_insn (gen_imb ());
5842 }
5843 \f
5844 /* Determine where to put an argument to a function.
5845 Value is zero to push the argument on the stack,
5846 or a hard register in which to store the argument.
5847
5848 MODE is the argument's machine mode.
5849 TYPE is the data type of the argument (as a tree).
5850 This is null for libcalls where that information may
5851 not be available.
5852 CUM is a variable of type CUMULATIVE_ARGS which gives info about
5853 the preceding args and about the function being called.
5854 NAMED is nonzero if this argument is a named parameter
5855 (otherwise it is an extra parameter matching an ellipsis).
5856
5857 On Alpha the first 6 words of args are normally in registers
5858 and the rest are pushed. */
5859
5860 rtx
5861 function_arg (CUMULATIVE_ARGS cum, enum machine_mode mode, tree type,
5862 int named ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
5863 {
5864 int basereg;
5865 int num_args;
5866
5867 /* Set up defaults for FP operands passed in FP registers, and
5868 integral operands passed in integer registers. */
5869 if (TARGET_FPREGS
5870 && (GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_COMPLEX_FLOAT
5871 || GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_FLOAT))
5872 basereg = 32 + 16;
5873 else
5874 basereg = 16;
5875
5876 /* ??? Irritatingly, the definition of CUMULATIVE_ARGS is different for
5877 the three platforms, so we can't avoid conditional compilation. */
5878 #if TARGET_ABI_OPEN_VMS
5879 {
5880 if (mode == VOIDmode)
5881 return alpha_arg_info_reg_val (cum);
5882
5883 num_args = cum.num_args;
5884 if (num_args >= 6 || MUST_PASS_IN_STACK (mode, type))
5885 return NULL_RTX;
5886 }
5887 #else
5888 #if TARGET_ABI_UNICOSMK
5889 {
5890 int size;
5891
5892 /* If this is the last argument, generate the call info word (CIW). */
5893 /* ??? We don't include the caller's line number in the CIW because
5894 I don't know how to determine it if debug infos are turned off. */
5895 if (mode == VOIDmode)
5896 {
5897 int i;
5898 HOST_WIDE_INT lo;
5899 HOST_WIDE_INT hi;
5900 rtx ciw;
5901
5902 lo = 0;
5903
5904 for (i = 0; i < cum.num_reg_words && i < 5; i++)
5905 if (cum.reg_args_type[i])
5906 lo |= (1 << (7 - i));
5907
5908 if (cum.num_reg_words == 6 && cum.reg_args_type[5])
5909 lo |= 7;
5910 else
5911 lo |= cum.num_reg_words;
5912
5913 #if HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT == 32
5914 hi = (cum.num_args << 20) | cum.num_arg_words;
5915 #else
5916 lo = lo | ((HOST_WIDE_INT) cum.num_args << 52)
5917 | ((HOST_WIDE_INT) cum.num_arg_words << 32);
5918 hi = 0;
5919 #endif
5920 ciw = immed_double_const (lo, hi, DImode);
5921
5922 return gen_rtx_UNSPEC (DImode, gen_rtvec (1, ciw),
5923 UNSPEC_UMK_LOAD_CIW);
5924 }
5925
5926 size = ALPHA_ARG_SIZE (mode, type, named);
5927 num_args = cum.num_reg_words;
5928 if (MUST_PASS_IN_STACK (mode, type)
5929 || cum.num_reg_words + size > 6 || cum.force_stack)
5930 return NULL_RTX;
5931 else if (type && TYPE_MODE (type) == BLKmode)
5932 {
5933 rtx reg1, reg2;
5934
5935 reg1 = gen_rtx_REG (DImode, num_args + 16);
5936 reg1 = gen_rtx_EXPR_LIST (DImode, reg1, const0_rtx);
5937
5938 /* The argument fits in two registers. Note that we still need to
5939 reserve a register for empty structures. */
5940 if (size == 0)
5941 return NULL_RTX;
5942 else if (size == 1)
5943 return gen_rtx_PARALLEL (mode, gen_rtvec (1, reg1));
5944 else
5945 {
5946 reg2 = gen_rtx_REG (DImode, num_args + 17);
5947 reg2 = gen_rtx_EXPR_LIST (DImode, reg2, GEN_INT (8));
5948 return gen_rtx_PARALLEL (mode, gen_rtvec (2, reg1, reg2));
5949 }
5950 }
5951 }
5952 #else
5953 {
5954 if (cum >= 6)
5955 return NULL_RTX;
5956 num_args = cum;
5957
5958 /* VOID is passed as a special flag for "last argument". */
5959 if (type == void_type_node)
5960 basereg = 16;
5961 else if (MUST_PASS_IN_STACK (mode, type))
5962 return NULL_RTX;
5963 else if (FUNCTION_ARG_PASS_BY_REFERENCE (cum, mode, type, named))
5964 basereg = 16;
5965 }
5966 #endif /* TARGET_ABI_UNICOSMK */
5967 #endif /* TARGET_ABI_OPEN_VMS */
5968
5969 return gen_rtx_REG (mode, num_args + basereg);
5970 }
5971
5972 tree
5973 alpha_build_va_list (void)
5974 {
5975 tree base, ofs, record, type_decl;
5976
5977 if (TARGET_ABI_OPEN_VMS || TARGET_ABI_UNICOSMK)
5978 return ptr_type_node;
5979
5980 record = (*lang_hooks.types.make_type) (RECORD_TYPE);
5981 type_decl = build_decl (TYPE_DECL, get_identifier ("__va_list_tag"), record);
5982 TREE_CHAIN (record) = type_decl;
5983 TYPE_NAME (record) = type_decl;
5984
5985 /* C++? SET_IS_AGGR_TYPE (record, 1); */
5986
5987 ofs = build_decl (FIELD_DECL, get_identifier ("__offset"),
5988 integer_type_node);
5989 DECL_FIELD_CONTEXT (ofs) = record;
5990
5991 base = build_decl (FIELD_DECL, get_identifier ("__base"),
5992 ptr_type_node);
5993 DECL_FIELD_CONTEXT (base) = record;
5994 TREE_CHAIN (base) = ofs;
5995
5996 TYPE_FIELDS (record) = base;
5997 layout_type (record);
5998
5999 return record;
6000 }
6001
6002 /* Perform any needed actions needed for a function that is receiving a
6003 variable number of arguments.
6004
6005 On the Alpha, we allocate space for all 12 arg registers, but only
6006 push those that are remaining. However, if NO registers need to be
6007 saved, don't allocate any space. This is not only because we won't
6008 need the space, but because AP includes the current_pretend_args_size
6009 and we don't want to mess up any ap-relative addresses already made.
6010
6011 If we are not to use the floating-point registers, save the integer
6012 registers where we would put the floating-point registers. This is
6013 not the most efficient way to implement varargs with just one register
6014 class, but it isn't worth doing anything more efficient in this rare
6015 case. */
6016
6017 #if TARGET_ABI_OSF
6018 void
6019 alpha_setup_incoming_varargs(CUMULATIVE_ARGS cum,
6020 enum machine_mode mode ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
6021 tree type ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
6022 int *pretend_size, int no_rtl)
6023 {
6024 if (cum >= 6)
6025 return;
6026
6027 if (!no_rtl)
6028 {
6029 int set = get_varargs_alias_set ();
6030 rtx tmp;
6031
6032 tmp = gen_rtx_MEM (BLKmode,
6033 plus_constant (virtual_incoming_args_rtx,
6034 (cum + 6) * UNITS_PER_WORD));
6035 set_mem_alias_set (tmp, set);
6036 move_block_from_reg (16 + cum, tmp, 6 - cum);
6037
6038 tmp = gen_rtx_MEM (BLKmode,
6039 plus_constant (virtual_incoming_args_rtx,
6040 cum * UNITS_PER_WORD));
6041 set_mem_alias_set (tmp, set);
6042 move_block_from_reg (16 + (TARGET_FPREGS ? 32 : 0) + cum, tmp,
6043 6 - cum);
6044 }
6045 *pretend_size = 12 * UNITS_PER_WORD;
6046 }
6047 #endif
6048
6049 void
6050 alpha_va_start (tree valist, rtx nextarg ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
6051 {
6052 HOST_WIDE_INT offset;
6053 tree t, offset_field, base_field;
6054
6055 if (TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (valist)) == ERROR_MARK)
6056 return;
6057
6058 if (TARGET_ABI_UNICOSMK)
6059 std_expand_builtin_va_start (valist, nextarg);
6060
6061 /* For Unix, SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS moves the starting address base
6062 up by 48, storing fp arg registers in the first 48 bytes, and the
6063 integer arg registers in the next 48 bytes. This is only done,
6064 however, if any integer registers need to be stored.
6065
6066 If no integer registers need be stored, then we must subtract 48
6067 in order to account for the integer arg registers which are counted
6068 in argsize above, but which are not actually stored on the stack.
6069 Must further be careful here about structures straddling the last
6070 integer argument register; that futzes with pretend_args_size,
6071 which changes the meaning of AP. */
6072
6073 if (NUM_ARGS <= 6)
6074 offset = TARGET_ABI_OPEN_VMS ? UNITS_PER_WORD : 6 * UNITS_PER_WORD;
6075 else
6076 offset = -6 * UNITS_PER_WORD + current_function_pretend_args_size;
6077
6078 if (TARGET_ABI_OPEN_VMS)
6079 {
6080 nextarg = plus_constant (nextarg, offset);
6081 nextarg = plus_constant (nextarg, NUM_ARGS * UNITS_PER_WORD);
6082 t = build (MODIFY_EXPR, TREE_TYPE (valist), valist,
6083 make_tree (ptr_type_node, nextarg));
6084 TREE_SIDE_EFFECTS (t) = 1;
6085
6086 expand_expr (t, const0_rtx, VOIDmode, EXPAND_NORMAL);
6087 }
6088 else
6089 {
6090 base_field = TYPE_FIELDS (TREE_TYPE (valist));
6091 offset_field = TREE_CHAIN (base_field);
6092
6093 base_field = build (COMPONENT_REF, TREE_TYPE (base_field),
6094 valist, base_field);
6095 offset_field = build (COMPONENT_REF, TREE_TYPE (offset_field),
6096 valist, offset_field);
6097
6098 t = make_tree (ptr_type_node, virtual_incoming_args_rtx);
6099 t = build (PLUS_EXPR, ptr_type_node, t, build_int_2 (offset, 0));
6100 t = build (MODIFY_EXPR, TREE_TYPE (base_field), base_field, t);
6101 TREE_SIDE_EFFECTS (t) = 1;
6102 expand_expr (t, const0_rtx, VOIDmode, EXPAND_NORMAL);
6103
6104 t = build_int_2 (NUM_ARGS * UNITS_PER_WORD, 0);
6105 t = build (MODIFY_EXPR, TREE_TYPE (offset_field), offset_field, t);
6106 TREE_SIDE_EFFECTS (t) = 1;
6107 expand_expr (t, const0_rtx, VOIDmode, EXPAND_NORMAL);
6108 }
6109 }
6110
6111 rtx
6112 alpha_va_arg (tree valist, tree type)
6113 {
6114 rtx addr;
6115 tree t, type_size, rounded_size;
6116 tree offset_field, base_field, addr_tree, addend;
6117 tree wide_type, wide_ofs;
6118 int indirect = 0;
6119
6120 if (TARGET_ABI_OPEN_VMS || TARGET_ABI_UNICOSMK)
6121 return std_expand_builtin_va_arg (valist, type);
6122
6123 if (type == error_mark_node
6124 || (type_size = TYPE_SIZE_UNIT (TYPE_MAIN_VARIANT (type))) == NULL
6125 || TREE_OVERFLOW (type_size))
6126 rounded_size = size_zero_node;
6127 else
6128 rounded_size = fold (build (MULT_EXPR, sizetype,
6129 fold (build (TRUNC_DIV_EXPR, sizetype,
6130 fold (build (PLUS_EXPR, sizetype,
6131 type_size,
6132 size_int (7))),
6133 size_int (8))),
6134 size_int (8)));
6135
6136 base_field = TYPE_FIELDS (TREE_TYPE (valist));
6137 offset_field = TREE_CHAIN (base_field);
6138
6139 base_field = build (COMPONENT_REF, TREE_TYPE (base_field),
6140 valist, base_field);
6141 offset_field = build (COMPONENT_REF, TREE_TYPE (offset_field),
6142 valist, offset_field);
6143
6144 /* If the type could not be passed in registers, skip the block
6145 reserved for the registers. */
6146 if (MUST_PASS_IN_STACK (TYPE_MODE (type), type))
6147 {
6148 t = build (MODIFY_EXPR, TREE_TYPE (offset_field), offset_field,
6149 build (MAX_EXPR, TREE_TYPE (offset_field),
6150 offset_field, build_int_2 (6*8, 0)));
6151 TREE_SIDE_EFFECTS (t) = 1;
6152 expand_expr (t, const0_rtx, VOIDmode, EXPAND_NORMAL);
6153 }
6154
6155 wide_type = make_signed_type (64);
6156 wide_ofs = save_expr (build1 (CONVERT_EXPR, wide_type, offset_field));
6157
6158 addend = wide_ofs;
6159
6160 if (TYPE_MODE (type) == TFmode || TYPE_MODE (type) == TCmode)
6161 {
6162 indirect = 1;
6163 rounded_size = size_int (UNITS_PER_WORD);
6164 }
6165 else if (FLOAT_TYPE_P (type))
6166 {
6167 tree fpaddend, cond;
6168
6169 fpaddend = fold (build (PLUS_EXPR, TREE_TYPE (addend),
6170 addend, build_int_2 (-6*8, 0)));
6171
6172 cond = fold (build (LT_EXPR, integer_type_node,
6173 wide_ofs, build_int_2 (6*8, 0)));
6174
6175 addend = fold (build (COND_EXPR, TREE_TYPE (addend), cond,
6176 fpaddend, addend));
6177 }
6178
6179 addr_tree = build (PLUS_EXPR, TREE_TYPE (base_field),
6180 base_field, addend);
6181
6182 addr = expand_expr (addr_tree, NULL_RTX, Pmode, EXPAND_NORMAL);
6183 addr = copy_to_reg (addr);
6184
6185 t = build (MODIFY_EXPR, TREE_TYPE (offset_field), offset_field,
6186 build (PLUS_EXPR, TREE_TYPE (offset_field),
6187 offset_field, rounded_size));
6188 TREE_SIDE_EFFECTS (t) = 1;
6189 expand_expr (t, const0_rtx, VOIDmode, EXPAND_NORMAL);
6190
6191 if (indirect)
6192 {
6193 addr = force_reg (Pmode, addr);
6194 addr = gen_rtx_MEM (Pmode, addr);
6195 }
6196
6197 return addr;
6198 }
6199 \f
6200 /* Builtins. */
6201
6202 enum alpha_builtin
6203 {
6204 ALPHA_BUILTIN_CMPBGE,
6205 ALPHA_BUILTIN_EXTBL,
6206 ALPHA_BUILTIN_EXTWL,
6207 ALPHA_BUILTIN_EXTLL,
6208 ALPHA_BUILTIN_EXTQL,
6209 ALPHA_BUILTIN_EXTWH,
6210 ALPHA_BUILTIN_EXTLH,
6211 ALPHA_BUILTIN_EXTQH,
6212 ALPHA_BUILTIN_INSBL,
6213 ALPHA_BUILTIN_INSWL,
6214 ALPHA_BUILTIN_INSLL,
6215 ALPHA_BUILTIN_INSQL,
6216 ALPHA_BUILTIN_INSWH,
6217 ALPHA_BUILTIN_INSLH,
6218 ALPHA_BUILTIN_INSQH,
6219 ALPHA_BUILTIN_MSKBL,
6220 ALPHA_BUILTIN_MSKWL,
6221 ALPHA_BUILTIN_MSKLL,
6222 ALPHA_BUILTIN_MSKQL,
6223 ALPHA_BUILTIN_MSKWH,
6224 ALPHA_BUILTIN_MSKLH,
6225 ALPHA_BUILTIN_MSKQH,
6226 ALPHA_BUILTIN_UMULH,
6227 ALPHA_BUILTIN_ZAP,
6228 ALPHA_BUILTIN_ZAPNOT,
6229 ALPHA_BUILTIN_AMASK,
6230 ALPHA_BUILTIN_IMPLVER,
6231 ALPHA_BUILTIN_RPCC,
6232 ALPHA_BUILTIN_THREAD_POINTER,
6233 ALPHA_BUILTIN_SET_THREAD_POINTER,
6234
6235 /* TARGET_MAX */
6236 ALPHA_BUILTIN_MINUB8,
6237 ALPHA_BUILTIN_MINSB8,
6238 ALPHA_BUILTIN_MINUW4,
6239 ALPHA_BUILTIN_MINSW4,
6240 ALPHA_BUILTIN_MAXUB8,
6241 ALPHA_BUILTIN_MAXSB8,
6242 ALPHA_BUILTIN_MAXUW4,
6243 ALPHA_BUILTIN_MAXSW4,
6244 ALPHA_BUILTIN_PERR,
6245 ALPHA_BUILTIN_PKLB,
6246 ALPHA_BUILTIN_PKWB,
6247 ALPHA_BUILTIN_UNPKBL,
6248 ALPHA_BUILTIN_UNPKBW,
6249
6250 /* TARGET_CIX */
6251 ALPHA_BUILTIN_CTTZ,
6252 ALPHA_BUILTIN_CTLZ,
6253 ALPHA_BUILTIN_CTPOP,
6254
6255 ALPHA_BUILTIN_max
6256 };
6257
6258 static unsigned int const code_for_builtin[ALPHA_BUILTIN_max] = {
6259 CODE_FOR_builtin_cmpbge,
6260 CODE_FOR_builtin_extbl,
6261 CODE_FOR_builtin_extwl,
6262 CODE_FOR_builtin_extll,
6263 CODE_FOR_builtin_extql,
6264 CODE_FOR_builtin_extwh,
6265 CODE_FOR_builtin_extlh,
6266 CODE_FOR_builtin_extqh,
6267 CODE_FOR_builtin_insbl,
6268 CODE_FOR_builtin_inswl,
6269 CODE_FOR_builtin_insll,
6270 CODE_FOR_builtin_insql,
6271 CODE_FOR_builtin_inswh,
6272 CODE_FOR_builtin_inslh,
6273 CODE_FOR_builtin_insqh,
6274 CODE_FOR_builtin_mskbl,
6275 CODE_FOR_builtin_mskwl,
6276 CODE_FOR_builtin_mskll,
6277 CODE_FOR_builtin_mskql,
6278 CODE_FOR_builtin_mskwh,
6279 CODE_FOR_builtin_msklh,
6280 CODE_FOR_builtin_mskqh,
6281 CODE_FOR_umuldi3_highpart,
6282 CODE_FOR_builtin_zap,
6283 CODE_FOR_builtin_zapnot,
6284 CODE_FOR_builtin_amask,
6285 CODE_FOR_builtin_implver,
6286 CODE_FOR_builtin_rpcc,
6287 CODE_FOR_load_tp,
6288 CODE_FOR_set_tp,
6289
6290 /* TARGET_MAX */
6291 CODE_FOR_builtin_minub8,
6292 CODE_FOR_builtin_minsb8,
6293 CODE_FOR_builtin_minuw4,
6294 CODE_FOR_builtin_minsw4,
6295 CODE_FOR_builtin_maxub8,
6296 CODE_FOR_builtin_maxsb8,
6297 CODE_FOR_builtin_maxuw4,
6298 CODE_FOR_builtin_maxsw4,
6299 CODE_FOR_builtin_perr,
6300 CODE_FOR_builtin_pklb,
6301 CODE_FOR_builtin_pkwb,
6302 CODE_FOR_builtin_unpkbl,
6303 CODE_FOR_builtin_unpkbw,
6304
6305 /* TARGET_CIX */
6306 CODE_FOR_builtin_cttz,
6307 CODE_FOR_builtin_ctlz,
6308 CODE_FOR_builtin_ctpop
6309 };
6310
6311 struct alpha_builtin_def
6312 {
6313 const char *name;
6314 enum alpha_builtin code;
6315 unsigned int target_mask;
6316 };
6317
6318 static struct alpha_builtin_def const zero_arg_builtins[] = {
6319 { "__builtin_alpha_implver", ALPHA_BUILTIN_IMPLVER, 0 },
6320 { "__builtin_alpha_rpcc", ALPHA_BUILTIN_RPCC, 0 }
6321 };
6322
6323 static struct alpha_builtin_def const one_arg_builtins[] = {
6324 { "__builtin_alpha_amask", ALPHA_BUILTIN_AMASK, 0 },
6325 { "__builtin_alpha_pklb", ALPHA_BUILTIN_PKLB, MASK_MAX },
6326 { "__builtin_alpha_pkwb", ALPHA_BUILTIN_PKWB, MASK_MAX },
6327 { "__builtin_alpha_unpkbl", ALPHA_BUILTIN_UNPKBL, MASK_MAX },
6328 { "__builtin_alpha_unpkbw", ALPHA_BUILTIN_UNPKBW, MASK_MAX },
6329 { "__builtin_alpha_cttz", ALPHA_BUILTIN_CTTZ, MASK_CIX },
6330 { "__builtin_alpha_ctlz", ALPHA_BUILTIN_CTLZ, MASK_CIX },
6331 { "__builtin_alpha_ctpop", ALPHA_BUILTIN_CTPOP, MASK_CIX }
6332 };
6333
6334 static struct alpha_builtin_def const two_arg_builtins[] = {
6335 { "__builtin_alpha_cmpbge", ALPHA_BUILTIN_CMPBGE, 0 },
6336 { "__builtin_alpha_extbl", ALPHA_BUILTIN_EXTBL, 0 },
6337 { "__builtin_alpha_extwl", ALPHA_BUILTIN_EXTWL, 0 },
6338 { "__builtin_alpha_extll", ALPHA_BUILTIN_EXTLL, 0 },
6339 { "__builtin_alpha_extql", ALPHA_BUILTIN_EXTQL, 0 },
6340 { "__builtin_alpha_extwh", ALPHA_BUILTIN_EXTWH, 0 },
6341 { "__builtin_alpha_extlh", ALPHA_BUILTIN_EXTLH, 0 },
6342 { "__builtin_alpha_extqh", ALPHA_BUILTIN_EXTQH, 0 },
6343 { "__builtin_alpha_insbl", ALPHA_BUILTIN_INSBL, 0 },
6344 { "__builtin_alpha_inswl", ALPHA_BUILTIN_INSWL, 0 },
6345 { "__builtin_alpha_insll", ALPHA_BUILTIN_INSLL, 0 },
6346 { "__builtin_alpha_insql", ALPHA_BUILTIN_INSQL, 0 },
6347 { "__builtin_alpha_inswh", ALPHA_BUILTIN_INSWH, 0 },
6348 { "__builtin_alpha_inslh", ALPHA_BUILTIN_INSLH, 0 },
6349 { "__builtin_alpha_insqh", ALPHA_BUILTIN_INSQH, 0 },
6350 { "__builtin_alpha_mskbl", ALPHA_BUILTIN_MSKBL, 0 },
6351 { "__builtin_alpha_mskwl", ALPHA_BUILTIN_MSKWL, 0 },
6352 { "__builtin_alpha_mskll", ALPHA_BUILTIN_MSKLL, 0 },
6353 { "__builtin_alpha_mskql", ALPHA_BUILTIN_MSKQL, 0 },
6354 { "__builtin_alpha_mskwh", ALPHA_BUILTIN_MSKWH, 0 },
6355 { "__builtin_alpha_msklh", ALPHA_BUILTIN_MSKLH, 0 },
6356 { "__builtin_alpha_mskqh", ALPHA_BUILTIN_MSKQH, 0 },
6357 { "__builtin_alpha_umulh", ALPHA_BUILTIN_UMULH, 0 },
6358 { "__builtin_alpha_zap", ALPHA_BUILTIN_ZAP, 0 },
6359 { "__builtin_alpha_zapnot", ALPHA_BUILTIN_ZAPNOT, 0 },
6360 { "__builtin_alpha_minub8", ALPHA_BUILTIN_MINUB8, MASK_MAX },
6361 { "__builtin_alpha_minsb8", ALPHA_BUILTIN_MINSB8, MASK_MAX },
6362 { "__builtin_alpha_minuw4", ALPHA_BUILTIN_MINUW4, MASK_MAX },
6363 { "__builtin_alpha_minsw4", ALPHA_BUILTIN_MINSW4, MASK_MAX },
6364 { "__builtin_alpha_maxub8", ALPHA_BUILTIN_MAXUB8, MASK_MAX },
6365 { "__builtin_alpha_maxsb8", ALPHA_BUILTIN_MAXSB8, MASK_MAX },
6366 { "__builtin_alpha_maxuw4", ALPHA_BUILTIN_MAXUW4, MASK_MAX },
6367 { "__builtin_alpha_maxsw4", ALPHA_BUILTIN_MAXSW4, MASK_MAX },
6368 { "__builtin_alpha_perr", ALPHA_BUILTIN_PERR, MASK_MAX }
6369 };
6370
6371 static void
6372 alpha_init_builtins (void)
6373 {
6374 const struct alpha_builtin_def *p;
6375 tree ftype;
6376 size_t i;
6377
6378 ftype = build_function_type (long_integer_type_node, void_list_node);
6379
6380 p = zero_arg_builtins;
6381 for (i = 0; i < ARRAY_SIZE (zero_arg_builtins); ++i, ++p)
6382 if ((target_flags & p->target_mask) == p->target_mask)
6383 builtin_function (p->name, ftype, p->code, BUILT_IN_MD,
6384 NULL, NULL_TREE);
6385
6386 ftype = build_function_type_list (long_integer_type_node,
6387 long_integer_type_node, NULL_TREE);
6388
6389 p = one_arg_builtins;
6390 for (i = 0; i < ARRAY_SIZE (one_arg_builtins); ++i, ++p)
6391 if ((target_flags & p->target_mask) == p->target_mask)
6392 builtin_function (p->name, ftype, p->code, BUILT_IN_MD,
6393 NULL, NULL_TREE);
6394
6395 ftype = build_function_type_list (long_integer_type_node,
6396 long_integer_type_node,
6397 long_integer_type_node, NULL_TREE);
6398
6399 p = two_arg_builtins;
6400 for (i = 0; i < ARRAY_SIZE (two_arg_builtins); ++i, ++p)
6401 if ((target_flags & p->target_mask) == p->target_mask)
6402 builtin_function (p->name, ftype, p->code, BUILT_IN_MD,
6403 NULL, NULL_TREE);
6404
6405 ftype = build_function_type (ptr_type_node, void_list_node);
6406 builtin_function ("__builtin_thread_pointer", ftype,
6407 ALPHA_BUILTIN_THREAD_POINTER, BUILT_IN_MD,
6408 NULL, NULL_TREE);
6409
6410 ftype = build_function_type_list (void_type_node, ptr_type_node, NULL_TREE);
6411 builtin_function ("__builtin_set_thread_pointer", ftype,
6412 ALPHA_BUILTIN_SET_THREAD_POINTER, BUILT_IN_MD,
6413 NULL, NULL_TREE);
6414 }
6415
6416 /* Expand an expression EXP that calls a built-in function,
6417 with result going to TARGET if that's convenient
6418 (and in mode MODE if that's convenient).
6419 SUBTARGET may be used as the target for computing one of EXP's operands.
6420 IGNORE is nonzero if the value is to be ignored. */
6421
6422 static rtx
6423 alpha_expand_builtin (tree exp, rtx target,
6424 rtx subtarget ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
6425 enum machine_mode mode ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
6426 int ignore ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
6427 {
6428 #define MAX_ARGS 2
6429
6430 tree fndecl = TREE_OPERAND (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), 0);
6431 unsigned int fcode = DECL_FUNCTION_CODE (fndecl);
6432 tree arglist = TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1);
6433 enum insn_code icode;
6434 rtx op[MAX_ARGS], pat;
6435 int arity;
6436 bool nonvoid;
6437
6438 if (fcode >= ALPHA_BUILTIN_max)
6439 internal_error ("bad builtin fcode");
6440 icode = code_for_builtin[fcode];
6441 if (icode == 0)
6442 internal_error ("bad builtin fcode");
6443
6444 nonvoid = TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (fndecl)) != void_type_node;
6445
6446 for (arglist = TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1), arity = 0;
6447 arglist;
6448 arglist = TREE_CHAIN (arglist), arity++)
6449 {
6450 const struct insn_operand_data *insn_op;
6451
6452 tree arg = TREE_VALUE (arglist);
6453 if (arg == error_mark_node)
6454 return NULL_RTX;
6455 if (arity > MAX_ARGS)
6456 return NULL_RTX;
6457
6458 insn_op = &insn_data[icode].operand[arity + nonvoid];
6459
6460 op[arity] = expand_expr (arg, NULL_RTX, insn_op->mode, 0);
6461
6462 if (!(*insn_op->predicate) (op[arity], insn_op->mode))
6463 op[arity] = copy_to_mode_reg (insn_op->mode, op[arity]);
6464 }
6465
6466 if (nonvoid)
6467 {
6468 enum machine_mode tmode = insn_data[icode].operand[0].mode;
6469 if (!target
6470 || GET_MODE (target) != tmode
6471 || !(*insn_data[icode].operand[0].predicate) (target, tmode))
6472 target = gen_reg_rtx (tmode);
6473 }
6474
6475 switch (arity)
6476 {
6477 case 0:
6478 pat = GEN_FCN (icode) (target);
6479 break;
6480 case 1:
6481 if (nonvoid)
6482 pat = GEN_FCN (icode) (target, op[0]);
6483 else
6484 pat = GEN_FCN (icode) (op[0]);
6485 break;
6486 case 2:
6487 pat = GEN_FCN (icode) (target, op[0], op[1]);
6488 break;
6489 default:
6490 abort ();
6491 }
6492 if (!pat)
6493 return NULL_RTX;
6494 emit_insn (pat);
6495
6496 if (nonvoid)
6497 return target;
6498 else
6499 return const0_rtx;
6500 }
6501 \f
6502 /* This page contains routines that are used to determine what the function
6503 prologue and epilogue code will do and write them out. */
6504
6505 /* Compute the size of the save area in the stack. */
6506
6507 /* These variables are used for communication between the following functions.
6508 They indicate various things about the current function being compiled
6509 that are used to tell what kind of prologue, epilogue and procedure
6510 descriptior to generate. */
6511
6512 /* Nonzero if we need a stack procedure. */
6513 enum alpha_procedure_types {PT_NULL = 0, PT_REGISTER = 1, PT_STACK = 2};
6514 static enum alpha_procedure_types alpha_procedure_type;
6515
6516 /* Register number (either FP or SP) that is used to unwind the frame. */
6517 static int vms_unwind_regno;
6518
6519 /* Register number used to save FP. We need not have one for RA since
6520 we don't modify it for register procedures. This is only defined
6521 for register frame procedures. */
6522 static int vms_save_fp_regno;
6523
6524 /* Register number used to reference objects off our PV. */
6525 static int vms_base_regno;
6526
6527 /* Compute register masks for saved registers. */
6528
6529 static void
6530 alpha_sa_mask (unsigned long *imaskP, unsigned long *fmaskP)
6531 {
6532 unsigned long imask = 0;
6533 unsigned long fmask = 0;
6534 unsigned int i;
6535
6536 /* Irritatingly, there are two kinds of thunks -- those created with
6537 TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_MI_THUNK and those with DECL_THUNK_P that go
6538 through the regular part of the compiler. In the
6539 TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_MI_THUNK case we don't have valid register life
6540 info, but assemble_start_function wants to output .frame and
6541 .mask directives. */
6542 if (current_function_is_thunk && !no_new_pseudos)
6543 {
6544 *imaskP = 0;
6545 *fmaskP = 0;
6546 return;
6547 }
6548
6549 if (TARGET_ABI_OPEN_VMS && alpha_procedure_type == PT_STACK)
6550 imask |= (1UL << HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM);
6551
6552 /* One for every register we have to save. */
6553 for (i = 0; i < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER; i++)
6554 if (! fixed_regs[i] && ! call_used_regs[i]
6555 && regs_ever_live[i] && i != REG_RA
6556 && (!TARGET_ABI_UNICOSMK || i != HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM))
6557 {
6558 if (i < 32)
6559 imask |= (1UL << i);
6560 else
6561 fmask |= (1UL << (i - 32));
6562 }
6563
6564 /* We need to restore these for the handler. */
6565 if (current_function_calls_eh_return)
6566 for (i = 0; ; ++i)
6567 {
6568 unsigned regno = EH_RETURN_DATA_REGNO (i);
6569 if (regno == INVALID_REGNUM)
6570 break;
6571 imask |= 1UL << regno;
6572 }
6573
6574 /* If any register spilled, then spill the return address also. */
6575 /* ??? This is required by the Digital stack unwind specification
6576 and isn't needed if we're doing Dwarf2 unwinding. */
6577 if (imask || fmask || alpha_ra_ever_killed ())
6578 imask |= (1UL << REG_RA);
6579
6580 *imaskP = imask;
6581 *fmaskP = fmask;
6582 }
6583
6584 int
6585 alpha_sa_size (void)
6586 {
6587 unsigned long mask[2];
6588 int sa_size = 0;
6589 int i, j;
6590
6591 alpha_sa_mask (&mask[0], &mask[1]);
6592
6593 if (TARGET_ABI_UNICOSMK)
6594 {
6595 if (mask[0] || mask[1])
6596 sa_size = 14;
6597 }
6598 else
6599 {
6600 for (j = 0; j < 2; ++j)
6601 for (i = 0; i < 32; ++i)
6602 if ((mask[j] >> i) & 1)
6603 sa_size++;
6604 }
6605
6606 if (TARGET_ABI_UNICOSMK)
6607 {
6608 /* We might not need to generate a frame if we don't make any calls
6609 (including calls to __T3E_MISMATCH if this is a vararg function),
6610 don't have any local variables which require stack slots, don't
6611 use alloca and have not determined that we need a frame for other
6612 reasons. */
6613
6614 alpha_procedure_type
6615 = (sa_size || get_frame_size() != 0
6616 || current_function_outgoing_args_size
6617 || current_function_stdarg || current_function_calls_alloca
6618 || frame_pointer_needed)
6619 ? PT_STACK : PT_REGISTER;
6620
6621 /* Always reserve space for saving callee-saved registers if we
6622 need a frame as required by the calling convention. */
6623 if (alpha_procedure_type == PT_STACK)
6624 sa_size = 14;
6625 }
6626 else if (TARGET_ABI_OPEN_VMS)
6627 {
6628 /* Start by assuming we can use a register procedure if we don't
6629 make any calls (REG_RA not used) or need to save any
6630 registers and a stack procedure if we do. */
6631 if ((mask[0] >> REG_RA) & 1)
6632 alpha_procedure_type = PT_STACK;
6633 else if (get_frame_size() != 0)
6634 alpha_procedure_type = PT_REGISTER;
6635 else
6636 alpha_procedure_type = PT_NULL;
6637
6638 /* Don't reserve space for saving FP & RA yet. Do that later after we've
6639 made the final decision on stack procedure vs register procedure. */
6640 if (alpha_procedure_type == PT_STACK)
6641 sa_size -= 2;
6642
6643 /* Decide whether to refer to objects off our PV via FP or PV.
6644 If we need FP for something else or if we receive a nonlocal
6645 goto (which expects PV to contain the value), we must use PV.
6646 Otherwise, start by assuming we can use FP. */
6647
6648 vms_base_regno
6649 = (frame_pointer_needed
6650 || current_function_has_nonlocal_label
6651 || alpha_procedure_type == PT_STACK
6652 || current_function_outgoing_args_size)
6653 ? REG_PV : HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM;
6654
6655 /* If we want to copy PV into FP, we need to find some register
6656 in which to save FP. */
6657
6658 vms_save_fp_regno = -1;
6659 if (vms_base_regno == HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM)
6660 for (i = 0; i < 32; i++)
6661 if (! fixed_regs[i] && call_used_regs[i] && ! regs_ever_live[i])
6662 vms_save_fp_regno = i;
6663
6664 if (vms_save_fp_regno == -1 && alpha_procedure_type == PT_REGISTER)
6665 vms_base_regno = REG_PV, alpha_procedure_type = PT_STACK;
6666 else if (alpha_procedure_type == PT_NULL)
6667 vms_base_regno = REG_PV;
6668
6669 /* Stack unwinding should be done via FP unless we use it for PV. */
6670 vms_unwind_regno = (vms_base_regno == REG_PV
6671 ? HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM : STACK_POINTER_REGNUM);
6672
6673 /* If this is a stack procedure, allow space for saving FP and RA. */
6674 if (alpha_procedure_type == PT_STACK)
6675 sa_size += 2;
6676 }
6677 else
6678 {
6679 /* Our size must be even (multiple of 16 bytes). */
6680 if (sa_size & 1)
6681 sa_size++;
6682 }
6683
6684 return sa_size * 8;
6685 }
6686
6687 /* Define the offset between two registers, one to be eliminated,
6688 and the other its replacement, at the start of a routine. */
6689
6690 HOST_WIDE_INT
6691 alpha_initial_elimination_offset (unsigned int from,
6692 unsigned int to ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
6693 {
6694 HOST_WIDE_INT ret;
6695
6696 ret = alpha_sa_size ();
6697 ret += ALPHA_ROUND (current_function_outgoing_args_size);
6698
6699 if (from == FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM)
6700 ;
6701 else if (from == ARG_POINTER_REGNUM)
6702 ret += (ALPHA_ROUND (get_frame_size ()
6703 + current_function_pretend_args_size)
6704 - current_function_pretend_args_size);
6705 else
6706 abort ();
6707
6708 return ret;
6709 }
6710
6711 int
6712 alpha_pv_save_size (void)
6713 {
6714 alpha_sa_size ();
6715 return alpha_procedure_type == PT_STACK ? 8 : 0;
6716 }
6717
6718 int
6719 alpha_using_fp (void)
6720 {
6721 alpha_sa_size ();
6722 return vms_unwind_regno == HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM;
6723 }
6724
6725 #if TARGET_ABI_OPEN_VMS
6726
6727 const struct attribute_spec vms_attribute_table[] =
6728 {
6729 /* { name, min_len, max_len, decl_req, type_req, fn_type_req, handler } */
6730 { "overlaid", 0, 0, true, false, false, NULL },
6731 { "global", 0, 0, true, false, false, NULL },
6732 { "initialize", 0, 0, true, false, false, NULL },
6733 { NULL, 0, 0, false, false, false, NULL }
6734 };
6735
6736 #endif
6737
6738 static int
6739 find_lo_sum_using_gp (rtx *px, void *data ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
6740 {
6741 return GET_CODE (*px) == LO_SUM && XEXP (*px, 0) == pic_offset_table_rtx;
6742 }
6743
6744 int
6745 alpha_find_lo_sum_using_gp (rtx insn)
6746 {
6747 return for_each_rtx (&PATTERN (insn), find_lo_sum_using_gp, NULL) > 0;
6748 }
6749
6750 static int
6751 alpha_does_function_need_gp (void)
6752 {
6753 rtx insn;
6754
6755 /* The GP being variable is an OSF abi thing. */
6756 if (! TARGET_ABI_OSF)
6757 return 0;
6758
6759 if (TARGET_PROFILING_NEEDS_GP && current_function_profile)
6760 return 1;
6761
6762 if (current_function_is_thunk)
6763 return 1;
6764
6765 /* If we need a GP (we have a LDSYM insn or a CALL_INSN), load it first.
6766 Even if we are a static function, we still need to do this in case
6767 our address is taken and passed to something like qsort. */
6768
6769 push_topmost_sequence ();
6770 insn = get_insns ();
6771 pop_topmost_sequence ();
6772
6773 for (; insn; insn = NEXT_INSN (insn))
6774 if (INSN_P (insn)
6775 && GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn)) != USE
6776 && GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn)) != CLOBBER
6777 && get_attr_usegp (insn))
6778 return 1;
6779
6780 return 0;
6781 }
6782
6783 /* Write a version stamp. Don't write anything if we are running as a
6784 cross-compiler. Otherwise, use the versions in /usr/include/stamp.h. */
6785
6786 #ifdef HAVE_STAMP_H
6787 #include <stamp.h>
6788 #endif
6789
6790 void
6791 alpha_write_verstamp (FILE *file ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
6792 {
6793 #ifdef MS_STAMP
6794 fprintf (file, "\t.verstamp %d %d\n", MS_STAMP, LS_STAMP);
6795 #endif
6796 }
6797 \f
6798 /* Helper function to set RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P on instructions, including
6799 sequences. */
6800
6801 static rtx
6802 set_frame_related_p (void)
6803 {
6804 rtx seq = get_insns ();
6805 rtx insn;
6806
6807 end_sequence ();
6808
6809 if (!seq)
6810 return NULL_RTX;
6811
6812 if (INSN_P (seq))
6813 {
6814 insn = seq;
6815 while (insn != NULL_RTX)
6816 {
6817 RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P (insn) = 1;
6818 insn = NEXT_INSN (insn);
6819 }
6820 seq = emit_insn (seq);
6821 }
6822 else
6823 {
6824 seq = emit_insn (seq);
6825 RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P (seq) = 1;
6826 }
6827 return seq;
6828 }
6829
6830 #define FRP(exp) (start_sequence (), exp, set_frame_related_p ())
6831
6832 /* Write function prologue. */
6833
6834 /* On vms we have two kinds of functions:
6835
6836 - stack frame (PROC_STACK)
6837 these are 'normal' functions with local vars and which are
6838 calling other functions
6839 - register frame (PROC_REGISTER)
6840 keeps all data in registers, needs no stack
6841
6842 We must pass this to the assembler so it can generate the
6843 proper pdsc (procedure descriptor)
6844 This is done with the '.pdesc' command.
6845
6846 On not-vms, we don't really differentiate between the two, as we can
6847 simply allocate stack without saving registers. */
6848
6849 void
6850 alpha_expand_prologue (void)
6851 {
6852 /* Registers to save. */
6853 unsigned long imask = 0;
6854 unsigned long fmask = 0;
6855 /* Stack space needed for pushing registers clobbered by us. */
6856 HOST_WIDE_INT sa_size;
6857 /* Complete stack size needed. */
6858 HOST_WIDE_INT frame_size;
6859 /* Offset from base reg to register save area. */
6860 HOST_WIDE_INT reg_offset;
6861 rtx sa_reg, mem;
6862 int i;
6863
6864 sa_size = alpha_sa_size ();
6865
6866 frame_size = get_frame_size ();
6867 if (TARGET_ABI_OPEN_VMS)
6868 frame_size = ALPHA_ROUND (sa_size
6869 + (alpha_procedure_type == PT_STACK ? 8 : 0)
6870 + frame_size
6871 + current_function_pretend_args_size);
6872 else if (TARGET_ABI_UNICOSMK)
6873 /* We have to allocate space for the DSIB if we generate a frame. */
6874 frame_size = ALPHA_ROUND (sa_size
6875 + (alpha_procedure_type == PT_STACK ? 48 : 0))
6876 + ALPHA_ROUND (frame_size
6877 + current_function_outgoing_args_size);
6878 else
6879 frame_size = (ALPHA_ROUND (current_function_outgoing_args_size)
6880 + sa_size
6881 + ALPHA_ROUND (frame_size
6882 + current_function_pretend_args_size));
6883
6884 if (TARGET_ABI_OPEN_VMS)
6885 reg_offset = 8;
6886 else
6887 reg_offset = ALPHA_ROUND (current_function_outgoing_args_size);
6888
6889 alpha_sa_mask (&imask, &fmask);
6890
6891 /* Emit an insn to reload GP, if needed. */
6892 if (TARGET_ABI_OSF)
6893 {
6894 alpha_function_needs_gp = alpha_does_function_need_gp ();
6895 if (alpha_function_needs_gp)
6896 emit_insn (gen_prologue_ldgp ());
6897 }
6898
6899 /* TARGET_PROFILING_NEEDS_GP actually implies that we need to insert
6900 the call to mcount ourselves, rather than having the linker do it
6901 magically in response to -pg. Since _mcount has special linkage,
6902 don't represent the call as a call. */
6903 if (TARGET_PROFILING_NEEDS_GP && current_function_profile)
6904 emit_insn (gen_prologue_mcount ());
6905
6906 if (TARGET_ABI_UNICOSMK)
6907 unicosmk_gen_dsib (&imask);
6908
6909 /* Adjust the stack by the frame size. If the frame size is > 4096
6910 bytes, we need to be sure we probe somewhere in the first and last
6911 4096 bytes (we can probably get away without the latter test) and
6912 every 8192 bytes in between. If the frame size is > 32768, we
6913 do this in a loop. Otherwise, we generate the explicit probe
6914 instructions.
6915
6916 Note that we are only allowed to adjust sp once in the prologue. */
6917
6918 if (frame_size <= 32768)
6919 {
6920 if (frame_size > 4096)
6921 {
6922 int probed = 4096;
6923
6924 do
6925 emit_insn (gen_probe_stack (GEN_INT (TARGET_ABI_UNICOSMK
6926 ? -probed + 64
6927 : -probed)));
6928 while ((probed += 8192) < frame_size);
6929
6930 /* We only have to do this probe if we aren't saving registers. */
6931 if (sa_size == 0 && probed + 4096 < frame_size)
6932 emit_insn (gen_probe_stack (GEN_INT (-frame_size)));
6933 }
6934
6935 if (frame_size != 0)
6936 FRP (emit_insn (gen_adddi3 (stack_pointer_rtx, stack_pointer_rtx,
6937 GEN_INT (TARGET_ABI_UNICOSMK
6938 ? -frame_size + 64
6939 : -frame_size))));
6940 }
6941 else
6942 {
6943 /* Here we generate code to set R22 to SP + 4096 and set R23 to the
6944 number of 8192 byte blocks to probe. We then probe each block
6945 in the loop and then set SP to the proper location. If the
6946 amount remaining is > 4096, we have to do one more probe if we
6947 are not saving any registers. */
6948
6949 HOST_WIDE_INT blocks = (frame_size + 4096) / 8192;
6950 HOST_WIDE_INT leftover = frame_size + 4096 - blocks * 8192;
6951 rtx ptr = gen_rtx_REG (DImode, 22);
6952 rtx count = gen_rtx_REG (DImode, 23);
6953 rtx seq;
6954
6955 emit_move_insn (count, GEN_INT (blocks));
6956 emit_insn (gen_adddi3 (ptr, stack_pointer_rtx,
6957 GEN_INT (TARGET_ABI_UNICOSMK ? 4096 - 64 : 4096)));
6958
6959 /* Because of the difficulty in emitting a new basic block this
6960 late in the compilation, generate the loop as a single insn. */
6961 emit_insn (gen_prologue_stack_probe_loop (count, ptr));
6962
6963 if (leftover > 4096 && sa_size == 0)
6964 {
6965 rtx last = gen_rtx_MEM (DImode, plus_constant (ptr, -leftover));
6966 MEM_VOLATILE_P (last) = 1;
6967 emit_move_insn (last, const0_rtx);
6968 }
6969
6970 if (TARGET_ABI_WINDOWS_NT)
6971 {
6972 /* For NT stack unwind (done by 'reverse execution'), it's
6973 not OK to take the result of a loop, even though the value
6974 is already in ptr, so we reload it via a single operation
6975 and subtract it to sp.
6976
6977 Yes, that's correct -- we have to reload the whole constant
6978 into a temporary via ldah+lda then subtract from sp. To
6979 ensure we get ldah+lda, we use a special pattern. */
6980
6981 HOST_WIDE_INT lo, hi;
6982 lo = ((frame_size & 0xffff) ^ 0x8000) - 0x8000;
6983 hi = frame_size - lo;
6984
6985 emit_move_insn (ptr, GEN_INT (hi));
6986 emit_insn (gen_nt_lda (ptr, GEN_INT (lo)));
6987 seq = emit_insn (gen_subdi3 (stack_pointer_rtx, stack_pointer_rtx,
6988 ptr));
6989 }
6990 else
6991 {
6992 seq = emit_insn (gen_adddi3 (stack_pointer_rtx, ptr,
6993 GEN_INT (-leftover)));
6994 }
6995
6996 /* This alternative is special, because the DWARF code cannot
6997 possibly intuit through the loop above. So we invent this
6998 note it looks at instead. */
6999 RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P (seq) = 1;
7000 REG_NOTES (seq)
7001 = gen_rtx_EXPR_LIST (REG_FRAME_RELATED_EXPR,
7002 gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, stack_pointer_rtx,
7003 gen_rtx_PLUS (Pmode, stack_pointer_rtx,
7004 GEN_INT (TARGET_ABI_UNICOSMK
7005 ? -frame_size + 64
7006 : -frame_size))),
7007 REG_NOTES (seq));
7008 }
7009
7010 if (!TARGET_ABI_UNICOSMK)
7011 {
7012 /* Cope with very large offsets to the register save area. */
7013 sa_reg = stack_pointer_rtx;
7014 if (reg_offset + sa_size > 0x8000)
7015 {
7016 int low = ((reg_offset & 0xffff) ^ 0x8000) - 0x8000;
7017 HOST_WIDE_INT bias;
7018
7019 if (low + sa_size <= 0x8000)
7020 bias = reg_offset - low, reg_offset = low;
7021 else
7022 bias = reg_offset, reg_offset = 0;
7023
7024 sa_reg = gen_rtx_REG (DImode, 24);
7025 FRP (emit_insn (gen_adddi3 (sa_reg, stack_pointer_rtx,
7026 GEN_INT (bias))));
7027 }
7028
7029 /* Save regs in stack order. Beginning with VMS PV. */
7030 if (TARGET_ABI_OPEN_VMS && alpha_procedure_type == PT_STACK)
7031 {
7032 mem = gen_rtx_MEM (DImode, stack_pointer_rtx);
7033 set_mem_alias_set (mem, alpha_sr_alias_set);
7034 FRP (emit_move_insn (mem, gen_rtx_REG (DImode, REG_PV)));
7035 }
7036
7037 /* Save register RA next. */
7038 if (imask & (1UL << REG_RA))
7039 {
7040 mem = gen_rtx_MEM (DImode, plus_constant (sa_reg, reg_offset));
7041 set_mem_alias_set (mem, alpha_sr_alias_set);
7042 FRP (emit_move_insn (mem, gen_rtx_REG (DImode, REG_RA)));
7043 imask &= ~(1UL << REG_RA);
7044 reg_offset += 8;
7045 }
7046
7047 /* Now save any other registers required to be saved. */
7048 for (i = 0; i < 32; i++)
7049 if (imask & (1UL << i))
7050 {
7051 mem = gen_rtx_MEM (DImode, plus_constant (sa_reg, reg_offset));
7052 set_mem_alias_set (mem, alpha_sr_alias_set);
7053 FRP (emit_move_insn (mem, gen_rtx_REG (DImode, i)));
7054 reg_offset += 8;
7055 }
7056
7057 for (i = 0; i < 32; i++)
7058 if (fmask & (1UL << i))
7059 {
7060 mem = gen_rtx_MEM (DFmode, plus_constant (sa_reg, reg_offset));
7061 set_mem_alias_set (mem, alpha_sr_alias_set);
7062 FRP (emit_move_insn (mem, gen_rtx_REG (DFmode, i+32)));
7063 reg_offset += 8;
7064 }
7065 }
7066 else if (TARGET_ABI_UNICOSMK && alpha_procedure_type == PT_STACK)
7067 {
7068 /* The standard frame on the T3E includes space for saving registers.
7069 We just have to use it. We don't have to save the return address and
7070 the old frame pointer here - they are saved in the DSIB. */
7071
7072 reg_offset = -56;
7073 for (i = 9; i < 15; i++)
7074 if (imask & (1UL << i))
7075 {
7076 mem = gen_rtx_MEM (DImode, plus_constant(hard_frame_pointer_rtx,
7077 reg_offset));
7078 set_mem_alias_set (mem, alpha_sr_alias_set);
7079 FRP (emit_move_insn (mem, gen_rtx_REG (DImode, i)));
7080 reg_offset -= 8;
7081 }
7082 for (i = 2; i < 10; i++)
7083 if (fmask & (1UL << i))
7084 {
7085 mem = gen_rtx_MEM (DFmode, plus_constant (hard_frame_pointer_rtx,
7086 reg_offset));
7087 set_mem_alias_set (mem, alpha_sr_alias_set);
7088 FRP (emit_move_insn (mem, gen_rtx_REG (DFmode, i+32)));
7089 reg_offset -= 8;
7090 }
7091 }
7092
7093 if (TARGET_ABI_OPEN_VMS)
7094 {
7095 if (alpha_procedure_type == PT_REGISTER)
7096 /* Register frame procedures save the fp.
7097 ?? Ought to have a dwarf2 save for this. */
7098 emit_move_insn (gen_rtx_REG (DImode, vms_save_fp_regno),
7099 hard_frame_pointer_rtx);
7100
7101 if (alpha_procedure_type != PT_NULL && vms_base_regno != REG_PV)
7102 emit_insn (gen_force_movdi (gen_rtx_REG (DImode, vms_base_regno),
7103 gen_rtx_REG (DImode, REG_PV)));
7104
7105 if (alpha_procedure_type != PT_NULL
7106 && vms_unwind_regno == HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM)
7107 FRP (emit_move_insn (hard_frame_pointer_rtx, stack_pointer_rtx));
7108
7109 /* If we have to allocate space for outgoing args, do it now. */
7110 if (current_function_outgoing_args_size != 0)
7111 {
7112 rtx seq
7113 = emit_move_insn (stack_pointer_rtx,
7114 plus_constant
7115 (hard_frame_pointer_rtx,
7116 - (ALPHA_ROUND
7117 (current_function_outgoing_args_size))));
7118
7119 /* Only set FRAME_RELATED_P on the stack adjustment we just emitted
7120 if ! frame_pointer_needed. Setting the bit will change the CFA
7121 computation rule to use sp again, which would be wrong if we had
7122 frame_pointer_needed, as this means sp might move unpredictably
7123 later on.
7124
7125 Also, note that
7126 frame_pointer_needed
7127 => vms_unwind_regno == HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
7128 and
7129 current_function_outgoing_args_size != 0
7130 => alpha_procedure_type != PT_NULL,
7131
7132 so when we are not setting the bit here, we are guaranteed to
7133 have emited an FRP frame pointer update just before. */
7134 RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P (seq) = ! frame_pointer_needed;
7135 }
7136 }
7137 else if (!TARGET_ABI_UNICOSMK)
7138 {
7139 /* If we need a frame pointer, set it from the stack pointer. */
7140 if (frame_pointer_needed)
7141 {
7142 if (TARGET_CAN_FAULT_IN_PROLOGUE)
7143 FRP (emit_move_insn (hard_frame_pointer_rtx, stack_pointer_rtx));
7144 else
7145 /* This must always be the last instruction in the
7146 prologue, thus we emit a special move + clobber. */
7147 FRP (emit_insn (gen_init_fp (hard_frame_pointer_rtx,
7148 stack_pointer_rtx, sa_reg)));
7149 }
7150 }
7151
7152 /* The ABIs for VMS and OSF/1 say that while we can schedule insns into
7153 the prologue, for exception handling reasons, we cannot do this for
7154 any insn that might fault. We could prevent this for mems with a
7155 (clobber:BLK (scratch)), but this doesn't work for fp insns. So we
7156 have to prevent all such scheduling with a blockage.
7157
7158 Linux, on the other hand, never bothered to implement OSF/1's
7159 exception handling, and so doesn't care about such things. Anyone
7160 planning to use dwarf2 frame-unwind info can also omit the blockage. */
7161
7162 if (! TARGET_CAN_FAULT_IN_PROLOGUE)
7163 emit_insn (gen_blockage ());
7164 }
7165
7166 /* Output the textual info surrounding the prologue. */
7167
7168 void
7169 alpha_start_function (FILE *file, const char *fnname,
7170 tree decl ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
7171 {
7172 unsigned long imask = 0;
7173 unsigned long fmask = 0;
7174 /* Stack space needed for pushing registers clobbered by us. */
7175 HOST_WIDE_INT sa_size;
7176 /* Complete stack size needed. */
7177 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT frame_size;
7178 /* Offset from base reg to register save area. */
7179 HOST_WIDE_INT reg_offset;
7180 char *entry_label = (char *) alloca (strlen (fnname) + 6);
7181 int i;
7182
7183 /* Don't emit an extern directive for functions defined in the same file. */
7184 if (TARGET_ABI_UNICOSMK)
7185 {
7186 tree name_tree;
7187 name_tree = get_identifier (fnname);
7188 TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (name_tree) = 1;
7189 }
7190
7191 alpha_fnname = fnname;
7192 sa_size = alpha_sa_size ();
7193
7194 frame_size = get_frame_size ();
7195 if (TARGET_ABI_OPEN_VMS)
7196 frame_size = ALPHA_ROUND (sa_size
7197 + (alpha_procedure_type == PT_STACK ? 8 : 0)
7198 + frame_size
7199 + current_function_pretend_args_size);
7200 else if (TARGET_ABI_UNICOSMK)
7201 frame_size = ALPHA_ROUND (sa_size
7202 + (alpha_procedure_type == PT_STACK ? 48 : 0))
7203 + ALPHA_ROUND (frame_size
7204 + current_function_outgoing_args_size);
7205 else
7206 frame_size = (ALPHA_ROUND (current_function_outgoing_args_size)
7207 + sa_size
7208 + ALPHA_ROUND (frame_size
7209 + current_function_pretend_args_size));
7210
7211 if (TARGET_ABI_OPEN_VMS)
7212 reg_offset = 8;
7213 else
7214 reg_offset = ALPHA_ROUND (current_function_outgoing_args_size);
7215
7216 alpha_sa_mask (&imask, &fmask);
7217
7218 /* Ecoff can handle multiple .file directives, so put out file and lineno.
7219 We have to do that before the .ent directive as we cannot switch
7220 files within procedures with native ecoff because line numbers are
7221 linked to procedure descriptors.
7222 Outputting the lineno helps debugging of one line functions as they
7223 would otherwise get no line number at all. Please note that we would
7224 like to put out last_linenum from final.c, but it is not accessible. */
7225
7226 if (write_symbols == SDB_DEBUG)
7227 {
7228 #ifdef ASM_OUTPUT_SOURCE_FILENAME
7229 ASM_OUTPUT_SOURCE_FILENAME (file,
7230 DECL_SOURCE_FILE (current_function_decl));
7231 #endif
7232 #ifdef ASM_OUTPUT_SOURCE_LINE
7233 if (debug_info_level != DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
7234 ASM_OUTPUT_SOURCE_LINE (file,
7235 DECL_SOURCE_LINE (current_function_decl), 0);
7236 #endif
7237 }
7238
7239 /* Issue function start and label. */
7240 if (TARGET_ABI_OPEN_VMS
7241 || (!TARGET_ABI_UNICOSMK && !flag_inhibit_size_directive))
7242 {
7243 fputs ("\t.ent ", file);
7244 assemble_name (file, fnname);
7245 putc ('\n', file);
7246
7247 /* If the function needs GP, we'll write the "..ng" label there.
7248 Otherwise, do it here. */
7249 if (TARGET_ABI_OSF
7250 && ! alpha_function_needs_gp
7251 && ! current_function_is_thunk)
7252 {
7253 putc ('$', file);
7254 assemble_name (file, fnname);
7255 fputs ("..ng:\n", file);
7256 }
7257 }
7258
7259 strcpy (entry_label, fnname);
7260 if (TARGET_ABI_OPEN_VMS)
7261 strcat (entry_label, "..en");
7262
7263 /* For public functions, the label must be globalized by appending an
7264 additional colon. */
7265 if (TARGET_ABI_UNICOSMK && TREE_PUBLIC (decl))
7266 strcat (entry_label, ":");
7267
7268 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (file, entry_label);
7269 inside_function = TRUE;
7270
7271 if (TARGET_ABI_OPEN_VMS)
7272 fprintf (file, "\t.base $%d\n", vms_base_regno);
7273
7274 if (!TARGET_ABI_OPEN_VMS && !TARGET_ABI_UNICOSMK && TARGET_IEEE_CONFORMANT
7275 && !flag_inhibit_size_directive)
7276 {
7277 /* Set flags in procedure descriptor to request IEEE-conformant
7278 math-library routines. The value we set it to is PDSC_EXC_IEEE
7279 (/usr/include/pdsc.h). */
7280 fputs ("\t.eflag 48\n", file);
7281 }
7282
7283 /* Set up offsets to alpha virtual arg/local debugging pointer. */
7284 alpha_auto_offset = -frame_size + current_function_pretend_args_size;
7285 alpha_arg_offset = -frame_size + 48;
7286
7287 /* Describe our frame. If the frame size is larger than an integer,
7288 print it as zero to avoid an assembler error. We won't be
7289 properly describing such a frame, but that's the best we can do. */
7290 if (TARGET_ABI_UNICOSMK)
7291 ;
7292 else if (TARGET_ABI_OPEN_VMS)
7293 fprintf (file, "\t.frame $%d," HOST_WIDE_INT_PRINT_DEC ",$26,"
7294 HOST_WIDE_INT_PRINT_DEC "\n",
7295 vms_unwind_regno,
7296 frame_size >= (1UL << 31) ? 0 : frame_size,
7297 reg_offset);
7298 else if (!flag_inhibit_size_directive)
7299 fprintf (file, "\t.frame $%d," HOST_WIDE_INT_PRINT_DEC ",$26,%d\n",
7300 (frame_pointer_needed
7301 ? HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM : STACK_POINTER_REGNUM),
7302 frame_size >= (1UL << 31) ? 0 : frame_size,
7303 current_function_pretend_args_size);
7304
7305 /* Describe which registers were spilled. */
7306 if (TARGET_ABI_UNICOSMK)
7307 ;
7308 else if (TARGET_ABI_OPEN_VMS)
7309 {
7310 if (imask)
7311 /* ??? Does VMS care if mask contains ra? The old code didn't
7312 set it, so I don't here. */
7313 fprintf (file, "\t.mask 0x%lx,0\n", imask & ~(1UL << REG_RA));
7314 if (fmask)
7315 fprintf (file, "\t.fmask 0x%lx,0\n", fmask);
7316 if (alpha_procedure_type == PT_REGISTER)
7317 fprintf (file, "\t.fp_save $%d\n", vms_save_fp_regno);
7318 }
7319 else if (!flag_inhibit_size_directive)
7320 {
7321 if (imask)
7322 {
7323 fprintf (file, "\t.mask 0x%lx," HOST_WIDE_INT_PRINT_DEC "\n", imask,
7324 frame_size >= (1UL << 31) ? 0 : reg_offset - frame_size);
7325
7326 for (i = 0; i < 32; ++i)
7327 if (imask & (1UL << i))
7328 reg_offset += 8;
7329 }
7330
7331 if (fmask)
7332 fprintf (file, "\t.fmask 0x%lx," HOST_WIDE_INT_PRINT_DEC "\n", fmask,
7333 frame_size >= (1UL << 31) ? 0 : reg_offset - frame_size);
7334 }
7335
7336 #if TARGET_ABI_OPEN_VMS
7337 /* Ifdef'ed cause link_section are only available then. */
7338 readonly_data_section ();
7339 fprintf (file, "\t.align 3\n");
7340 assemble_name (file, fnname); fputs ("..na:\n", file);
7341 fputs ("\t.ascii \"", file);
7342 assemble_name (file, fnname);
7343 fputs ("\\0\"\n", file);
7344 alpha_need_linkage (fnname, 1);
7345 text_section ();
7346 #endif
7347 }
7348
7349 /* Emit the .prologue note at the scheduled end of the prologue. */
7350
7351 static void
7352 alpha_output_function_end_prologue (FILE *file)
7353 {
7354 if (TARGET_ABI_UNICOSMK)
7355 ;
7356 else if (TARGET_ABI_OPEN_VMS)
7357 fputs ("\t.prologue\n", file);
7358 else if (TARGET_ABI_WINDOWS_NT)
7359 fputs ("\t.prologue 0\n", file);
7360 else if (!flag_inhibit_size_directive)
7361 fprintf (file, "\t.prologue %d\n",
7362 alpha_function_needs_gp || current_function_is_thunk);
7363 }
7364
7365 /* Write function epilogue. */
7366
7367 /* ??? At some point we will want to support full unwind, and so will
7368 need to mark the epilogue as well. At the moment, we just confuse
7369 dwarf2out. */
7370 #undef FRP
7371 #define FRP(exp) exp
7372
7373 void
7374 alpha_expand_epilogue (void)
7375 {
7376 /* Registers to save. */
7377 unsigned long imask = 0;
7378 unsigned long fmask = 0;
7379 /* Stack space needed for pushing registers clobbered by us. */
7380 HOST_WIDE_INT sa_size;
7381 /* Complete stack size needed. */
7382 HOST_WIDE_INT frame_size;
7383 /* Offset from base reg to register save area. */
7384 HOST_WIDE_INT reg_offset;
7385 int fp_is_frame_pointer, fp_offset;
7386 rtx sa_reg, sa_reg_exp = NULL;
7387 rtx sp_adj1, sp_adj2, mem;
7388 rtx eh_ofs;
7389 int i;
7390
7391 sa_size = alpha_sa_size ();
7392
7393 frame_size = get_frame_size ();
7394 if (TARGET_ABI_OPEN_VMS)
7395 frame_size = ALPHA_ROUND (sa_size
7396 + (alpha_procedure_type == PT_STACK ? 8 : 0)
7397 + frame_size
7398 + current_function_pretend_args_size);
7399 else if (TARGET_ABI_UNICOSMK)
7400 frame_size = ALPHA_ROUND (sa_size
7401 + (alpha_procedure_type == PT_STACK ? 48 : 0))
7402 + ALPHA_ROUND (frame_size
7403 + current_function_outgoing_args_size);
7404 else
7405 frame_size = (ALPHA_ROUND (current_function_outgoing_args_size)
7406 + sa_size
7407 + ALPHA_ROUND (frame_size
7408 + current_function_pretend_args_size));
7409
7410 if (TARGET_ABI_OPEN_VMS)
7411 {
7412 if (alpha_procedure_type == PT_STACK)
7413 reg_offset = 8;
7414 else
7415 reg_offset = 0;
7416 }
7417 else
7418 reg_offset = ALPHA_ROUND (current_function_outgoing_args_size);
7419
7420 alpha_sa_mask (&imask, &fmask);
7421
7422 fp_is_frame_pointer
7423 = ((TARGET_ABI_OPEN_VMS && alpha_procedure_type == PT_STACK)
7424 || (!TARGET_ABI_OPEN_VMS && frame_pointer_needed));
7425 fp_offset = 0;
7426 sa_reg = stack_pointer_rtx;
7427
7428 if (current_function_calls_eh_return)
7429 eh_ofs = EH_RETURN_STACKADJ_RTX;
7430 else
7431 eh_ofs = NULL_RTX;
7432
7433 if (!TARGET_ABI_UNICOSMK && sa_size)
7434 {
7435 /* If we have a frame pointer, restore SP from it. */
7436 if ((TARGET_ABI_OPEN_VMS
7437 && vms_unwind_regno == HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM)
7438 || (!TARGET_ABI_OPEN_VMS && frame_pointer_needed))
7439 FRP (emit_move_insn (stack_pointer_rtx, hard_frame_pointer_rtx));
7440
7441 /* Cope with very large offsets to the register save area. */
7442 if (reg_offset + sa_size > 0x8000)
7443 {
7444 int low = ((reg_offset & 0xffff) ^ 0x8000) - 0x8000;
7445 HOST_WIDE_INT bias;
7446
7447 if (low + sa_size <= 0x8000)
7448 bias = reg_offset - low, reg_offset = low;
7449 else
7450 bias = reg_offset, reg_offset = 0;
7451
7452 sa_reg = gen_rtx_REG (DImode, 22);
7453 sa_reg_exp = plus_constant (stack_pointer_rtx, bias);
7454
7455 FRP (emit_move_insn (sa_reg, sa_reg_exp));
7456 }
7457
7458 /* Restore registers in order, excepting a true frame pointer. */
7459
7460 mem = gen_rtx_MEM (DImode, plus_constant (sa_reg, reg_offset));
7461 if (! eh_ofs)
7462 set_mem_alias_set (mem, alpha_sr_alias_set);
7463 FRP (emit_move_insn (gen_rtx_REG (DImode, REG_RA), mem));
7464
7465 reg_offset += 8;
7466 imask &= ~(1UL << REG_RA);
7467
7468 for (i = 0; i < 32; ++i)
7469 if (imask & (1UL << i))
7470 {
7471 if (i == HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM && fp_is_frame_pointer)
7472 fp_offset = reg_offset;
7473 else
7474 {
7475 mem = gen_rtx_MEM (DImode, plus_constant(sa_reg, reg_offset));
7476 set_mem_alias_set (mem, alpha_sr_alias_set);
7477 FRP (emit_move_insn (gen_rtx_REG (DImode, i), mem));
7478 }
7479 reg_offset += 8;
7480 }
7481
7482 for (i = 0; i < 32; ++i)
7483 if (fmask & (1UL << i))
7484 {
7485 mem = gen_rtx_MEM (DFmode, plus_constant(sa_reg, reg_offset));
7486 set_mem_alias_set (mem, alpha_sr_alias_set);
7487 FRP (emit_move_insn (gen_rtx_REG (DFmode, i+32), mem));
7488 reg_offset += 8;
7489 }
7490 }
7491 else if (TARGET_ABI_UNICOSMK && alpha_procedure_type == PT_STACK)
7492 {
7493 /* Restore callee-saved general-purpose registers. */
7494
7495 reg_offset = -56;
7496
7497 for (i = 9; i < 15; i++)
7498 if (imask & (1UL << i))
7499 {
7500 mem = gen_rtx_MEM (DImode, plus_constant(hard_frame_pointer_rtx,
7501 reg_offset));
7502 set_mem_alias_set (mem, alpha_sr_alias_set);
7503 FRP (emit_move_insn (gen_rtx_REG (DImode, i), mem));
7504 reg_offset -= 8;
7505 }
7506
7507 for (i = 2; i < 10; i++)
7508 if (fmask & (1UL << i))
7509 {
7510 mem = gen_rtx_MEM (DFmode, plus_constant(hard_frame_pointer_rtx,
7511 reg_offset));
7512 set_mem_alias_set (mem, alpha_sr_alias_set);
7513 FRP (emit_move_insn (gen_rtx_REG (DFmode, i+32), mem));
7514 reg_offset -= 8;
7515 }
7516
7517 /* Restore the return address from the DSIB. */
7518
7519 mem = gen_rtx_MEM (DImode, plus_constant(hard_frame_pointer_rtx, -8));
7520 set_mem_alias_set (mem, alpha_sr_alias_set);
7521 FRP (emit_move_insn (gen_rtx_REG (DImode, REG_RA), mem));
7522 }
7523
7524 if (frame_size || eh_ofs)
7525 {
7526 sp_adj1 = stack_pointer_rtx;
7527
7528 if (eh_ofs)
7529 {
7530 sp_adj1 = gen_rtx_REG (DImode, 23);
7531 emit_move_insn (sp_adj1,
7532 gen_rtx_PLUS (Pmode, stack_pointer_rtx, eh_ofs));
7533 }
7534
7535 /* If the stack size is large, begin computation into a temporary
7536 register so as not to interfere with a potential fp restore,
7537 which must be consecutive with an SP restore. */
7538 if (frame_size < 32768
7539 && ! (TARGET_ABI_UNICOSMK && current_function_calls_alloca))
7540 sp_adj2 = GEN_INT (frame_size);
7541 else if (TARGET_ABI_UNICOSMK)
7542 {
7543 sp_adj1 = gen_rtx_REG (DImode, 23);
7544 FRP (emit_move_insn (sp_adj1, hard_frame_pointer_rtx));
7545 sp_adj2 = const0_rtx;
7546 }
7547 else if (frame_size < 0x40007fffL)
7548 {
7549 int low = ((frame_size & 0xffff) ^ 0x8000) - 0x8000;
7550
7551 sp_adj2 = plus_constant (sp_adj1, frame_size - low);
7552 if (sa_reg_exp && rtx_equal_p (sa_reg_exp, sp_adj2))
7553 sp_adj1 = sa_reg;
7554 else
7555 {
7556 sp_adj1 = gen_rtx_REG (DImode, 23);
7557 FRP (emit_move_insn (sp_adj1, sp_adj2));
7558 }
7559 sp_adj2 = GEN_INT (low);
7560 }
7561 else
7562 {
7563 rtx tmp = gen_rtx_REG (DImode, 23);
7564 FRP (sp_adj2 = alpha_emit_set_const (tmp, DImode, frame_size, 3));
7565 if (!sp_adj2)
7566 {
7567 /* We can't drop new things to memory this late, afaik,
7568 so build it up by pieces. */
7569 FRP (sp_adj2 = alpha_emit_set_long_const (tmp, frame_size,
7570 -(frame_size < 0)));
7571 if (!sp_adj2)
7572 abort ();
7573 }
7574 }
7575
7576 /* From now on, things must be in order. So emit blockages. */
7577
7578 /* Restore the frame pointer. */
7579 if (TARGET_ABI_UNICOSMK)
7580 {
7581 emit_insn (gen_blockage ());
7582 mem = gen_rtx_MEM (DImode,
7583 plus_constant (hard_frame_pointer_rtx, -16));
7584 set_mem_alias_set (mem, alpha_sr_alias_set);
7585 FRP (emit_move_insn (hard_frame_pointer_rtx, mem));
7586 }
7587 else if (fp_is_frame_pointer)
7588 {
7589 emit_insn (gen_blockage ());
7590 mem = gen_rtx_MEM (DImode, plus_constant (sa_reg, fp_offset));
7591 set_mem_alias_set (mem, alpha_sr_alias_set);
7592 FRP (emit_move_insn (hard_frame_pointer_rtx, mem));
7593 }
7594 else if (TARGET_ABI_OPEN_VMS)
7595 {
7596 emit_insn (gen_blockage ());
7597 FRP (emit_move_insn (hard_frame_pointer_rtx,
7598 gen_rtx_REG (DImode, vms_save_fp_regno)));
7599 }
7600
7601 /* Restore the stack pointer. */
7602 emit_insn (gen_blockage ());
7603 if (sp_adj2 == const0_rtx)
7604 FRP (emit_move_insn (stack_pointer_rtx, sp_adj1));
7605 else
7606 FRP (emit_move_insn (stack_pointer_rtx,
7607 gen_rtx_PLUS (DImode, sp_adj1, sp_adj2)));
7608 }
7609 else
7610 {
7611 if (TARGET_ABI_OPEN_VMS && alpha_procedure_type == PT_REGISTER)
7612 {
7613 emit_insn (gen_blockage ());
7614 FRP (emit_move_insn (hard_frame_pointer_rtx,
7615 gen_rtx_REG (DImode, vms_save_fp_regno)));
7616 }
7617 else if (TARGET_ABI_UNICOSMK && alpha_procedure_type != PT_STACK)
7618 {
7619 /* Decrement the frame pointer if the function does not have a
7620 frame. */
7621
7622 emit_insn (gen_blockage ());
7623 FRP (emit_insn (gen_adddi3 (hard_frame_pointer_rtx,
7624 hard_frame_pointer_rtx, GEN_INT (-1))));
7625 }
7626 }
7627 }
7628 \f
7629 /* Output the rest of the textual info surrounding the epilogue. */
7630
7631 void
7632 alpha_end_function (FILE *file, const char *fnname, tree decl ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
7633 {
7634 /* End the function. */
7635 if (!TARGET_ABI_UNICOSMK && !flag_inhibit_size_directive)
7636 {
7637 fputs ("\t.end ", file);
7638 assemble_name (file, fnname);
7639 putc ('\n', file);
7640 }
7641 inside_function = FALSE;
7642
7643 #if TARGET_ABI_OPEN_VMS
7644 alpha_write_linkage (file, fnname, decl);
7645 #endif
7646
7647 /* Output jump tables and the static subroutine information block. */
7648 if (TARGET_ABI_UNICOSMK)
7649 {
7650 unicosmk_output_ssib (file, fnname);
7651 unicosmk_output_deferred_case_vectors (file);
7652 }
7653 }
7654
7655 #if TARGET_ABI_OSF
7656 /* Emit a tail call to FUNCTION after adjusting THIS by DELTA.
7657
7658 In order to avoid the hordes of differences between generated code
7659 with and without TARGET_EXPLICIT_RELOCS, and to avoid duplicating
7660 lots of code loading up large constants, generate rtl and emit it
7661 instead of going straight to text.
7662
7663 Not sure why this idea hasn't been explored before... */
7664
7665 static void
7666 alpha_output_mi_thunk_osf (FILE *file, tree thunk_fndecl ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
7667 HOST_WIDE_INT delta, HOST_WIDE_INT vcall_offset,
7668 tree function)
7669 {
7670 HOST_WIDE_INT hi, lo;
7671 rtx this, insn, funexp;
7672
7673 /* We always require a valid GP. */
7674 emit_insn (gen_prologue_ldgp ());
7675 emit_note (NULL, NOTE_INSN_PROLOGUE_END);
7676
7677 /* Find the "this" pointer. If the function returns a structure,
7678 the structure return pointer is in $16. */
7679 if (aggregate_value_p (TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (function))))
7680 this = gen_rtx_REG (Pmode, 17);
7681 else
7682 this = gen_rtx_REG (Pmode, 16);
7683
7684 /* Add DELTA. When possible we use ldah+lda. Otherwise load the
7685 entire constant for the add. */
7686 lo = ((delta & 0xffff) ^ 0x8000) - 0x8000;
7687 hi = (((delta - lo) & 0xffffffff) ^ 0x80000000) - 0x80000000;
7688 if (hi + lo == delta)
7689 {
7690 if (hi)
7691 emit_insn (gen_adddi3 (this, this, GEN_INT (hi)));
7692 if (lo)
7693 emit_insn (gen_adddi3 (this, this, GEN_INT (lo)));
7694 }
7695 else
7696 {
7697 rtx tmp = alpha_emit_set_long_const (gen_rtx_REG (Pmode, 0),
7698 delta, -(delta < 0));
7699 emit_insn (gen_adddi3 (this, this, tmp));
7700 }
7701
7702 /* Add a delta stored in the vtable at VCALL_OFFSET. */
7703 if (vcall_offset)
7704 {
7705 rtx tmp, tmp2;
7706
7707 tmp = gen_rtx_REG (Pmode, 0);
7708 emit_move_insn (tmp, gen_rtx_MEM (Pmode, this));
7709
7710 lo = ((vcall_offset & 0xffff) ^ 0x8000) - 0x8000;
7711 hi = (((vcall_offset - lo) & 0xffffffff) ^ 0x80000000) - 0x80000000;
7712 if (hi + lo == vcall_offset)
7713 {
7714 if (hi)
7715 emit_insn (gen_adddi3 (tmp, tmp, GEN_INT (hi)));
7716 }
7717 else
7718 {
7719 tmp2 = alpha_emit_set_long_const (gen_rtx_REG (Pmode, 1),
7720 vcall_offset, -(vcall_offset < 0));
7721 emit_insn (gen_adddi3 (tmp, tmp, tmp2));
7722 lo = 0;
7723 }
7724 if (lo)
7725 tmp2 = gen_rtx_PLUS (Pmode, tmp, GEN_INT (lo));
7726 else
7727 tmp2 = tmp;
7728 emit_move_insn (tmp, gen_rtx_MEM (Pmode, tmp2));
7729
7730 emit_insn (gen_adddi3 (this, this, tmp));
7731 }
7732
7733 /* Generate a tail call to the target function. */
7734 if (! TREE_USED (function))
7735 {
7736 assemble_external (function);
7737 TREE_USED (function) = 1;
7738 }
7739 funexp = XEXP (DECL_RTL (function), 0);
7740 funexp = gen_rtx_MEM (FUNCTION_MODE, funexp);
7741 insn = emit_call_insn (gen_sibcall (funexp, const0_rtx));
7742 SIBLING_CALL_P (insn) = 1;
7743
7744 /* Run just enough of rest_of_compilation to get the insns emitted.
7745 There's not really enough bulk here to make other passes such as
7746 instruction scheduling worth while. Note that use_thunk calls
7747 assemble_start_function and assemble_end_function. */
7748 insn = get_insns ();
7749 insn_locators_initialize ();
7750 shorten_branches (insn);
7751 final_start_function (insn, file, 1);
7752 final (insn, file, 1, 0);
7753 final_end_function ();
7754 }
7755 #endif /* TARGET_ABI_OSF */
7756 \f
7757 /* Debugging support. */
7758
7759 #include "gstab.h"
7760
7761 /* Count the number of sdb related labels are generated (to find block
7762 start and end boundaries). */
7763
7764 int sdb_label_count = 0;
7765
7766 /* Next label # for each statement. */
7767
7768 static int sym_lineno = 0;
7769
7770 /* Count the number of .file directives, so that .loc is up to date. */
7771
7772 static int num_source_filenames = 0;
7773
7774 /* Name of the file containing the current function. */
7775
7776 static const char *current_function_file = "";
7777
7778 /* Offsets to alpha virtual arg/local debugging pointers. */
7779
7780 long alpha_arg_offset;
7781 long alpha_auto_offset;
7782 \f
7783 /* Emit a new filename to a stream. */
7784
7785 void
7786 alpha_output_filename (FILE *stream, const char *name)
7787 {
7788 static int first_time = TRUE;
7789 char ltext_label_name[100];
7790
7791 if (first_time)
7792 {
7793 first_time = FALSE;
7794 ++num_source_filenames;
7795 current_function_file = name;
7796 fprintf (stream, "\t.file\t%d ", num_source_filenames);
7797 output_quoted_string (stream, name);
7798 fprintf (stream, "\n");
7799 if (!TARGET_GAS && write_symbols == DBX_DEBUG)
7800 fprintf (stream, "\t#@stabs\n");
7801 }
7802
7803 else if (write_symbols == DBX_DEBUG)
7804 {
7805 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (ltext_label_name, "Ltext", 0);
7806 fprintf (stream, "%s", ASM_STABS_OP);
7807 output_quoted_string (stream, name);
7808 fprintf (stream, ",%d,0,0,%s\n", N_SOL, &ltext_label_name[1]);
7809 }
7810
7811 else if (name != current_function_file
7812 && strcmp (name, current_function_file) != 0)
7813 {
7814 if (inside_function && ! TARGET_GAS)
7815 fprintf (stream, "\t#.file\t%d ", num_source_filenames);
7816 else
7817 {
7818 ++num_source_filenames;
7819 current_function_file = name;
7820 fprintf (stream, "\t.file\t%d ", num_source_filenames);
7821 }
7822
7823 output_quoted_string (stream, name);
7824 fprintf (stream, "\n");
7825 }
7826 }
7827
7828 /* Emit a linenumber to a stream. */
7829
7830 void
7831 alpha_output_lineno (FILE *stream, int line)
7832 {
7833 if (write_symbols == DBX_DEBUG)
7834 {
7835 /* mips-tfile doesn't understand .stabd directives. */
7836 ++sym_lineno;
7837 fprintf (stream, "$LM%d:\n%s%d,0,%d,$LM%d\n",
7838 sym_lineno, ASM_STABN_OP, N_SLINE, line, sym_lineno);
7839 }
7840 else
7841 fprintf (stream, "\n\t.loc\t%d %d\n", num_source_filenames, line);
7842 }
7843 \f
7844 /* Structure to show the current status of registers and memory. */
7845
7846 struct shadow_summary
7847 {
7848 struct {
7849 unsigned int i : 31; /* Mask of int regs */
7850 unsigned int fp : 31; /* Mask of fp regs */
7851 unsigned int mem : 1; /* mem == imem | fpmem */
7852 } used, defd;
7853 };
7854
7855 /* Summary the effects of expression X on the machine. Update SUM, a pointer
7856 to the summary structure. SET is nonzero if the insn is setting the
7857 object, otherwise zero. */
7858
7859 static void
7860 summarize_insn (rtx x, struct shadow_summary *sum, int set)
7861 {
7862 const char *format_ptr;
7863 int i, j;
7864
7865 if (x == 0)
7866 return;
7867
7868 switch (GET_CODE (x))
7869 {
7870 /* ??? Note that this case would be incorrect if the Alpha had a
7871 ZERO_EXTRACT in SET_DEST. */
7872 case SET:
7873 summarize_insn (SET_SRC (x), sum, 0);
7874 summarize_insn (SET_DEST (x), sum, 1);
7875 break;
7876
7877 case CLOBBER:
7878 summarize_insn (XEXP (x, 0), sum, 1);
7879 break;
7880
7881 case USE:
7882 summarize_insn (XEXP (x, 0), sum, 0);
7883 break;
7884
7885 case ASM_OPERANDS:
7886 for (i = ASM_OPERANDS_INPUT_LENGTH (x) - 1; i >= 0; i--)
7887 summarize_insn (ASM_OPERANDS_INPUT (x, i), sum, 0);
7888 break;
7889
7890 case PARALLEL:
7891 for (i = XVECLEN (x, 0) - 1; i >= 0; i--)
7892 summarize_insn (XVECEXP (x, 0, i), sum, 0);
7893 break;
7894
7895 case SUBREG:
7896 summarize_insn (SUBREG_REG (x), sum, 0);
7897 break;
7898
7899 case REG:
7900 {
7901 int regno = REGNO (x);
7902 unsigned long mask = ((unsigned long) 1) << (regno % 32);
7903
7904 if (regno == 31 || regno == 63)
7905 break;
7906
7907 if (set)
7908 {
7909 if (regno < 32)
7910 sum->defd.i |= mask;
7911 else
7912 sum->defd.fp |= mask;
7913 }
7914 else
7915 {
7916 if (regno < 32)
7917 sum->used.i |= mask;
7918 else
7919 sum->used.fp |= mask;
7920 }
7921 }
7922 break;
7923
7924 case MEM:
7925 if (set)
7926 sum->defd.mem = 1;
7927 else
7928 sum->used.mem = 1;
7929
7930 /* Find the regs used in memory address computation: */
7931 summarize_insn (XEXP (x, 0), sum, 0);
7932 break;
7933
7934 case CONST_INT: case CONST_DOUBLE:
7935 case SYMBOL_REF: case LABEL_REF: case CONST:
7936 case SCRATCH: case ASM_INPUT:
7937 break;
7938
7939 /* Handle common unary and binary ops for efficiency. */
7940 case COMPARE: case PLUS: case MINUS: case MULT: case DIV:
7941 case MOD: case UDIV: case UMOD: case AND: case IOR:
7942 case XOR: case ASHIFT: case ROTATE: case ASHIFTRT: case LSHIFTRT:
7943 case ROTATERT: case SMIN: case SMAX: case UMIN: case UMAX:
7944 case NE: case EQ: case GE: case GT: case LE:
7945 case LT: case GEU: case GTU: case LEU: case LTU:
7946 summarize_insn (XEXP (x, 0), sum, 0);
7947 summarize_insn (XEXP (x, 1), sum, 0);
7948 break;
7949
7950 case NEG: case NOT: case SIGN_EXTEND: case ZERO_EXTEND:
7951 case TRUNCATE: case FLOAT_EXTEND: case FLOAT_TRUNCATE: case FLOAT:
7952 case FIX: case UNSIGNED_FLOAT: case UNSIGNED_FIX: case ABS:
7953 case SQRT: case FFS:
7954 summarize_insn (XEXP (x, 0), sum, 0);
7955 break;
7956
7957 default:
7958 format_ptr = GET_RTX_FORMAT (GET_CODE (x));
7959 for (i = GET_RTX_LENGTH (GET_CODE (x)) - 1; i >= 0; i--)
7960 switch (format_ptr[i])
7961 {
7962 case 'e':
7963 summarize_insn (XEXP (x, i), sum, 0);
7964 break;
7965
7966 case 'E':
7967 for (j = XVECLEN (x, i) - 1; j >= 0; j--)
7968 summarize_insn (XVECEXP (x, i, j), sum, 0);
7969 break;
7970
7971 case 'i':
7972 break;
7973
7974 default:
7975 abort ();
7976 }
7977 }
7978 }
7979
7980 /* Ensure a sufficient number of `trapb' insns are in the code when
7981 the user requests code with a trap precision of functions or
7982 instructions.
7983
7984 In naive mode, when the user requests a trap-precision of
7985 "instruction", a trapb is needed after every instruction that may
7986 generate a trap. This ensures that the code is resumption safe but
7987 it is also slow.
7988
7989 When optimizations are turned on, we delay issuing a trapb as long
7990 as possible. In this context, a trap shadow is the sequence of
7991 instructions that starts with a (potentially) trap generating
7992 instruction and extends to the next trapb or call_pal instruction
7993 (but GCC never generates call_pal by itself). We can delay (and
7994 therefore sometimes omit) a trapb subject to the following
7995 conditions:
7996
7997 (a) On entry to the trap shadow, if any Alpha register or memory
7998 location contains a value that is used as an operand value by some
7999 instruction in the trap shadow (live on entry), then no instruction
8000 in the trap shadow may modify the register or memory location.
8001
8002 (b) Within the trap shadow, the computation of the base register
8003 for a memory load or store instruction may not involve using the
8004 result of an instruction that might generate an UNPREDICTABLE
8005 result.
8006
8007 (c) Within the trap shadow, no register may be used more than once
8008 as a destination register. (This is to make life easier for the
8009 trap-handler.)
8010
8011 (d) The trap shadow may not include any branch instructions. */
8012
8013 static void
8014 alpha_handle_trap_shadows (void)
8015 {
8016 struct shadow_summary shadow;
8017 int trap_pending, exception_nesting;
8018 rtx i, n;
8019
8020 trap_pending = 0;
8021 exception_nesting = 0;
8022 shadow.used.i = 0;
8023 shadow.used.fp = 0;
8024 shadow.used.mem = 0;
8025 shadow.defd = shadow.used;
8026
8027 for (i = get_insns (); i ; i = NEXT_INSN (i))
8028 {
8029 if (GET_CODE (i) == NOTE)
8030 {
8031 switch (NOTE_LINE_NUMBER (i))
8032 {
8033 case NOTE_INSN_EH_REGION_BEG:
8034 exception_nesting++;
8035 if (trap_pending)
8036 goto close_shadow;
8037 break;
8038
8039 case NOTE_INSN_EH_REGION_END:
8040 exception_nesting--;
8041 if (trap_pending)
8042 goto close_shadow;
8043 break;
8044
8045 case NOTE_INSN_EPILOGUE_BEG:
8046 if (trap_pending && alpha_tp >= ALPHA_TP_FUNC)
8047 goto close_shadow;
8048 break;
8049 }
8050 }
8051 else if (trap_pending)
8052 {
8053 if (alpha_tp == ALPHA_TP_FUNC)
8054 {
8055 if (GET_CODE (i) == JUMP_INSN
8056 && GET_CODE (PATTERN (i)) == RETURN)
8057 goto close_shadow;
8058 }
8059 else if (alpha_tp == ALPHA_TP_INSN)
8060 {
8061 if (optimize > 0)
8062 {
8063 struct shadow_summary sum;
8064
8065 sum.used.i = 0;
8066 sum.used.fp = 0;
8067 sum.used.mem = 0;
8068 sum.defd = sum.used;
8069
8070 switch (GET_CODE (i))
8071 {
8072 case INSN:
8073 /* Annoyingly, get_attr_trap will abort on these. */
8074 if (GET_CODE (PATTERN (i)) == USE
8075 || GET_CODE (PATTERN (i)) == CLOBBER)
8076 break;
8077
8078 summarize_insn (PATTERN (i), &sum, 0);
8079
8080 if ((sum.defd.i & shadow.defd.i)
8081 || (sum.defd.fp & shadow.defd.fp))
8082 {
8083 /* (c) would be violated */
8084 goto close_shadow;
8085 }
8086
8087 /* Combine shadow with summary of current insn: */
8088 shadow.used.i |= sum.used.i;
8089 shadow.used.fp |= sum.used.fp;
8090 shadow.used.mem |= sum.used.mem;
8091 shadow.defd.i |= sum.defd.i;
8092 shadow.defd.fp |= sum.defd.fp;
8093 shadow.defd.mem |= sum.defd.mem;
8094
8095 if ((sum.defd.i & shadow.used.i)
8096 || (sum.defd.fp & shadow.used.fp)
8097 || (sum.defd.mem & shadow.used.mem))
8098 {
8099 /* (a) would be violated (also takes care of (b)) */
8100 if (get_attr_trap (i) == TRAP_YES
8101 && ((sum.defd.i & sum.used.i)
8102 || (sum.defd.fp & sum.used.fp)))
8103 abort ();
8104
8105 goto close_shadow;
8106 }
8107 break;
8108
8109 case JUMP_INSN:
8110 case CALL_INSN:
8111 case CODE_LABEL:
8112 goto close_shadow;
8113
8114 default:
8115 abort ();
8116 }
8117 }
8118 else
8119 {
8120 close_shadow:
8121 n = emit_insn_before (gen_trapb (), i);
8122 PUT_MODE (n, TImode);
8123 PUT_MODE (i, TImode);
8124 trap_pending = 0;
8125 shadow.used.i = 0;
8126 shadow.used.fp = 0;
8127 shadow.used.mem = 0;
8128 shadow.defd = shadow.used;
8129 }
8130 }
8131 }
8132
8133 if ((exception_nesting > 0 || alpha_tp >= ALPHA_TP_FUNC)
8134 && GET_CODE (i) == INSN
8135 && GET_CODE (PATTERN (i)) != USE
8136 && GET_CODE (PATTERN (i)) != CLOBBER
8137 && get_attr_trap (i) == TRAP_YES)
8138 {
8139 if (optimize && !trap_pending)
8140 summarize_insn (PATTERN (i), &shadow, 0);
8141 trap_pending = 1;
8142 }
8143 }
8144 }
8145 \f
8146 /* Alpha can only issue instruction groups simultaneously if they are
8147 suitibly aligned. This is very processor-specific. */
8148
8149 enum alphaev4_pipe {
8150 EV4_STOP = 0,
8151 EV4_IB0 = 1,
8152 EV4_IB1 = 2,
8153 EV4_IBX = 4
8154 };
8155
8156 enum alphaev5_pipe {
8157 EV5_STOP = 0,
8158 EV5_NONE = 1,
8159 EV5_E01 = 2,
8160 EV5_E0 = 4,
8161 EV5_E1 = 8,
8162 EV5_FAM = 16,
8163 EV5_FA = 32,
8164 EV5_FM = 64
8165 };
8166
8167 static enum alphaev4_pipe
8168 alphaev4_insn_pipe (rtx insn)
8169 {
8170 if (recog_memoized (insn) < 0)
8171 return EV4_STOP;
8172 if (get_attr_length (insn) != 4)
8173 return EV4_STOP;
8174
8175 switch (get_attr_type (insn))
8176 {
8177 case TYPE_ILD:
8178 case TYPE_FLD:
8179 return EV4_IBX;
8180
8181 case TYPE_LDSYM:
8182 case TYPE_IADD:
8183 case TYPE_ILOG:
8184 case TYPE_ICMOV:
8185 case TYPE_ICMP:
8186 case TYPE_IST:
8187 case TYPE_FST:
8188 case TYPE_SHIFT:
8189 case TYPE_IMUL:
8190 case TYPE_FBR:
8191 return EV4_IB0;
8192
8193 case TYPE_MISC:
8194 case TYPE_IBR:
8195 case TYPE_JSR:
8196 case TYPE_CALLPAL:
8197 case TYPE_FCPYS:
8198 case TYPE_FCMOV:
8199 case TYPE_FADD:
8200 case TYPE_FDIV:
8201 case TYPE_FMUL:
8202 return EV4_IB1;
8203
8204 default:
8205 abort ();
8206 }
8207 }
8208
8209 static enum alphaev5_pipe
8210 alphaev5_insn_pipe (rtx insn)
8211 {
8212 if (recog_memoized (insn) < 0)
8213 return EV5_STOP;
8214 if (get_attr_length (insn) != 4)
8215 return EV5_STOP;
8216
8217 switch (get_attr_type (insn))
8218 {
8219 case TYPE_ILD:
8220 case TYPE_FLD:
8221 case TYPE_LDSYM:
8222 case TYPE_IADD:
8223 case TYPE_ILOG:
8224 case TYPE_ICMOV:
8225 case TYPE_ICMP:
8226 return EV5_E01;
8227
8228 case TYPE_IST:
8229 case TYPE_FST:
8230 case TYPE_SHIFT:
8231 case TYPE_IMUL:
8232 case TYPE_MISC:
8233 case TYPE_MVI:
8234 return EV5_E0;
8235
8236 case TYPE_IBR:
8237 case TYPE_JSR:
8238 case TYPE_CALLPAL:
8239 return EV5_E1;
8240
8241 case TYPE_FCPYS:
8242 return EV5_FAM;
8243
8244 case TYPE_FBR:
8245 case TYPE_FCMOV:
8246 case TYPE_FADD:
8247 case TYPE_FDIV:
8248 return EV5_FA;
8249
8250 case TYPE_FMUL:
8251 return EV5_FM;
8252
8253 default:
8254 abort();
8255 }
8256 }
8257
8258 /* IN_USE is a mask of the slots currently filled within the insn group.
8259 The mask bits come from alphaev4_pipe above. If EV4_IBX is set, then
8260 the insn in EV4_IB0 can be swapped by the hardware into EV4_IB1.
8261
8262 LEN is, of course, the length of the group in bytes. */
8263
8264 static rtx
8265 alphaev4_next_group (rtx insn, int *pin_use, int *plen)
8266 {
8267 int len, in_use;
8268
8269 len = in_use = 0;
8270
8271 if (! INSN_P (insn)
8272 || GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn)) == CLOBBER
8273 || GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn)) == USE)
8274 goto next_and_done;
8275
8276 while (1)
8277 {
8278 enum alphaev4_pipe pipe;
8279
8280 pipe = alphaev4_insn_pipe (insn);
8281 switch (pipe)
8282 {
8283 case EV4_STOP:
8284 /* Force complex instructions to start new groups. */
8285 if (in_use)
8286 goto done;
8287
8288 /* If this is a completely unrecognized insn, its an asm.
8289 We don't know how long it is, so record length as -1 to
8290 signal a needed realignment. */
8291 if (recog_memoized (insn) < 0)
8292 len = -1;
8293 else
8294 len = get_attr_length (insn);
8295 goto next_and_done;
8296
8297 case EV4_IBX:
8298 if (in_use & EV4_IB0)
8299 {
8300 if (in_use & EV4_IB1)
8301 goto done;
8302 in_use |= EV4_IB1;
8303 }
8304 else
8305 in_use |= EV4_IB0 | EV4_IBX;
8306 break;
8307
8308 case EV4_IB0:
8309 if (in_use & EV4_IB0)
8310 {
8311 if (!(in_use & EV4_IBX) || (in_use & EV4_IB1))
8312 goto done;
8313 in_use |= EV4_IB1;
8314 }
8315 in_use |= EV4_IB0;
8316 break;
8317
8318 case EV4_IB1:
8319 if (in_use & EV4_IB1)
8320 goto done;
8321 in_use |= EV4_IB1;
8322 break;
8323
8324 default:
8325 abort();
8326 }
8327 len += 4;
8328
8329 /* Haifa doesn't do well scheduling branches. */
8330 if (GET_CODE (insn) == JUMP_INSN)
8331 goto next_and_done;
8332
8333 next:
8334 insn = next_nonnote_insn (insn);
8335
8336 if (!insn || ! INSN_P (insn))
8337 goto done;
8338
8339 /* Let Haifa tell us where it thinks insn group boundaries are. */
8340 if (GET_MODE (insn) == TImode)
8341 goto done;
8342
8343 if (GET_CODE (insn) == CLOBBER || GET_CODE (insn) == USE)
8344 goto next;
8345 }
8346
8347 next_and_done:
8348 insn = next_nonnote_insn (insn);
8349
8350 done:
8351 *plen = len;
8352 *pin_use = in_use;
8353 return insn;
8354 }
8355
8356 /* IN_USE is a mask of the slots currently filled within the insn group.
8357 The mask bits come from alphaev5_pipe above. If EV5_E01 is set, then
8358 the insn in EV5_E0 can be swapped by the hardware into EV5_E1.
8359
8360 LEN is, of course, the length of the group in bytes. */
8361
8362 static rtx
8363 alphaev5_next_group (rtx insn, int *pin_use, int *plen)
8364 {
8365 int len, in_use;
8366
8367 len = in_use = 0;
8368
8369 if (! INSN_P (insn)
8370 || GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn)) == CLOBBER
8371 || GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn)) == USE)
8372 goto next_and_done;
8373
8374 while (1)
8375 {
8376 enum alphaev5_pipe pipe;
8377
8378 pipe = alphaev5_insn_pipe (insn);
8379 switch (pipe)
8380 {
8381 case EV5_STOP:
8382 /* Force complex instructions to start new groups. */
8383 if (in_use)
8384 goto done;
8385
8386 /* If this is a completely unrecognized insn, its an asm.
8387 We don't know how long it is, so record length as -1 to
8388 signal a needed realignment. */
8389 if (recog_memoized (insn) < 0)
8390 len = -1;
8391 else
8392 len = get_attr_length (insn);
8393 goto next_and_done;
8394
8395 /* ??? Most of the places below, we would like to abort, as
8396 it would indicate an error either in Haifa, or in the
8397 scheduling description. Unfortunately, Haifa never
8398 schedules the last instruction of the BB, so we don't
8399 have an accurate TI bit to go off. */
8400 case EV5_E01:
8401 if (in_use & EV5_E0)
8402 {
8403 if (in_use & EV5_E1)
8404 goto done;
8405 in_use |= EV5_E1;
8406 }
8407 else
8408 in_use |= EV5_E0 | EV5_E01;
8409 break;
8410
8411 case EV5_E0:
8412 if (in_use & EV5_E0)
8413 {
8414 if (!(in_use & EV5_E01) || (in_use & EV5_E1))
8415 goto done;
8416 in_use |= EV5_E1;
8417 }
8418 in_use |= EV5_E0;
8419 break;
8420
8421 case EV5_E1:
8422 if (in_use & EV5_E1)
8423 goto done;
8424 in_use |= EV5_E1;
8425 break;
8426
8427 case EV5_FAM:
8428 if (in_use & EV5_FA)
8429 {
8430 if (in_use & EV5_FM)
8431 goto done;
8432 in_use |= EV5_FM;
8433 }
8434 else
8435 in_use |= EV5_FA | EV5_FAM;
8436 break;
8437
8438 case EV5_FA:
8439 if (in_use & EV5_FA)
8440 goto done;
8441 in_use |= EV5_FA;
8442 break;
8443
8444 case EV5_FM:
8445 if (in_use & EV5_FM)
8446 goto done;
8447 in_use |= EV5_FM;
8448 break;
8449
8450 case EV5_NONE:
8451 break;
8452
8453 default:
8454 abort();
8455 }
8456 len += 4;
8457
8458 /* Haifa doesn't do well scheduling branches. */
8459 /* ??? If this is predicted not-taken, slotting continues, except
8460 that no more IBR, FBR, or JSR insns may be slotted. */
8461 if (GET_CODE (insn) == JUMP_INSN)
8462 goto next_and_done;
8463
8464 next:
8465 insn = next_nonnote_insn (insn);
8466
8467 if (!insn || ! INSN_P (insn))
8468 goto done;
8469
8470 /* Let Haifa tell us where it thinks insn group boundaries are. */
8471 if (GET_MODE (insn) == TImode)
8472 goto done;
8473
8474 if (GET_CODE (insn) == CLOBBER || GET_CODE (insn) == USE)
8475 goto next;
8476 }
8477
8478 next_and_done:
8479 insn = next_nonnote_insn (insn);
8480
8481 done:
8482 *plen = len;
8483 *pin_use = in_use;
8484 return insn;
8485 }
8486
8487 static rtx
8488 alphaev4_next_nop (int *pin_use)
8489 {
8490 int in_use = *pin_use;
8491 rtx nop;
8492
8493 if (!(in_use & EV4_IB0))
8494 {
8495 in_use |= EV4_IB0;
8496 nop = gen_nop ();
8497 }
8498 else if ((in_use & (EV4_IBX|EV4_IB1)) == EV4_IBX)
8499 {
8500 in_use |= EV4_IB1;
8501 nop = gen_nop ();
8502 }
8503 else if (TARGET_FP && !(in_use & EV4_IB1))
8504 {
8505 in_use |= EV4_IB1;
8506 nop = gen_fnop ();
8507 }
8508 else
8509 nop = gen_unop ();
8510
8511 *pin_use = in_use;
8512 return nop;
8513 }
8514
8515 static rtx
8516 alphaev5_next_nop (int *pin_use)
8517 {
8518 int in_use = *pin_use;
8519 rtx nop;
8520
8521 if (!(in_use & EV5_E1))
8522 {
8523 in_use |= EV5_E1;
8524 nop = gen_nop ();
8525 }
8526 else if (TARGET_FP && !(in_use & EV5_FA))
8527 {
8528 in_use |= EV5_FA;
8529 nop = gen_fnop ();
8530 }
8531 else if (TARGET_FP && !(in_use & EV5_FM))
8532 {
8533 in_use |= EV5_FM;
8534 nop = gen_fnop ();
8535 }
8536 else
8537 nop = gen_unop ();
8538
8539 *pin_use = in_use;
8540 return nop;
8541 }
8542
8543 /* The instruction group alignment main loop. */
8544
8545 static void
8546 alpha_align_insns (unsigned int max_align,
8547 rtx (*next_group) (rtx, int *, int *),
8548 rtx (*next_nop) (int *))
8549 {
8550 /* ALIGN is the known alignment for the insn group. */
8551 unsigned int align;
8552 /* OFS is the offset of the current insn in the insn group. */
8553 int ofs;
8554 int prev_in_use, in_use, len;
8555 rtx i, next;
8556
8557 /* Let shorten branches care for assigning alignments to code labels. */
8558 shorten_branches (get_insns ());
8559
8560 if (align_functions < 4)
8561 align = 4;
8562 else if ((unsigned int) align_functions < max_align)
8563 align = align_functions;
8564 else
8565 align = max_align;
8566
8567 ofs = prev_in_use = 0;
8568 i = get_insns ();
8569 if (GET_CODE (i) == NOTE)
8570 i = next_nonnote_insn (i);
8571
8572 while (i)
8573 {
8574 next = (*next_group) (i, &in_use, &len);
8575
8576 /* When we see a label, resync alignment etc. */
8577 if (GET_CODE (i) == CODE_LABEL)
8578 {
8579 unsigned int new_align = 1 << label_to_alignment (i);
8580
8581 if (new_align >= align)
8582 {
8583 align = new_align < max_align ? new_align : max_align;
8584 ofs = 0;
8585 }
8586
8587 else if (ofs & (new_align-1))
8588 ofs = (ofs | (new_align-1)) + 1;
8589 if (len != 0)
8590 abort();
8591 }
8592
8593 /* Handle complex instructions special. */
8594 else if (in_use == 0)
8595 {
8596 /* Asms will have length < 0. This is a signal that we have
8597 lost alignment knowledge. Assume, however, that the asm
8598 will not mis-align instructions. */
8599 if (len < 0)
8600 {
8601 ofs = 0;
8602 align = 4;
8603 len = 0;
8604 }
8605 }
8606
8607 /* If the known alignment is smaller than the recognized insn group,
8608 realign the output. */
8609 else if ((int) align < len)
8610 {
8611 unsigned int new_log_align = len > 8 ? 4 : 3;
8612 rtx prev, where;
8613
8614 where = prev = prev_nonnote_insn (i);
8615 if (!where || GET_CODE (where) != CODE_LABEL)
8616 where = i;
8617
8618 /* Can't realign between a call and its gp reload. */
8619 if (! (TARGET_EXPLICIT_RELOCS
8620 && prev && GET_CODE (prev) == CALL_INSN))
8621 {
8622 emit_insn_before (gen_realign (GEN_INT (new_log_align)), where);
8623 align = 1 << new_log_align;
8624 ofs = 0;
8625 }
8626 }
8627
8628 /* If the group won't fit in the same INT16 as the previous,
8629 we need to add padding to keep the group together. Rather
8630 than simply leaving the insn filling to the assembler, we
8631 can make use of the knowledge of what sorts of instructions
8632 were issued in the previous group to make sure that all of
8633 the added nops are really free. */
8634 else if (ofs + len > (int) align)
8635 {
8636 int nop_count = (align - ofs) / 4;
8637 rtx where;
8638
8639 /* Insert nops before labels, branches, and calls to truely merge
8640 the execution of the nops with the previous instruction group. */
8641 where = prev_nonnote_insn (i);
8642 if (where)
8643 {
8644 if (GET_CODE (where) == CODE_LABEL)
8645 {
8646 rtx where2 = prev_nonnote_insn (where);
8647 if (where2 && GET_CODE (where2) == JUMP_INSN)
8648 where = where2;
8649 }
8650 else if (GET_CODE (where) == INSN)
8651 where = i;
8652 }
8653 else
8654 where = i;
8655
8656 do
8657 emit_insn_before ((*next_nop)(&prev_in_use), where);
8658 while (--nop_count);
8659 ofs = 0;
8660 }
8661
8662 ofs = (ofs + len) & (align - 1);
8663 prev_in_use = in_use;
8664 i = next;
8665 }
8666 }
8667 \f
8668 /* Machine dependent reorg pass. */
8669
8670 static void
8671 alpha_reorg (void)
8672 {
8673 if (alpha_tp != ALPHA_TP_PROG || flag_exceptions)
8674 alpha_handle_trap_shadows ();
8675
8676 /* Due to the number of extra trapb insns, don't bother fixing up
8677 alignment when trap precision is instruction. Moreover, we can
8678 only do our job when sched2 is run. */
8679 if (optimize && !optimize_size
8680 && alpha_tp != ALPHA_TP_INSN
8681 && flag_schedule_insns_after_reload)
8682 {
8683 if (alpha_cpu == PROCESSOR_EV4)
8684 alpha_align_insns (8, alphaev4_next_group, alphaev4_next_nop);
8685 else if (alpha_cpu == PROCESSOR_EV5)
8686 alpha_align_insns (16, alphaev5_next_group, alphaev5_next_nop);
8687 }
8688 }
8689 \f
8690 #ifdef OBJECT_FORMAT_ELF
8691
8692 /* Switch to the section to which we should output X. The only thing
8693 special we do here is to honor small data. */
8694
8695 static void
8696 alpha_elf_select_rtx_section (enum machine_mode mode, rtx x,
8697 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT align)
8698 {
8699 if (TARGET_SMALL_DATA && GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) <= g_switch_value)
8700 /* ??? Consider using mergable sdata sections. */
8701 sdata_section ();
8702 else
8703 default_elf_select_rtx_section (mode, x, align);
8704 }
8705
8706 #endif /* OBJECT_FORMAT_ELF */
8707 \f
8708 /* Structure to collect function names for final output in link section. */
8709 /* Note that items marked with GTY can't be ifdef'ed out. */
8710
8711 enum links_kind {KIND_UNUSED, KIND_LOCAL, KIND_EXTERN};
8712 enum reloc_kind {KIND_LINKAGE, KIND_CODEADDR};
8713
8714 struct alpha_links GTY(())
8715 {
8716 int num;
8717 rtx linkage;
8718 enum links_kind lkind;
8719 enum reloc_kind rkind;
8720 };
8721
8722 struct alpha_funcs GTY(())
8723 {
8724 int num;
8725 splay_tree GTY ((param1_is (char *), param2_is (struct alpha_links *)))
8726 links;
8727 };
8728
8729 static GTY ((param1_is (char *), param2_is (struct alpha_links *)))
8730 splay_tree alpha_links_tree;
8731 static GTY ((param1_is (tree), param2_is (struct alpha_funcs *)))
8732 splay_tree alpha_funcs_tree;
8733
8734 static GTY(()) int alpha_funcs_num;
8735
8736 #if TARGET_ABI_OPEN_VMS
8737
8738 /* Return the VMS argument type corresponding to MODE. */
8739
8740 enum avms_arg_type
8741 alpha_arg_type (enum machine_mode mode)
8742 {
8743 switch (mode)
8744 {
8745 case SFmode:
8746 return TARGET_FLOAT_VAX ? FF : FS;
8747 case DFmode:
8748 return TARGET_FLOAT_VAX ? FD : FT;
8749 default:
8750 return I64;
8751 }
8752 }
8753
8754 /* Return an rtx for an integer representing the VMS Argument Information
8755 register value. */
8756
8757 rtx
8758 alpha_arg_info_reg_val (CUMULATIVE_ARGS cum)
8759 {
8760 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT regval = cum.num_args;
8761 int i;
8762
8763 for (i = 0; i < 6; i++)
8764 regval |= ((int) cum.atypes[i]) << (i * 3 + 8);
8765
8766 return GEN_INT (regval);
8767 }
8768 \f
8769 /* Make (or fake) .linkage entry for function call.
8770
8771 IS_LOCAL is 0 if name is used in call, 1 if name is used in definition.
8772
8773 Return an SYMBOL_REF rtx for the linkage. */
8774
8775 rtx
8776 alpha_need_linkage (const char *name, int is_local)
8777 {
8778 splay_tree_node node;
8779 struct alpha_links *al;
8780
8781 if (name[0] == '*')
8782 name++;
8783
8784 if (is_local)
8785 {
8786 struct alpha_funcs *cfaf;
8787
8788 if (!alpha_funcs_tree)
8789 alpha_funcs_tree = splay_tree_new_ggc ((splay_tree_compare_fn)
8790 splay_tree_compare_pointers);
8791
8792 cfaf = (struct alpha_funcs *) ggc_alloc (sizeof (struct alpha_funcs));
8793
8794 cfaf->links = 0;
8795 cfaf->num = ++alpha_funcs_num;
8796
8797 splay_tree_insert (alpha_funcs_tree,
8798 (splay_tree_key) current_function_decl,
8799 (splay_tree_value) cfaf);
8800 }
8801
8802 if (alpha_links_tree)
8803 {
8804 /* Is this name already defined? */
8805
8806 node = splay_tree_lookup (alpha_links_tree, (splay_tree_key) name);
8807 if (node)
8808 {
8809 al = (struct alpha_links *) node->value;
8810 if (is_local)
8811 {
8812 /* Defined here but external assumed. */
8813 if (al->lkind == KIND_EXTERN)
8814 al->lkind = KIND_LOCAL;
8815 }
8816 else
8817 {
8818 /* Used here but unused assumed. */
8819 if (al->lkind == KIND_UNUSED)
8820 al->lkind = KIND_LOCAL;
8821 }
8822 return al->linkage;
8823 }
8824 }
8825 else
8826 alpha_links_tree = splay_tree_new_ggc ((splay_tree_compare_fn) strcmp);
8827
8828 al = (struct alpha_links *) ggc_alloc (sizeof (struct alpha_links));
8829 name = ggc_strdup (name);
8830
8831 /* Assume external if no definition. */
8832 al->lkind = (is_local ? KIND_UNUSED : KIND_EXTERN);
8833
8834 /* Ensure we have an IDENTIFIER so assemble_name can mark it used. */
8835 get_identifier (name);
8836
8837 /* Construct a SYMBOL_REF for us to call. */
8838 {
8839 size_t name_len = strlen (name);
8840 char *linksym = alloca (name_len + 6);
8841 linksym[0] = '$';
8842 memcpy (linksym + 1, name, name_len);
8843 memcpy (linksym + 1 + name_len, "..lk", 5);
8844 al->linkage = gen_rtx_SYMBOL_REF (Pmode,
8845 ggc_alloc_string (linksym, name_len + 5));
8846 }
8847
8848 splay_tree_insert (alpha_links_tree, (splay_tree_key) name,
8849 (splay_tree_value) al);
8850
8851 return al->linkage;
8852 }
8853
8854 rtx
8855 alpha_use_linkage (rtx linkage, tree cfundecl, int lflag, int rflag)
8856 {
8857 splay_tree_node cfunnode;
8858 struct alpha_funcs *cfaf;
8859 struct alpha_links *al;
8860 const char *name = XSTR (linkage, 0);
8861
8862 cfaf = (struct alpha_funcs *) 0;
8863 al = (struct alpha_links *) 0;
8864
8865 cfunnode = splay_tree_lookup (alpha_funcs_tree, (splay_tree_key) cfundecl);
8866 cfaf = (struct alpha_funcs *) cfunnode->value;
8867
8868 if (cfaf->links)
8869 {
8870 splay_tree_node lnode;
8871
8872 /* Is this name already defined? */
8873
8874 lnode = splay_tree_lookup (cfaf->links, (splay_tree_key) name);
8875 if (lnode)
8876 al = (struct alpha_links *) lnode->value;
8877 }
8878 else
8879 cfaf->links = splay_tree_new_ggc ((splay_tree_compare_fn) strcmp);
8880
8881 if (!al)
8882 {
8883 size_t name_len;
8884 size_t buflen;
8885 char buf [512];
8886 char *linksym;
8887 splay_tree_node node = 0;
8888 struct alpha_links *anl;
8889
8890 if (name[0] == '*')
8891 name++;
8892
8893 name_len = strlen (name);
8894
8895 al = (struct alpha_links *) ggc_alloc (sizeof (struct alpha_links));
8896 al->num = cfaf->num;
8897
8898 node = splay_tree_lookup (alpha_links_tree, (splay_tree_key) name);
8899 if (node)
8900 {
8901 anl = (struct alpha_links *) node->value;
8902 al->lkind = anl->lkind;
8903 }
8904
8905 sprintf (buf, "$%d..%s..lk", cfaf->num, name);
8906 buflen = strlen (buf);
8907 linksym = alloca (buflen + 1);
8908 memcpy (linksym, buf, buflen + 1);
8909
8910 al->linkage = gen_rtx_SYMBOL_REF
8911 (Pmode, ggc_alloc_string (linksym, buflen + 1));
8912
8913 splay_tree_insert (cfaf->links, (splay_tree_key) name,
8914 (splay_tree_value) al);
8915 }
8916
8917 if (rflag)
8918 al->rkind = KIND_CODEADDR;
8919 else
8920 al->rkind = KIND_LINKAGE;
8921
8922 if (lflag)
8923 return gen_rtx_MEM (Pmode, plus_constant (al->linkage, 8));
8924 else
8925 return al->linkage;
8926 }
8927
8928 static int
8929 alpha_write_one_linkage (splay_tree_node node, void *data)
8930 {
8931 const char *const name = (const char *) node->key;
8932 struct alpha_links *link = (struct alpha_links *) node->value;
8933 FILE *stream = (FILE *) data;
8934
8935 fprintf (stream, "$%d..%s..lk:\n", link->num, name);
8936 if (link->rkind == KIND_CODEADDR)
8937 {
8938 if (link->lkind == KIND_LOCAL)
8939 {
8940 /* Local and used */
8941 fprintf (stream, "\t.quad %s..en\n", name);
8942 }
8943 else
8944 {
8945 /* External and used, request code address. */
8946 fprintf (stream, "\t.code_address %s\n", name);
8947 }
8948 }
8949 else
8950 {
8951 if (link->lkind == KIND_LOCAL)
8952 {
8953 /* Local and used, build linkage pair. */
8954 fprintf (stream, "\t.quad %s..en\n", name);
8955 fprintf (stream, "\t.quad %s\n", name);
8956 }
8957 else
8958 {
8959 /* External and used, request linkage pair. */
8960 fprintf (stream, "\t.linkage %s\n", name);
8961 }
8962 }
8963
8964 return 0;
8965 }
8966
8967 static void
8968 alpha_write_linkage (FILE *stream, const char *funname, tree fundecl)
8969 {
8970 splay_tree_node node;
8971 struct alpha_funcs *func;
8972
8973 link_section ();
8974 fprintf (stream, "\t.align 3\n");
8975 node = splay_tree_lookup (alpha_funcs_tree, (splay_tree_key) fundecl);
8976 func = (struct alpha_funcs *) node->value;
8977
8978 fputs ("\t.name ", stream);
8979 assemble_name (stream, funname);
8980 fputs ("..na\n", stream);
8981 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (stream, funname);
8982 fprintf (stream, "\t.pdesc ");
8983 assemble_name (stream, funname);
8984 fprintf (stream, "..en,%s\n",
8985 alpha_procedure_type == PT_STACK ? "stack"
8986 : alpha_procedure_type == PT_REGISTER ? "reg" : "null");
8987
8988 if (func->links)
8989 {
8990 splay_tree_foreach (func->links, alpha_write_one_linkage, stream);
8991 /* splay_tree_delete (func->links); */
8992 }
8993 }
8994
8995 /* Given a decl, a section name, and whether the decl initializer
8996 has relocs, choose attributes for the section. */
8997
8998 #define SECTION_VMS_OVERLAY SECTION_FORGET
8999 #define SECTION_VMS_GLOBAL SECTION_MACH_DEP
9000 #define SECTION_VMS_INITIALIZE (SECTION_VMS_GLOBAL << 1)
9001
9002 static unsigned int
9003 vms_section_type_flags (tree decl, const char *name, int reloc)
9004 {
9005 unsigned int flags = default_section_type_flags (decl, name, reloc);
9006
9007 if (decl && DECL_ATTRIBUTES (decl)
9008 && lookup_attribute ("overlaid", DECL_ATTRIBUTES (decl)))
9009 flags |= SECTION_VMS_OVERLAY;
9010 if (decl && DECL_ATTRIBUTES (decl)
9011 && lookup_attribute ("global", DECL_ATTRIBUTES (decl)))
9012 flags |= SECTION_VMS_GLOBAL;
9013 if (decl && DECL_ATTRIBUTES (decl)
9014 && lookup_attribute ("initialize", DECL_ATTRIBUTES (decl)))
9015 flags |= SECTION_VMS_INITIALIZE;
9016
9017 return flags;
9018 }
9019
9020 /* Switch to an arbitrary section NAME with attributes as specified
9021 by FLAGS. ALIGN specifies any known alignment requirements for
9022 the section; 0 if the default should be used. */
9023
9024 static void
9025 vms_asm_named_section (const char *name, unsigned int flags)
9026 {
9027 fputc ('\n', asm_out_file);
9028 fprintf (asm_out_file, ".section\t%s", name);
9029
9030 if (flags & SECTION_VMS_OVERLAY)
9031 fprintf (asm_out_file, ",OVR");
9032 if (flags & SECTION_VMS_GLOBAL)
9033 fprintf (asm_out_file, ",GBL");
9034 if (flags & SECTION_VMS_INITIALIZE)
9035 fprintf (asm_out_file, ",NOMOD");
9036 if (flags & SECTION_DEBUG)
9037 fprintf (asm_out_file, ",NOWRT");
9038
9039 fputc ('\n', asm_out_file);
9040 }
9041
9042 /* Record an element in the table of global constructors. SYMBOL is
9043 a SYMBOL_REF of the function to be called; PRIORITY is a number
9044 between 0 and MAX_INIT_PRIORITY.
9045
9046 Differs from default_ctors_section_asm_out_constructor in that the
9047 width of the .ctors entry is always 64 bits, rather than the 32 bits
9048 used by a normal pointer. */
9049
9050 static void
9051 vms_asm_out_constructor (rtx symbol, int priority ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
9052 {
9053 ctors_section ();
9054 assemble_align (BITS_PER_WORD);
9055 assemble_integer (symbol, UNITS_PER_WORD, BITS_PER_WORD, 1);
9056 }
9057
9058 static void
9059 vms_asm_out_destructor (rtx symbol, int priority ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
9060 {
9061 dtors_section ();
9062 assemble_align (BITS_PER_WORD);
9063 assemble_integer (symbol, UNITS_PER_WORD, BITS_PER_WORD, 1);
9064 }
9065 #else
9066
9067 rtx
9068 alpha_need_linkage (const char *name ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
9069 int is_local ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
9070 {
9071 return NULL_RTX;
9072 }
9073
9074 rtx
9075 alpha_use_linkage (rtx linkage ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
9076 tree cfundecl ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
9077 int lflag ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
9078 int rflag ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
9079 {
9080 return NULL_RTX;
9081 }
9082
9083 #endif /* TARGET_ABI_OPEN_VMS */
9084 \f
9085 #if TARGET_ABI_UNICOSMK
9086
9087 /* Define the offset between two registers, one to be eliminated, and the
9088 other its replacement, at the start of a routine. */
9089
9090 int
9091 unicosmk_initial_elimination_offset (int from, int to)
9092 {
9093 int fixed_size;
9094
9095 fixed_size = alpha_sa_size();
9096 if (fixed_size != 0)
9097 fixed_size += 48;
9098
9099 if (from == FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM && to == HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM)
9100 return -fixed_size;
9101 else if (from == ARG_POINTER_REGNUM && to == HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM)
9102 return 0;
9103 else if (from == FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM && to == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM)
9104 return (ALPHA_ROUND (current_function_outgoing_args_size)
9105 + ALPHA_ROUND (get_frame_size()));
9106 else if (from == ARG_POINTER_REGNUM && to == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM)
9107 return (ALPHA_ROUND (fixed_size)
9108 + ALPHA_ROUND (get_frame_size()
9109 + current_function_outgoing_args_size));
9110 else
9111 abort ();
9112 }
9113
9114 /* Output the module name for .ident and .end directives. We have to strip
9115 directories and add make sure that the module name starts with a letter
9116 or '$'. */
9117
9118 static void
9119 unicosmk_output_module_name (FILE *file)
9120 {
9121 const char *name;
9122
9123 /* Strip directories. */
9124
9125 name = strrchr (main_input_filename, '/');
9126 if (name)
9127 ++name;
9128 else
9129 name = main_input_filename;
9130
9131 /* CAM only accepts module names that start with a letter or '$'. We
9132 prefix the module name with a '$' if necessary. */
9133
9134 if (!ISALPHA (*name))
9135 putc ('$', file);
9136 output_clean_symbol_name (file, name);
9137 }
9138
9139 /* Output the definition of a common variable. */
9140
9141 void
9142 unicosmk_output_common (FILE *file, const char *name, int size, int align)
9143 {
9144 tree name_tree;
9145 printf ("T3E__: common %s\n", name);
9146
9147 common_section ();
9148 fputs("\t.endp\n\n\t.psect ", file);
9149 assemble_name(file, name);
9150 fprintf(file, ",%d,common\n", floor_log2 (align / BITS_PER_UNIT));
9151 fprintf(file, "\t.byte\t0:%d\n", size);
9152
9153 /* Mark the symbol as defined in this module. */
9154 name_tree = get_identifier (name);
9155 TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (name_tree) = 1;
9156 }
9157
9158 #define SECTION_PUBLIC SECTION_MACH_DEP
9159 #define SECTION_MAIN (SECTION_PUBLIC << 1)
9160 static int current_section_align;
9161
9162 static unsigned int
9163 unicosmk_section_type_flags (tree decl, const char *name,
9164 int reloc ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
9165 {
9166 unsigned int flags = default_section_type_flags (decl, name, reloc);
9167
9168 if (!decl)
9169 return flags;
9170
9171 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == FUNCTION_DECL)
9172 {
9173 current_section_align = floor_log2 (FUNCTION_BOUNDARY / BITS_PER_UNIT);
9174 if (align_functions_log > current_section_align)
9175 current_section_align = align_functions_log;
9176
9177 if (! strcmp (IDENTIFIER_POINTER (DECL_ASSEMBLER_NAME (decl)), "main"))
9178 flags |= SECTION_MAIN;
9179 }
9180 else
9181 current_section_align = floor_log2 (DECL_ALIGN (decl) / BITS_PER_UNIT);
9182
9183 if (TREE_PUBLIC (decl))
9184 flags |= SECTION_PUBLIC;
9185
9186 return flags;
9187 }
9188
9189 /* Generate a section name for decl and associate it with the
9190 declaration. */
9191
9192 static void
9193 unicosmk_unique_section (tree decl, int reloc ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
9194 {
9195 const char *name;
9196 int len;
9197
9198 if (!decl)
9199 abort ();
9200
9201 name = IDENTIFIER_POINTER (DECL_ASSEMBLER_NAME (decl));
9202 name = default_strip_name_encoding (name);
9203 len = strlen (name);
9204
9205 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == FUNCTION_DECL)
9206 {
9207 char *string;
9208
9209 /* It is essential that we prefix the section name here because
9210 otherwise the section names generated for constructors and
9211 destructors confuse collect2. */
9212
9213 string = alloca (len + 6);
9214 sprintf (string, "code@%s", name);
9215 DECL_SECTION_NAME (decl) = build_string (len + 5, string);
9216 }
9217 else if (TREE_PUBLIC (decl))
9218 DECL_SECTION_NAME (decl) = build_string (len, name);
9219 else
9220 {
9221 char *string;
9222
9223 string = alloca (len + 6);
9224 sprintf (string, "data@%s", name);
9225 DECL_SECTION_NAME (decl) = build_string (len + 5, string);
9226 }
9227 }
9228
9229 /* Switch to an arbitrary section NAME with attributes as specified
9230 by FLAGS. ALIGN specifies any known alignment requirements for
9231 the section; 0 if the default should be used. */
9232
9233 static void
9234 unicosmk_asm_named_section (const char *name, unsigned int flags)
9235 {
9236 const char *kind;
9237
9238 /* Close the previous section. */
9239
9240 fputs ("\t.endp\n\n", asm_out_file);
9241
9242 /* Find out what kind of section we are opening. */
9243
9244 if (flags & SECTION_MAIN)
9245 fputs ("\t.start\tmain\n", asm_out_file);
9246
9247 if (flags & SECTION_CODE)
9248 kind = "code";
9249 else if (flags & SECTION_PUBLIC)
9250 kind = "common";
9251 else
9252 kind = "data";
9253
9254 if (current_section_align != 0)
9255 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t.psect\t%s,%d,%s\n", name,
9256 current_section_align, kind);
9257 else
9258 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t.psect\t%s,%s\n", name, kind);
9259 }
9260
9261 static void
9262 unicosmk_insert_attributes (tree decl, tree *attr_ptr ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
9263 {
9264 if (DECL_P (decl)
9265 && (TREE_PUBLIC (decl) || TREE_CODE (decl) == FUNCTION_DECL))
9266 unicosmk_unique_section (decl, 0);
9267 }
9268
9269 /* Output an alignment directive. We have to use the macro 'gcc@code@align'
9270 in code sections because .align fill unused space with zeroes. */
9271
9272 void
9273 unicosmk_output_align (FILE *file, int align)
9274 {
9275 if (inside_function)
9276 fprintf (file, "\tgcc@code@align\t%d\n", align);
9277 else
9278 fprintf (file, "\t.align\t%d\n", align);
9279 }
9280
9281 /* Add a case vector to the current function's list of deferred case
9282 vectors. Case vectors have to be put into a separate section because CAM
9283 does not allow data definitions in code sections. */
9284
9285 void
9286 unicosmk_defer_case_vector (rtx lab, rtx vec)
9287 {
9288 struct machine_function *machine = cfun->machine;
9289
9290 vec = gen_rtx_EXPR_LIST (VOIDmode, lab, vec);
9291 machine->addr_list = gen_rtx_EXPR_LIST (VOIDmode, vec,
9292 machine->addr_list);
9293 }
9294
9295 /* Output a case vector. */
9296
9297 static void
9298 unicosmk_output_addr_vec (FILE *file, rtx vec)
9299 {
9300 rtx lab = XEXP (vec, 0);
9301 rtx body = XEXP (vec, 1);
9302 int vlen = XVECLEN (body, 0);
9303 int idx;
9304
9305 (*targetm.asm_out.internal_label) (file, "L", CODE_LABEL_NUMBER (lab));
9306
9307 for (idx = 0; idx < vlen; idx++)
9308 {
9309 ASM_OUTPUT_ADDR_VEC_ELT
9310 (file, CODE_LABEL_NUMBER (XEXP (XVECEXP (body, 0, idx), 0)));
9311 }
9312 }
9313
9314 /* Output current function's deferred case vectors. */
9315
9316 static void
9317 unicosmk_output_deferred_case_vectors (FILE *file)
9318 {
9319 struct machine_function *machine = cfun->machine;
9320 rtx t;
9321
9322 if (machine->addr_list == NULL_RTX)
9323 return;
9324
9325 data_section ();
9326 for (t = machine->addr_list; t; t = XEXP (t, 1))
9327 unicosmk_output_addr_vec (file, XEXP (t, 0));
9328 }
9329
9330 /* Generate the name of the SSIB section for the current function. */
9331
9332 #define SSIB_PREFIX "__SSIB_"
9333 #define SSIB_PREFIX_LEN 7
9334
9335 static const char *
9336 unicosmk_ssib_name (void)
9337 {
9338 /* This is ok since CAM won't be able to deal with names longer than that
9339 anyway. */
9340
9341 static char name[256];
9342
9343 rtx x;
9344 const char *fnname;
9345 int len;
9346
9347 x = DECL_RTL (cfun->decl);
9348 if (GET_CODE (x) != MEM)
9349 abort ();
9350 x = XEXP (x, 0);
9351 if (GET_CODE (x) != SYMBOL_REF)
9352 abort ();
9353 fnname = XSTR (x, 0);
9354
9355 len = strlen (fnname);
9356 if (len + SSIB_PREFIX_LEN > 255)
9357 len = 255 - SSIB_PREFIX_LEN;
9358
9359 strcpy (name, SSIB_PREFIX);
9360 strncpy (name + SSIB_PREFIX_LEN, fnname, len);
9361 name[len + SSIB_PREFIX_LEN] = 0;
9362
9363 return name;
9364 }
9365
9366 /* Set up the dynamic subprogram information block (DSIB) and update the
9367 frame pointer register ($15) for subroutines which have a frame. If the
9368 subroutine doesn't have a frame, simply increment $15. */
9369
9370 static void
9371 unicosmk_gen_dsib (unsigned long *imaskP)
9372 {
9373 if (alpha_procedure_type == PT_STACK)
9374 {
9375 const char *ssib_name;
9376 rtx mem;
9377
9378 /* Allocate 64 bytes for the DSIB. */
9379
9380 FRP (emit_insn (gen_adddi3 (stack_pointer_rtx, stack_pointer_rtx,
9381 GEN_INT (-64))));
9382 emit_insn (gen_blockage ());
9383
9384 /* Save the return address. */
9385
9386 mem = gen_rtx_MEM (DImode, plus_constant (stack_pointer_rtx, 56));
9387 set_mem_alias_set (mem, alpha_sr_alias_set);
9388 FRP (emit_move_insn (mem, gen_rtx_REG (DImode, REG_RA)));
9389 (*imaskP) &= ~(1UL << REG_RA);
9390
9391 /* Save the old frame pointer. */
9392
9393 mem = gen_rtx_MEM (DImode, plus_constant (stack_pointer_rtx, 48));
9394 set_mem_alias_set (mem, alpha_sr_alias_set);
9395 FRP (emit_move_insn (mem, hard_frame_pointer_rtx));
9396 (*imaskP) &= ~(1UL << HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM);
9397
9398 emit_insn (gen_blockage ());
9399
9400 /* Store the SSIB pointer. */
9401
9402 ssib_name = ggc_strdup (unicosmk_ssib_name ());
9403 mem = gen_rtx_MEM (DImode, plus_constant (stack_pointer_rtx, 32));
9404 set_mem_alias_set (mem, alpha_sr_alias_set);
9405
9406 FRP (emit_move_insn (gen_rtx_REG (DImode, 5),
9407 gen_rtx_SYMBOL_REF (Pmode, ssib_name)));
9408 FRP (emit_move_insn (mem, gen_rtx_REG (DImode, 5)));
9409
9410 /* Save the CIW index. */
9411
9412 mem = gen_rtx_MEM (DImode, plus_constant (stack_pointer_rtx, 24));
9413 set_mem_alias_set (mem, alpha_sr_alias_set);
9414 FRP (emit_move_insn (mem, gen_rtx_REG (DImode, 25)));
9415
9416 emit_insn (gen_blockage ());
9417
9418 /* Set the new frame pointer. */
9419
9420 FRP (emit_insn (gen_adddi3 (hard_frame_pointer_rtx,
9421 stack_pointer_rtx, GEN_INT (64))));
9422
9423 }
9424 else
9425 {
9426 /* Increment the frame pointer register to indicate that we do not
9427 have a frame. */
9428
9429 FRP (emit_insn (gen_adddi3 (hard_frame_pointer_rtx,
9430 hard_frame_pointer_rtx, GEN_INT (1))));
9431 }
9432 }
9433
9434 /* Output the static subroutine information block for the current
9435 function. */
9436
9437 static void
9438 unicosmk_output_ssib (FILE *file, const char *fnname)
9439 {
9440 int len;
9441 int i;
9442 rtx x;
9443 rtx ciw;
9444 struct machine_function *machine = cfun->machine;
9445
9446 ssib_section ();
9447 fprintf (file, "\t.endp\n\n\t.psect\t%s%s,data\n", user_label_prefix,
9448 unicosmk_ssib_name ());
9449
9450 /* Some required stuff and the function name length. */
9451
9452 len = strlen (fnname);
9453 fprintf (file, "\t.quad\t^X20008%2.2X28\n", len);
9454
9455 /* Saved registers
9456 ??? We don't do that yet. */
9457
9458 fputs ("\t.quad\t0\n", file);
9459
9460 /* Function address. */
9461
9462 fputs ("\t.quad\t", file);
9463 assemble_name (file, fnname);
9464 putc ('\n', file);
9465
9466 fputs ("\t.quad\t0\n", file);
9467 fputs ("\t.quad\t0\n", file);
9468
9469 /* Function name.
9470 ??? We do it the same way Cray CC does it but this could be
9471 simplified. */
9472
9473 for( i = 0; i < len; i++ )
9474 fprintf (file, "\t.byte\t%d\n", (int)(fnname[i]));
9475 if( (len % 8) == 0 )
9476 fputs ("\t.quad\t0\n", file);
9477 else
9478 fprintf (file, "\t.bits\t%d : 0\n", (8 - (len % 8))*8);
9479
9480 /* All call information words used in the function. */
9481
9482 for (x = machine->first_ciw; x; x = XEXP (x, 1))
9483 {
9484 ciw = XEXP (x, 0);
9485 #if HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT == 32
9486 fprintf (file, "\t.quad\t" HOST_WIDE_INT_PRINT_DOUBLE_HEX "\n",
9487 CONST_DOUBLE_HIGH (ciw), CONST_DOUBLE_LOW (ciw));
9488 #else
9489 fprintf (file, "\t.quad\t" HOST_WIDE_INT_PRINT_HEX "\n", INTVAL (ciw));
9490 #endif
9491 }
9492 }
9493
9494 /* Add a call information word (CIW) to the list of the current function's
9495 CIWs and return its index.
9496
9497 X is a CONST_INT or CONST_DOUBLE representing the CIW. */
9498
9499 rtx
9500 unicosmk_add_call_info_word (rtx x)
9501 {
9502 rtx node;
9503 struct machine_function *machine = cfun->machine;
9504
9505 node = gen_rtx_EXPR_LIST (VOIDmode, x, NULL_RTX);
9506 if (machine->first_ciw == NULL_RTX)
9507 machine->first_ciw = node;
9508 else
9509 XEXP (machine->last_ciw, 1) = node;
9510
9511 machine->last_ciw = node;
9512 ++machine->ciw_count;
9513
9514 return GEN_INT (machine->ciw_count
9515 + strlen (current_function_name)/8 + 5);
9516 }
9517
9518 static char unicosmk_section_buf[100];
9519
9520 char *
9521 unicosmk_text_section (void)
9522 {
9523 static int count = 0;
9524 sprintf (unicosmk_section_buf, "\t.endp\n\n\t.psect\tgcc@text___%d,code",
9525 count++);
9526 return unicosmk_section_buf;
9527 }
9528
9529 char *
9530 unicosmk_data_section (void)
9531 {
9532 static int count = 1;
9533 sprintf (unicosmk_section_buf, "\t.endp\n\n\t.psect\tgcc@data___%d,data",
9534 count++);
9535 return unicosmk_section_buf;
9536 }
9537
9538 /* The Cray assembler doesn't accept extern declarations for symbols which
9539 are defined in the same file. We have to keep track of all global
9540 symbols which are referenced and/or defined in a source file and output
9541 extern declarations for those which are referenced but not defined at
9542 the end of file. */
9543
9544 /* List of identifiers for which an extern declaration might have to be
9545 emitted. */
9546 /* FIXME: needs to use GC, so it can be saved and restored for PCH. */
9547
9548 struct unicosmk_extern_list
9549 {
9550 struct unicosmk_extern_list *next;
9551 const char *name;
9552 };
9553
9554 static struct unicosmk_extern_list *unicosmk_extern_head = 0;
9555
9556 /* Output extern declarations which are required for every asm file. */
9557
9558 static void
9559 unicosmk_output_default_externs (FILE *file)
9560 {
9561 static const char *const externs[] =
9562 { "__T3E_MISMATCH" };
9563
9564 int i;
9565 int n;
9566
9567 n = ARRAY_SIZE (externs);
9568
9569 for (i = 0; i < n; i++)
9570 fprintf (file, "\t.extern\t%s\n", externs[i]);
9571 }
9572
9573 /* Output extern declarations for global symbols which are have been
9574 referenced but not defined. */
9575
9576 static void
9577 unicosmk_output_externs (FILE *file)
9578 {
9579 struct unicosmk_extern_list *p;
9580 const char *real_name;
9581 int len;
9582 tree name_tree;
9583
9584 len = strlen (user_label_prefix);
9585 for (p = unicosmk_extern_head; p != 0; p = p->next)
9586 {
9587 /* We have to strip the encoding and possibly remove user_label_prefix
9588 from the identifier in order to handle -fleading-underscore and
9589 explicit asm names correctly (cf. gcc.dg/asm-names-1.c). */
9590 real_name = default_strip_name_encoding (p->name);
9591 if (len && p->name[0] == '*'
9592 && !memcmp (real_name, user_label_prefix, len))
9593 real_name += len;
9594
9595 name_tree = get_identifier (real_name);
9596 if (! TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (name_tree))
9597 {
9598 TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (name_tree) = 1;
9599 fputs ("\t.extern\t", file);
9600 assemble_name (file, p->name);
9601 putc ('\n', file);
9602 }
9603 }
9604 }
9605
9606 /* Record an extern. */
9607
9608 void
9609 unicosmk_add_extern (const char *name)
9610 {
9611 struct unicosmk_extern_list *p;
9612
9613 p = (struct unicosmk_extern_list *)
9614 xmalloc (sizeof (struct unicosmk_extern_list));
9615 p->next = unicosmk_extern_head;
9616 p->name = name;
9617 unicosmk_extern_head = p;
9618 }
9619
9620 /* The Cray assembler generates incorrect code if identifiers which
9621 conflict with register names are used as instruction operands. We have
9622 to replace such identifiers with DEX expressions. */
9623
9624 /* Structure to collect identifiers which have been replaced by DEX
9625 expressions. */
9626 /* FIXME: needs to use GC, so it can be saved and restored for PCH. */
9627
9628 struct unicosmk_dex {
9629 struct unicosmk_dex *next;
9630 const char *name;
9631 };
9632
9633 /* List of identifiers which have been replaced by DEX expressions. The DEX
9634 number is determined by the position in the list. */
9635
9636 static struct unicosmk_dex *unicosmk_dex_list = NULL;
9637
9638 /* The number of elements in the DEX list. */
9639
9640 static int unicosmk_dex_count = 0;
9641
9642 /* Check if NAME must be replaced by a DEX expression. */
9643
9644 static int
9645 unicosmk_special_name (const char *name)
9646 {
9647 if (name[0] == '*')
9648 ++name;
9649
9650 if (name[0] == '$')
9651 ++name;
9652
9653 if (name[0] != 'r' && name[0] != 'f' && name[0] != 'R' && name[0] != 'F')
9654 return 0;
9655
9656 switch (name[1])
9657 {
9658 case '1': case '2':
9659 return (name[2] == '\0' || (ISDIGIT (name[2]) && name[3] == '\0'));
9660
9661 case '3':
9662 return (name[2] == '\0'
9663 || ((name[2] == '0' || name[2] == '1') && name[3] == '\0'));
9664
9665 default:
9666 return (ISDIGIT (name[1]) && name[2] == '\0');
9667 }
9668 }
9669
9670 /* Return the DEX number if X must be replaced by a DEX expression and 0
9671 otherwise. */
9672
9673 static int
9674 unicosmk_need_dex (rtx x)
9675 {
9676 struct unicosmk_dex *dex;
9677 const char *name;
9678 int i;
9679
9680 if (GET_CODE (x) != SYMBOL_REF)
9681 return 0;
9682
9683 name = XSTR (x,0);
9684 if (! unicosmk_special_name (name))
9685 return 0;
9686
9687 i = unicosmk_dex_count;
9688 for (dex = unicosmk_dex_list; dex; dex = dex->next)
9689 {
9690 if (! strcmp (name, dex->name))
9691 return i;
9692 --i;
9693 }
9694
9695 dex = (struct unicosmk_dex *) xmalloc (sizeof (struct unicosmk_dex));
9696 dex->name = name;
9697 dex->next = unicosmk_dex_list;
9698 unicosmk_dex_list = dex;
9699
9700 ++unicosmk_dex_count;
9701 return unicosmk_dex_count;
9702 }
9703
9704 /* Output the DEX definitions for this file. */
9705
9706 static void
9707 unicosmk_output_dex (FILE *file)
9708 {
9709 struct unicosmk_dex *dex;
9710 int i;
9711
9712 if (unicosmk_dex_list == NULL)
9713 return;
9714
9715 fprintf (file, "\t.dexstart\n");
9716
9717 i = unicosmk_dex_count;
9718 for (dex = unicosmk_dex_list; dex; dex = dex->next)
9719 {
9720 fprintf (file, "\tDEX (%d) = ", i);
9721 assemble_name (file, dex->name);
9722 putc ('\n', file);
9723 --i;
9724 }
9725
9726 fprintf (file, "\t.dexend\n");
9727 }
9728
9729 /* Output text that to appear at the beginning of an assembler file. */
9730
9731 void
9732 unicosmk_asm_file_start (FILE *file)
9733 {
9734 int i;
9735
9736 fputs ("\t.ident\t", file);
9737 unicosmk_output_module_name (file);
9738 fputs ("\n\n", file);
9739
9740 /* The Unicos/Mk assembler uses different register names. Instead of trying
9741 to support them, we simply use micro definitions. */
9742
9743 /* CAM has different register names: rN for the integer register N and fN
9744 for the floating-point register N. Instead of trying to use these in
9745 alpha.md, we define the symbols $N and $fN to refer to the appropriate
9746 register. */
9747
9748 for (i = 0; i < 32; ++i)
9749 fprintf (file, "$%d <- r%d\n", i, i);
9750
9751 for (i = 0; i < 32; ++i)
9752 fprintf (file, "$f%d <- f%d\n", i, i);
9753
9754 putc ('\n', file);
9755
9756 /* The .align directive fill unused space with zeroes which does not work
9757 in code sections. We define the macro 'gcc@code@align' which uses nops
9758 instead. Note that it assumes that code sections always have the
9759 biggest possible alignment since . refers to the current offset from
9760 the beginning of the section. */
9761
9762 fputs ("\t.macro gcc@code@align n\n", file);
9763 fputs ("gcc@n@bytes = 1 << n\n", file);
9764 fputs ("gcc@here = . % gcc@n@bytes\n", file);
9765 fputs ("\t.if ne, gcc@here, 0\n", file);
9766 fputs ("\t.repeat (gcc@n@bytes - gcc@here) / 4\n", file);
9767 fputs ("\tbis r31,r31,r31\n", file);
9768 fputs ("\t.endr\n", file);
9769 fputs ("\t.endif\n", file);
9770 fputs ("\t.endm gcc@code@align\n\n", file);
9771
9772 /* Output extern declarations which should always be visible. */
9773 unicosmk_output_default_externs (file);
9774
9775 /* Open a dummy section. We always need to be inside a section for the
9776 section-switching code to work correctly.
9777 ??? This should be a module id or something like that. I still have to
9778 figure out what the rules for those are. */
9779 fputs ("\n\t.psect\t$SG00000,data\n", file);
9780 }
9781
9782 /* Output text to appear at the end of an assembler file. This includes all
9783 pending extern declarations and DEX expressions. */
9784
9785 static void
9786 unicosmk_file_end (void)
9787 {
9788 fputs ("\t.endp\n\n", asm_out_file);
9789
9790 /* Output all pending externs. */
9791
9792 unicosmk_output_externs (asm_out_file);
9793
9794 /* Output dex definitions used for functions whose names conflict with
9795 register names. */
9796
9797 unicosmk_output_dex (asm_out_file);
9798
9799 fputs ("\t.end\t", asm_out_file);
9800 unicosmk_output_module_name (asm_out_file);
9801 putc ('\n', asm_out_file);
9802 }
9803
9804 #else
9805
9806 static void
9807 unicosmk_output_deferred_case_vectors (FILE *file ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
9808 {}
9809
9810 static void
9811 unicosmk_gen_dsib (unsigned long *imaskP ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
9812 {}
9813
9814 static void
9815 unicosmk_output_ssib (FILE * file ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
9816 const char * fnname ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
9817 {}
9818
9819 rtx
9820 unicosmk_add_call_info_word (rtx x ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
9821 {
9822 return NULL_RTX;
9823 }
9824
9825 static int
9826 unicosmk_need_dex (rtx x ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
9827 {
9828 return 0;
9829 }
9830
9831 #endif /* TARGET_ABI_UNICOSMK */
9832
9833 \f
9834 /* Initialize the GCC target structure. */
9835 #if TARGET_ABI_OPEN_VMS
9836 # undef TARGET_ATTRIBUTE_TABLE
9837 # define TARGET_ATTRIBUTE_TABLE vms_attribute_table
9838 # undef TARGET_SECTION_TYPE_FLAGS
9839 # define TARGET_SECTION_TYPE_FLAGS vms_section_type_flags
9840 #endif
9841
9842 #undef TARGET_IN_SMALL_DATA_P
9843 #define TARGET_IN_SMALL_DATA_P alpha_in_small_data_p
9844
9845 #if TARGET_ABI_UNICOSMK
9846 # undef TARGET_INSERT_ATTRIBUTES
9847 # define TARGET_INSERT_ATTRIBUTES unicosmk_insert_attributes
9848 # undef TARGET_SECTION_TYPE_FLAGS
9849 # define TARGET_SECTION_TYPE_FLAGS unicosmk_section_type_flags
9850 # undef TARGET_ASM_UNIQUE_SECTION
9851 # define TARGET_ASM_UNIQUE_SECTION unicosmk_unique_section
9852 # undef TARGET_ASM_GLOBALIZE_LABEL
9853 # define TARGET_ASM_GLOBALIZE_LABEL hook_void_FILEptr_constcharptr
9854 #endif
9855
9856 #undef TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_HI_OP
9857 #define TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_HI_OP "\t.word\t"
9858 #undef TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_DI_OP
9859 #define TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_DI_OP "\t.quad\t"
9860
9861 /* Default unaligned ops are provided for ELF systems. To get unaligned
9862 data for non-ELF systems, we have to turn off auto alignment. */
9863 #ifndef OBJECT_FORMAT_ELF
9864 #undef TARGET_ASM_UNALIGNED_HI_OP
9865 #define TARGET_ASM_UNALIGNED_HI_OP "\t.align 0\n\t.word\t"
9866 #undef TARGET_ASM_UNALIGNED_SI_OP
9867 #define TARGET_ASM_UNALIGNED_SI_OP "\t.align 0\n\t.long\t"
9868 #undef TARGET_ASM_UNALIGNED_DI_OP
9869 #define TARGET_ASM_UNALIGNED_DI_OP "\t.align 0\n\t.quad\t"
9870 #endif
9871
9872 #ifdef OBJECT_FORMAT_ELF
9873 #undef TARGET_ASM_SELECT_RTX_SECTION
9874 #define TARGET_ASM_SELECT_RTX_SECTION alpha_elf_select_rtx_section
9875 #endif
9876
9877 #undef TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_END_PROLOGUE
9878 #define TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_END_PROLOGUE alpha_output_function_end_prologue
9879
9880 #undef TARGET_SCHED_ADJUST_COST
9881 #define TARGET_SCHED_ADJUST_COST alpha_adjust_cost
9882 #undef TARGET_SCHED_ISSUE_RATE
9883 #define TARGET_SCHED_ISSUE_RATE alpha_issue_rate
9884 #undef TARGET_SCHED_USE_DFA_PIPELINE_INTERFACE
9885 #define TARGET_SCHED_USE_DFA_PIPELINE_INTERFACE \
9886 alpha_use_dfa_pipeline_interface
9887 #undef TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_DFA_LOOKAHEAD
9888 #define TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_DFA_LOOKAHEAD \
9889 alpha_multipass_dfa_lookahead
9890
9891 #undef TARGET_HAVE_TLS
9892 #define TARGET_HAVE_TLS HAVE_AS_TLS
9893
9894 #undef TARGET_INIT_BUILTINS
9895 #define TARGET_INIT_BUILTINS alpha_init_builtins
9896 #undef TARGET_EXPAND_BUILTIN
9897 #define TARGET_EXPAND_BUILTIN alpha_expand_builtin
9898
9899 #undef TARGET_FUNCTION_OK_FOR_SIBCALL
9900 #define TARGET_FUNCTION_OK_FOR_SIBCALL alpha_function_ok_for_sibcall
9901 #undef TARGET_CANNOT_COPY_INSN_P
9902 #define TARGET_CANNOT_COPY_INSN_P alpha_cannot_copy_insn_p
9903
9904 #if TARGET_ABI_OSF
9905 #undef TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_MI_THUNK
9906 #define TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_MI_THUNK alpha_output_mi_thunk_osf
9907 #undef TARGET_ASM_CAN_OUTPUT_MI_THUNK
9908 #define TARGET_ASM_CAN_OUTPUT_MI_THUNK hook_bool_tree_hwi_hwi_tree_true
9909 #endif
9910
9911 #undef TARGET_RTX_COSTS
9912 #define TARGET_RTX_COSTS alpha_rtx_costs
9913 #undef TARGET_ADDRESS_COST
9914 #define TARGET_ADDRESS_COST hook_int_rtx_0
9915
9916 #undef TARGET_MACHINE_DEPENDENT_REORG
9917 #define TARGET_MACHINE_DEPENDENT_REORG alpha_reorg
9918
9919 struct gcc_target targetm = TARGET_INITIALIZER;
9920
9921 \f
9922 #include "gt-alpha.h"
9923